导航栏

×
范文大全 > 教案

仁爱七年级英语教案

时间:2023-09-12 仁爱七年级英语教案 七年级英语教案

仁爱七年级英语教案锦集八篇。

一般给学生们上课之前,老师就早早地准备好了教案课件,因此就需要老师自己花点时间去写。老师要按照教案课件来实施上课内容,好的教案课件怎么写?教师范文大全的编辑今天要为大家推荐一篇关于“仁爱七年级英语教案”的文章,期望这篇文章有助于您谢谢浏览!

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇1

英语教学涉及多种专业理论知识,包括语言学、第二语言习得、词汇学、句法学、文体学、语料库。下面为了大家分享了八年级上的英语课件,欢迎参考!

教学目标

1语言目标:描述健康问题的词汇,及如何根据别人的健康问题提建议。技能目标:能听懂谈论健康问题的对话材料;能根据别人的健康问题提建议;能写出重点单词和重点句型,并能描述怎样对待健康问题。情感目标:通过开展扮演病人等活动,培养学生关心他人身体健康的品质。

通过本课的阅读,培养学生处理紧急事件的基本能力,树立紧急事件时互相帮助的精神。

教学重难点

掌握情态动词should shouldn’t.的用法

学习have的用法jk251.COM

教学工具

多媒体

教学过程

Step 1 Warming up and new words

1.Look at a picture and learn the parts of the body.2.New words and phrases.Step 2 Presentation

1a Look at the picture.Write the correct letter [a-m] for each part of the body.___arm ___ back ___ ear ___ eye ___ foot

___hand ___ head ___ leg ___ mouth

___ neck ___nose ___ stomach ___ tooth

Step 3 Listening

1b Listen and look at the picture.Then number the names 1-5

Listen to the conversations again and fill in the nversation 1

Nurse: What’s the matter, Sarah?

Girl: I ___________.Conversation 2

Nurse: What’s the matter, David?

Boy: I _________________.Conversation 3

Nurse: What’s the matter, Ben?

Boy: I _________________.Conversation 4

Nurse: What’s the matter, Nancy?

Girl: I _________________.Conversation 5

Betty: What’s the matter, Judy?

Ann: She __________________.Step 4 Speaking

1c Look at the pictures.What are the students’ problems? Make conversations.Examples

A: What’s the matter with Judy?

B: She talked too much yesterday and didn’t drink enough water.She has a very sore throat now.A: What’s the matter with Sarah?

B: She didn’t take care of herself on the weekend.She was playing with her friends at the park yesterday.Then it got windy, but she didn’t put on her jacket.Now she has a cold.Step 5 Guessing games

Guess what has happened to the students by using the important sentences.Step 6 Listening

2a Listen and number the pictures [1-5] in the order you hear them.2b Listen again.Match the problems with the advice.Step 7 Speaking

2c Make conversations using the information in 2a and 2b

A: What’s the matter?

B: My head feels very hot.A: Maybe you have a fever.B: What should I do?

A: You should take your temperature.Step 8 Role–play

Imagine you are the school doctor.A few students have health problems.Role-play a conversation between the doctor and the students.2d Role –play the conversation

Step 9 Language points and summary

1.What’s the matter?

这是人们特别是医生和护士询问病人病情时最常用的问句, 意思是“怎么了?”其后通常与介词with连用。类似的问句还有:

What’s wrong? 怎么啦?

What’s wrong with you? 你怎么了?

What’s your trouble? 你怎么了?

What’s the trouble with you? 你怎么了?

What’s up? 你怎么了?

2.have a cold伤风, 感冒, 是固定词组

表示身体不适的常用词组还有:

have a bad cold 重感冒

have a fever 发烧

have a headache 头痛

have a stomachache 肚子痛, 胃痛

have a toothache 牙痛

Summary

1.牙疼 have a toothache

2.胃疼 have a stomachache

3.背疼 have a backache

4.头疼 have a headache

5.喉咙疼 have a sore throat

6.发烧 have a fever

7.感冒 have a cold

8.躺下并且休息 lie down and rest

9.喝热蜂蜜茶 drink hot tea with honey

10.喝大量水 drink lots of water

11.看牙医 see a dentist

12.量体温 take one’s temperature

13.看医生 go to a doctor

Step 10 Exercises

根据上下文意思填空。

Mandy: Lisa, are you OK?

Lisa: I _____ a headache and I can’t move my neck.What ______ I do? Should I

_____ my temperature?

Mandy: No, it doesn’t sound like you have a fever.What _____ you do on the

weekend?

Lisa: I played computer _____ all weekend.Mandy: That’s probably why.You need to take breaks _____ from the computer.Lisa: Yeah, I think I sat in the _____ way for too long without moving.Mandy: I think you should ____ down and rest.If your head and neck still hurt tomorrow, then go to a _______.Lisa: OK.Thanks, Mandy.翻译下列句子。

1.你怎么了?我头痛。

2.他怎么了?他发烧

3.李雷怎么了?他喉咙痛。他应该多喝水。

4.如果你的头和脖子明天仍然疼的话,请去看医生。

Homework

Make up a conversation between a doctor and a patient.

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇2

Topic 2 section B

主备人: 审核人:

学习目的:1.复习有关职业的单词。

2.学会询问职业的表达法和工作地点。

一.复习与巩固

1. 想一想 你能说出那些关于职业的单词。

2. 说一说 请你和你的小组编写一个关于询问职业的对话,完成下列表格。

Names

Jobs

二.课前导学

1.读一读 请根据句意,猜测划线单词的意思。

(1) He is a cook, now he works in a _restaurant _. __________

(2) My father is a farmer, he works on a _farm___. ___________

(3) Xiao Ming’s mother is a doctor, so she works in a _hospital_. ______________

(4) My good friend is an office worker, she works in an _office_ . ___________

(5) I am a teacher and I _teach_ students English in a school.________________

(6) Jackie Chan is an actor, he _acts_ in Rush Hour. __________________

(7)Tom is a driver in Shanghai, he _drives_ a bus. ___________________

2.读一读 根据所学的音标,请试着读出划线部分的单词。

3. 火眼金睛:请观察下列单词,你能发现什么?

①farm-farmer

②teach-teacher work-worker act-actor drive-driver

小结:____________________________________________________________________

练一练 请仿照课前导读的1部分,用括号内的词的适当形式填空。

He ________ (work) in a Junior High school, so he is a _________ ( teach).

Can you _______ (act) out the conversation ?

Mr Brown often _________ (drive) to Wuhan.

4. 找一找 你知道下列词组吗?

在餐馆_____________________________ 在医院 _______________________________

在办公室 __________________________ 在农场 _______________________________

在学校 _____________________________在北京_______________________________

三. 自主探究学习 新词/句运用

1.学一学 看图片,运用下面的句型谈论图片中的职业及他们的工作地点。

What does he do ? Where does he work ?

He is --------- He works in ---------

(老师先演示,然后学生自由谈论)

2.看一看 看1a 部分中的图片,猜猜她们谈论的话题。

3.读一读 分角色读1a 部分。

4. 做一做 听1a部分的录音,做1b部分。

5 .演一演 请根据1a部分的图片及1c部分的3副图片编写4个对话。

6. ①听一听 听录音,做P66的3。

②Listen again, and complete the following blanks.

David is a _____ in Beijing. Lisa works in Fuzhou. She is a _____. Paul _____ a bus in Shenzhen. Danny _______ English at Nanjing No.1 High School. He is a very

good ______.

7.说一说 调查班上同学父母亲的工作和工作地点,完成P66第四部分的表格。

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇3

Topic 2 What does your mother do? Section A 导学案

班级__________ 小组__________ 姓名__________

1、掌握并应用关于职业和其他单词:

doctor, worker, driver, farmer, cook, nurse

kid, glad, mother, father, parent, office

2. 学习谈论工作和打招呼:

(1)-What does your mother do?

-She is a teacher.

(2)-What do your parents do?

-They are office workers.

(3)-Glad to meet you.

-Glad to meet you, too.

3、正确朗读 /au/ // // /e/ / u/ /tr/ /dr/ 参与

mother____ father____doctor____

parent____ office____ worker____

driver_____ farmer ___cook____ nurse____

Ⅲ、通过图片反应对应的单词,大声跟读和朗读。

Ⅳ、配合老师学习新句型,与小组同学合作讨论对话。

Ⅴ、独立思考与合作探究相结合,参照导学案去扩展与提升询问职业句型。

Ⅵ 保持积极乐观的情感,学唱歌曲。

相结合。

Ⅸ、 调查周边的同学,积极参与表达与展示。

听录音并跟读3a,听录音完成3b并核对。

通过3b 最后一个单词dream利用幻灯片图片引出关于jobs的新单词。由jobs新单词图标family 过渡到其他新单词的教学。

Ⅳ、 1c Work in groups, Make up conversations

巩固新单词后,教师引导进入职业的询问,并从整体到小组到个人层层递进进行操练,熟悉此句型。

_____ does he do? =What ___ he?

What _____ you do? =What ____ you?

What _____she do?

What _____your mother do?

What _____ your father do?

What ____ they do?

- What does he/she do?

- He/She is a/an…

- What do they do?

-They are…-s.

Ⅵ、 Sing the song: The more we get together

Ⅶ、 1a Watch the flash then answer the question.

Where are they?

I have a friend. His name is … His father is a/an … and his mother is a/an … He has a happy family.

小组评价 1、 个人学习效果(听说读写能力、单词短语的习得与句型的理解掌握运用、表演创作、课堂参与度)

-They are…-s.

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇4

Unit 5 第5单元

Topic 1How do you usually come to school? 话题1你通常怎样去上学? gaten.大门

the same to对……也一样 by prep.乘(车等);靠近,在……旁;在……时间;不迟于;被;用;由

subway(underground)n.地下铁道;地铁交通 always adv.总是,一直;永远 come on快点儿;加油;来吧 on foot走路,步行 go to school去上学 planen.飞机

trainn.火车;v. 培训,训练 ship n.船,轮船 boatn.小船,小舟 Ms. n.女士(用在婚姻状况不明的女子姓氏或姓名前)grandmothern.奶奶;外婆 groupn.组,群

weekdayn.平日(星期一至星期五的任何一天)early adj.早的;adv.早地 bird n.鸟

catchv.捉住;接住;赶上;染上(疾病)worm n.软体虫,蠕虫(尤指蚯蚓)sometimesadv.有时

seldomadv.很少;不常 walkv. & n.步行;散步 neveradv.决不,从来没有 ridev.骑(自行车、马等);乘车;n.乘车旅行 parkn.公园;v.停放(汽车)homeworkn.家庭作业

do(one’s)homework做家庭作业

watchv.观看;注视;当心,注意;n.手表,表 TV=television n. 电视;电视机 watch TV看电视 interviewern.采访者 America n.美国

lifen.生活;生命;人生

Americanadj.美国的;美国人的;n.美国 or conj.或者,还是;否则

fewadj.很少的,不多的;pron.不多,少数 have lunch 吃午饭

at school在学校;在上课 dayn.

(一)天,(一)日;白天

restn.休息;剩余的部分,其余的人(物);v.休息,歇息

have a rest休息 play v.打(球);玩;游戏;播放;n.玩耍;戏剧 basketballn.篮球

soccer(football BrE)n.足球(运动)swim v.& n.游;游泳 go swimming去游泳 and so on……等等 balln.球;舞会

gamen.比赛;运动;游戏

moreadv.更;另外;adj.另外的;较多的(much或many的比较级)

talkn.讲话,交谈;n.谈话,演讲 listen v.听,仔细听 listen to听……

musicn.音乐;乐曲

libraryn.图书馆,图书室

mustv.必须,应当;必定是;n.必须做(或看、买等)的事

firstadv.& adj.第一;首次;最初;num.第一 readv.读;朗读

onceadv.一次;从前,一度;cortj.一旦 weekn.星期,周 twiceadv.两次;两倍 everyadj.每一,每个的 beginv.开始;着手 have classes上课

whilen.一会儿,一段时间;conj. ……(然)而;虽然;在……的时候;和……同时 bedn.床 go to bed睡觉 Unit 5 第5单元

Topic 2 He is runnig on the playground.话题2他在操场上跑步。makev.制造,做;使得 cardn.卡片;名片;纸牌 boring adj.乏味的,无聊的 soonadv.很快,马上,不久 runv.跑,奔跑

playgroundn.操场,运动场 dancev.& n.跳舞

gymgymnasium n.体育馆,健身房;体操 dormitoryn.学生宿舍(缩写式dorm)sleep v.睡觉;睡;n.睡觉

cleanv.弄干净,擦干净;adj.清洁的,干净的lab laboratory;n.实验室

computern.计算机;电脑

roomn.室,房间;空间;地方

halln.大厅,会堂,礼堂;过道

dining hall 餐厅;食堂

classroomn.教室

buildingn.大楼;建筑物;房屋

swimmingn.游泳,游泳运动

pooln.水池,水塘

borrowv.(向别人)借用;借

coursen.过程;经过;课程

of course当然

useV.使用,利用,应用;n.用,使用,得到利用 better adv.更好地;更;adj. 较好的;更好的(good和well的比较级)

look for 寻找

shelf(pl.shelves)n.架子;搁板;搁层;礁;陆架 keepv.保存;保持;继续不断

return v.归还;回,归

on time准时,按时

pleasuren.高兴,愉快

postn.邮件;邮政,邮寄;v.投寄,邮寄 bye-byeinterj.再见

purse n.钱包

money n.钱;货币

elseadv.别的,其他的picturen.照片;图片;画片

putv.放,摆

put on穿,戴上;上演

aroundadv.在周围;在附近;大约;prep.在……周围

show sb.around领某人参观

sit(过去式sat)v.坐

writev.写,书写;写作,著述

at the back of在……的后面

drawv.绘画;绘制;拉,拖

becauseconj.因为

Japaneseadj.日本的;日本人的;日语的;n.日本人;日语

wonderfuladj.了不起的;美妙的alsoadv.也,而且,此外

Unit 5

第5单元

Topic 3My school life is very interesting.话题3我的学校生活非常有趣。

today

adv.在今天,在今日;n.今天 Wednesdayn.星期三 Mondayn.星期一 physicsn.物理(学)Tuesdayn.星期二 geographyn.地理(学)Thursdayn.星期四 P.E.(physical education的缩写)n.体育 Fridayn.星期五 artn.美术,艺术;技艺 mathn.(美口语)数学 sciencen.科学,自然科学 historyn.历史;历史的 meetingn.会;集会;会见;汇合点 activityn.活动 lessonn.课,功课;教训 learnn.学,学习,学会 easyadj.容易的,不费力的 interestingadj.有趣的 difficultadj.难的,艰难的;不易相处的 whichpron.那(哪)一个;那(哪)些 subjectn.学科;主语;主体;主题;题目 bestadv.& adj.最好地(的)(good和well的最高级)storyn.故事,小说 friendlyadj.友好的 otheradj.别的,另外的;pron.别人,别的东西 news n.新闻,消息 attention n.注意,关心 betweenprep.在(两者)之间;在……中间 stamp n.邮票 worldn.世界 Saturdayn.星期六 from...to...从……到…… nightn.夜,夜间 placen.地点,地方 programn.节目;项目 Februaryn.(Feb.)二月 newspapern.报纸 hardadj.努力的,辛苦的;困难的,艰难的;硬的;adv.努力地;使劲;猛烈地 wishn.愿望,祝愿;v.希望,想要,祝愿 Unit6 第六单元 Topic 1 Is there a computer in your study? 你的书房里有电脑吗? gardenn.花园,果园,菜园

bedroomn.卧室,寝室

secondnum.第二; adj.第二的;n.秒

floor n.(楼房的)层;地面,地板

next to 在……近旁;紧邻

upstairsadv.到楼上,在楼上

bathroomn.浴室,盥洗室

front n.前面;前部;前线;aaj.前面的;前部的 in front of在……前面

housen.房子,住宅

grandfathern.爷爷;外公

behindprep.(表示位置)在……后面;adv.在后面;向后

doorn.门

talk about 谈论,议论

nearprep.在……附近,靠近; aaj.近的 lampn.灯,油灯;光源

clockn.钟

under prep.& adv.在……下面;向……下面 table n.桌子;表格

key n.钥匙;答案;键;关键

awayadv.离开,远离

put away将……收起;把……放回原处

thingn.东西,物;(p1.)物品,用品;事情 dadn.(口语)爸爸,爹爹

windownn.窗户;计算机的窗口

modeln.模型;范例;模范

rivern.河;江;水道

centern.中心,中央

in the center of在……中心

yardn.院子;场地;码

beautifuladj.美的,美丽的,美观的flowern.花

largeadj.大的,巨大的leftn.左,左边; adv.向左; adj.左边的 peoplen.人;人们

mirrorn.镜子

drawer n.抽屉

chairn.椅子

keyboardn.键盘

pencil-box n.铅笔盒

Unit 6

第六单元

Topic2 What kind of home do you live in?

话题2 你住在什么样的房子里?)

country n.农村,乡下;国家 month n.月,月份 Mrsn.夫人,太太(称呼已婚妇女)furnituren.(总称)家具 quietadj.安静的;寂静的 per prep.每,每一 neighbor n.邻居,邻人 storen.商店;大百货公司 bankn.银行;(河、海、湖等的)岸,堤 streetn.街,街道 cornern.(街道)拐角;角;角落 museumn.博物馆,博物院 supermarketn.超级市场,超市 stationn.车站,站,所 mailv.(美)邮寄;n.邮政;邮递 restaurantn.饭馆,饭店 hearv.听见;听说,得知 pianon.钢琴 loudadj.大声的 reallyadv.真正地;到底;确实 endn.末尾,终点,结束;v.结束,终止 at the end of… 在……的结尾/末端 road n.路,道路 communityn.社区;社会 child(pl.children)n.儿童,小孩 a lot of(=lots of)许多,大量 closeadj.近,靠近;亲密的;adv.近,靠近;v.关,关闭 faradj.远的;adv.远地 far from远离 servicen.服务 arean.地区;范围;面积 stopn.(停车)站,停;v.停止;阻止 fann.风扇;(电影、运动等的)迷;热心的爱好者(支持者)linen.电话线路;线,线路;行,排 badadj.坏的,不好的 someonepron.某一个人 checkv.检查;核对;批改;n.检查;批改 movev.搬家;移动,搬动 countrysiden.乡下,农村 cityn.市,城市,都市 trafficn.交通;来往车辆 costn.费用;花费;价钱;v.值(多少钱);花费 missv.思念;未见到;未听到;错过 fresh adj.新鲜的townn.城镇,城

Unit 6

第六单元

Topic 3 Which is the way to the post office?

去邮局的路怎么走

bridgen.桥

alongprep.沿着,顺着; adv.向前;和……一起;一同

turn v.转弯;转变;旋转,翻转; n.转弯;轮流;(轮流的)顺序

crossingn.十字路口,人行横道

across prep.横过,穿过

meter n.米,公尺

untilconj.&prep.直到……为止

kilometer n.千米(公里)

shouldv.aux.会,应该(shall的过去式)

changev.更换;变化,改变; n.零钱;找头 public adj.公共的,公众的; n.公众

lightn.灯;灯光;光,光亮; adj.明亮的;浅色的;轻的; v.点(火),点燃

dangern.危险

safeadj.安全的hurt adj.(身体上)受伤的; v.受伤;伤害;使疼痛;感到疼痛

losev.丢失,失去

accidentn.事故,意外的事

rulen.规则,规定; v.统治;支配

sign n.符号,标记;指示牌

beforeconj.在……之前; prep.在……以前;在……前面; adv.以前

crossv.穿过;越过; n.十字形的东西

third num.第三

last adv.最后地;最近刚过去; n.最后; adj.最近刚过去的;最后的; v.持续

carefuladj.小心的,仔细的,谨慎的skateboardn.滑板

ticketn.罚款单;票;券

speedv.(使)加速; n.速度

fastadv.快地,迅速地; adj.快的,迅速的whenconj.当……的时候; adv.什么时候,何时 lateadj.晚的,迟的; adv.晚地,迟地

downprep沿着,沿……而下; adv.向下

Review of Units 5-6

复习5到6单元

hilln.小山;丘陵;土堆;斜坡

certainlyadv.当然,是的;一定;无疑

Unit 7第七单元 Topic 1 When is your birthday? 你的生日是什么时候? sport n.体育运动,锻炼 wasv.(am,is的过去式)是 born adj.出生 June n.(Jun.)六月 March n.(Mar.)三月 April n.(Apr.)四月 Mayn.五月 July n.(Jul.)七月 August n.(Aug.)八月 September n.(Sept.)九月 October n.(Oct.)十月 November n.(Nov.)十一月 December n.(Dec.)十二月 January n.(Jan.)一月 were v.(are的过去式)是 aloneadj.单独的,孤独的 thousandnum.千 birthdayn.生日 daten.日期;约会 planv.计划,打算; n.计划,打算;平面图 celebrate v.庆祝 partyn.聚会,宴会;党派 fourthnum.第四 fifthnum.第五 sixthnum.第六 seventhnum.第七 eighthnum.第八 ninthnum.第九 tenthnum.第十 eleventhnum.第十一 twelfthnum.第十二 thirteenthnum.第十三 twentiethnum.第二十 presentn.礼物,赠品 shapen.形状,外形; v.使成型;制造;塑造just now刚才 centimetern.(cm)厘米 footballn.(美式)橄榄球;(英式)足球 specialadj.特别的,专门的candlen.蜡烛

surprisen.惊奇,诧异; v.使惊奇,使诧异 do some cleaning打扫卫生

Unit 7

第七单元

Topic 2 Can you dance or draw?

你会跳舞或画画吗?

discon.迪斯科(一种舞曲)

performv.表演;履行;行动

balletn.芭蕾舞

have a good time玩得高兴,过得愉快

parrotn.鹦鹉

smartadj.聪明的,灵巧的;(人、服装等)时髦的,帅的countv.数,点数

erinterj.哦,嗯

climbv.爬,攀登

pign.猪

ping-pongn.乒乓球(运动)

be good at擅长于

Londonn.伦敦

agen.年龄;时代

at the age of在……岁时

anythingpron.任何事(物);无论何事(物)wordn.单词,词;话

mean v.意思是,意指

Unit 7

第七单元

Topic 3 We had a wonderful party.我们度过了一个精彩的聚会。

recitev.朗读;背诵

poem n.诗

magicadj.有魔力的enjoyv.喜欢;欣赏;享受……的乐趣

himselfpron他自己

yesterdayadv.&n.昨天

fall(过去式fell)v.倒;落(下),降落;

autumnn.秋季

washv.&n.洗(涤),冲洗

happenv.(偶然)发生

standv.站,立;起立;坐落;经受;持久 liev.说谎;躺;平放;位于; n.谎言

videon.录像,视频

everyonepron.每人,人人

truthn.真相,事实;真理;实际情况

tell a lie撒谎

angryadj.愤怒的,生气的 eachpron.&adj.每人,每个,每件 silentadj.无声的;安静的;沉默的 blow(过去式blew)v.吹;刮风;吹气; n.猛击;打击;吹 blow out 被(风等)吹灭;熄灭 breathn.气息;呼吸 sunnyadj.晴朗的,阳光充足的 deliciousadj.美味的,可口的 musicaladj.音乐的,配乐的 funnyadj.有趣的,滑稽可笑的 Unit 8 第8单元 Topic 1 What's the weather like in Spring? 春季的天气怎么样? weathern.天气 springn.春天,春季;泉,泉水 warmadj.暖和的,温暖的;热情的 seasonn.季,季节 summern.夏天,夏季 hotadj.热的;辣的 wintern.冬天,冬季 coldadj.冷的,寒的; n.寒冷;感冒,伤风 rainv.下雨; n.雨,雨水 snowv.下雪; n.雪 groundn.地面 rainyadj.下雨的,多雨的 cloudyadj.多云的,阴天的 snowyadj.下雪的,多(积)雪的;雪(白)的 windyadj.有风的,多风的 foggyadj.多雾的 brightadj.明亮的;聪明的 temperaturen.温度 lowadj.&adv.低;矮 hometown n.家乡 ifconj.如果,假使;是否,是不是 trip n.旅行,旅程 wear(过去式wore)v.穿,戴 holidayn.假日,假期 travelv.&n.旅行 had better(do sth.)最好(做某事)find out查明,发现,了解 umbrellan.伞,雨伞 go out出去;熄灭 Australian.澳大利亚 remember v.记起,想起

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇5

Unit1Myname’sGina.

一、教师寄语:

Athousand-lijourneyisstartedbytakingthefirststep.千里之行,始于足下。

二、学习目标:

Keywords:mynamenicemeetyouwhat’shisher

Keyphrases:myname,firstname,lastname,answerthequestion.

What’shisname?

What’shername?及回答。

1.掌握简单的问候语,并能自我介绍,初步培养用英语进行交际的能力。

2.掌握听的技能,在听的过程中准确获取数字信息。

1.name_________2.好的,令人愉快的______________

3.too___________4.遇见______5.your____________

①.onenum.1,一:Oneandtwomakesthree.一加二等于三。

adj.①一个:Ihaveonebook.我有一本书。②有一(天):Onedayhewillunderstandyou.有一天他会理解你的。

【记忆法】-ee-双写,与meat为同音词。

【考点】tomeetsb.(orsth.)遇到某人/某事:Nicetomeetyou.初次见面时的客套话,不是初次见面时则用see。

③“What’syourname?”“MynameisGina.”“你叫什么名字?”“我叫吉娜。”

两人初次见面互相询问姓名时可用这个句型。如想反问时可说:Andyou?或者Andwhat’syourname?如:

A:Hello.What’syourname?

B:MynameisAnnRead.Andyou?/Andwhat’syourname?

④Hello!你好!

Hello一般可作为熟人、朋友、青年人之间的招呼用语,语气较随便,译为“您好”;此外打电话或遇熟人时也可用。译为“喂”。在表示问候或唤起注意时,有时可用Hi来代替Hello,显得更为随便。如:

动词be就是我们所学过的am,is,are的动词原形。如何使用这三种形式主要取决于主语。当主语是第一人称I(我)时,用am,缩写为I’m;主语是第二人称you(你)或复数时,用are,缩写为you’re,主语是第三人称it/she/he(它/她/他)或名词及代词的单数时,用is,缩写为it’s/she’s/he’s。如:

Iam(I’m)LiuYing.我是刘英。

Youare(You’re)LinTao.你是林涛。

下面介绍一则口诀,帮你熟记“动词be的构成”:

我(I)用am,你(you)用are,is连着他(he),她(she),它(it)。

单数名词用is,复数名词全用are。

变否定,更容易,be后not加上去。

变疑问,往前提,句末问号莫丢弃。

(1)hello与hi可以互换,都表示“喂,你好”。但hi比hello用得更多,显得更随和亲近,它尤被美国年轻人所使用。但打电话时常用hello而少用hi。熟人、朋友见面时,彼此问候仅仅说声Hi!就可以了。用hello时,不能“Hello,hello,hello”这样反复使用。

(2)要注意hello/hi一般不用于与师长、上级、年长者以及有体面的人打招呼,以免显得对长辈不够尊重。

③Do1CPracticetheconversation。

在英语中如何拼写中国人的姓名,联合国教科文组织已做规定“一律按汉语拼音的写法。姓和名分开,姓在前,名在后”。现举例说明:

(1)如果是单姓,名又是单字,则姓与名的第一个字母要大写,其余字母用小写。如:LiLei李雷。

(2)如果是单姓,名是双字,则姓的第一个字母大写,名的第一个字母大写,名的双字合在一起算一个词,不得分开。如:HanMeimei韩梅梅。

(3)如果是复姓,则把复姓字母连在一起,只是第一个字母大写,名字的拼写方法同上。如:SimaZhao司马昭,OuyangYunsong欧阳云松。

中英姓名比较──中文姓名是姓在前,名在后;英文姓名是姓在后,名在前。Mr用于姓前,如MrGreen不能说成MrJim.

(4)如果名字里有可能造成音的混淆的拼写时,要用连字号“-”或隔音号“’”隔开。如:

YangXi-an(Xi’an)杨西安,如写成YangXian就成了杨仙。

(1)Goodmorning!/Goodafternoon!/Goodevening!分别用于上午、下午、晚上见面问好。

(2)Hello!/Hi!用于朋友或熟悉的人之间相互打招呼。

(3)Nicetomeet/seeyou.该句答语常用Nicetomeet/seeyou,too.

(1)英语口语中多用省略句,如Goodmorning!也可以直接说Morning!

(2)相互熟悉的人见面打招呼用Howareyou?,初次见面一般用Howdoyoudo?

(3)和外国人打招呼时,不要用中国式的问候语,如:你吃饭了吗?你上哪儿去?

(4)Howareyou?原用于询问对方身体状况,现在逐渐失去原来的涵义,成为日常生活中的寒暄用语。

(1)Iam…我是……

(2)Mynameis…我的名字是……

(3)如果询问对方名字,可以问:What’syourname?/MayIhaveyourname?

(1)如果见了长辈或年龄比自己大的人,用Mr.,Miss,Mrs.等称谓词+familyname(姓氏)。

(2)相互熟悉的同龄人之间可以直呼其名。

Bobby是个粗心的孩子,他写完作业不小心将墨水瓶打翻了。有的地方被墨水弄脏了,看不清了。

5.____________this?It'sabook.(what)

1.What'syourname?____________nameisJenny.

2.I'mHardy.____________tomeetyou.

3.Isthisyourbrother?What's____________name?

4.MaryKingis____________newteacher.

5.Hi!Thisis____________newteacher;____________nameisYangyan.

【例1】—yourname,please?—Mynameis.

A.What’s,JimGreenB.Who’s,JimGreen

C.What’s,GreenJimD.Who’s,GreenJim

精析What’syourname,please?询问对方的姓名,回答时用Mynameis…英语国家人的姓名结构顺序为:名+姓,故选A。答案A

【例2】—Hello!—!

精析Hello!与Goodmorning!都是问候语,它们的答语就是其本身,故选B。如:

—Goodmorning,Joan.琼,早上好!

—Goodmorning,WenBo.闻博,早上好!

【例3】Youateacher.Iastudent.Mysisterastudent,too.

A.am;is;areB.is;are;amC.are;am;isD.are;is;is

精析动词be在一般现在时中根据不同的人称有不同的形式,在本题中,You与are连用,I与am连用,Mysister为第三人称单数,应与is连用。答案C

Mike:Nicetomeetyou.LiLei:Nicetomeetyou,too.

(2)MissKing:That’sanicedress.Ann:.

精析(1)某种情况把迈克和李磊聚到一起,他们意识到双方必须相互了解,相互做自我介绍。因此气氛比较随便,自报姓名往往是为了打听对方姓名的一种策略。对别人自报姓名所做出的回答一般是自报自己的姓名。

(2)在西方国家,当有人赞美你时,要说谢谢,而不像中国人习惯在别人赞美你时要表示谦虚。

【例5】用动词be的适当形式填空。

(1)IinRow6.

(2)Whatyourname?

(3)youten?

精析本题考查的是系动词be的用法。系动词be(是),随着主语的人称和数的不同,又分为am,is,are三种不同的形式。Am用于第一人称单数;is用于第三人称单数;are用于第二人称单、复数和第一、三人称复数形式。如:Iam…;Itis…;Youare…。下面这则口诀可帮助记忆:我(I)用am,你(You)用are,is跟着他、她、它,一切复数都用are。答案(1)am(2)is(3)Are

1.SheisastudentandnameisKate.

2.ThisisMissGao.Sheyournewteacher.

七、课后反思:

我的收获:____________________________________________

_______________________________________________________

我的不足:________________________________________________

我努力的方向是____________________________________________

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇6

教材分析

(一).本节内容在教材中的地位与作用

本节是单元第一课时,通过观察多张照片,对其中人物所做事情的讨论,锻炼学生的观察能力及表达能力,通过进一步的游戏环节,拓展新的学习内容,体现了英语教育的趣味性和实用性。

(二).教学目标:

知识目标

1.掌握现在进行时的运用和表达的意思,关注人称和动词的搭配。

2.句型What are you doing?I’m doing sth..What is he/she doing?He/she is doing sth..Is he/she doing sth.?Yes,he/she is.或No,he/she isn’t.3.掌握肯定句和一般疑问句的句型转换及其回答。

4.掌握各种描述动作的词组。

能力目标

1.培养学生学以致用的能力,养成良好的观察能力。

2.培养学生主动参与学习,善于与他人合作学习的能力。

3.提高学生听说读写的能力。

情感目标

培养学生热爱学习,热爱劳动,热爱生活,珍惜生命的积极的人生观。

(三).教学重点、难点

教学重点:What are you doing?I’m doing sth..What is he/she doing?He/she is doing sth..Is he/she doing sth.?Yes,he/she is.或No,he/she isn’t.教学难点:用be doing来表示说话的瞬间正在做某事。

采用让学生动手操作、合作探究、媒体演示的教学方法来突出重点、突破难点。

(四).教具、学具准备(准备好以下相关的教具、学具)

1.教具:多媒体课件。

2.学具:笔、课堂练习本

教法选择与学法指导

本节课主要是对于正在发生的事情进行讨论,先利用欣赏电影片段吸引学生的注意力,教育学生要热爱生活,再利用观看照片来讨论某一瞬间发生的事情。并在课堂教学中将尽量为学生提供参与活动的场景,用任务型教学法让学生进行小组学习,抓住英语交际的机会,感知体验,大胆实践,使学生自得知识、自寻方法、自觅规律、自悟道理。

教学过程设计

Step 1.warm-up

1.Greeting :

Teacher: Hello, everyone.How are you? Today is a nice day, isn’t it?So what do you want to do? And why?点一个举手的学生回答,再面向全班: I like watching TV at home.Because it’s relaxing.Do you want to watch TV?得到肯定回答后,T:Now let’s go to watch TV.进入幻3,点击右下角的铃铛播放电影《泰坦尼克》结尾片段。看完后,T:Do you know its name? Do you like it? Why?学生回答后,老师显示字幕:Don’t let your life.设计目的:通过观看著名的电影片段来吸引学生的注意力,向学生灌输热爱生活珍惜生命的情感教育。

Step2.导入

1、T:I have some photos.展示幻4的照片:Look!This is my life.I’mdoing some things at home.用红外线灯照射每张照片,学生可以通过照片明白句子的意思。老师指着每张照片带读句子(同时做出相应的动作):I’m watching TV/cleaning/reading/talking on the phone/playing computer games/teaching.认读完最后一张自己上课的照片后,T: what’s my job?...yes,I’m a teacher.然后老师设计打电话的场景:hello, thisisMiss is a nice day.I’m watching TV at home.What about you?进行师生间的对话,起示范作用,让学生能仿造使用幻灯片上的句子回答,并对能使用其他动作回答的同学予以奖励。每个be doing形式都用红色标注,提示学生注意。

设计目的:通过展示老师自己的照片吸引学生的注意,输出新知识,用带读和创设情境的对话形式,让学生初步理解并能表达自己正在做某事。

Step 3:教授新课

展示幻5,T:now,let’s look at other photos.Who is in these photos?老师问几个举手的学生:what are you doing?然后让学生仿照进行pairwork活动:Can you ask your friend ‘what are you doing’?并请几组进行演示,每组演示之后,老师问大家:what is…doing?借机转换人称。

设计目的:创情设景,用学生自己的schoollife照片让大家有话可说,并可借机转换人称,转入下一环节。

展示幻6,T:now,we are in a happy apartment.These people are doing some things.Let’s listen to the conversation.Then tell me: What are these people doing?听完录音后,T ask S1:what is Jenny doing? S1: she is watching TV.T点击屏幕检验。T转向S2:Can you ask your friend about Dave and Mary?然后用以上问句依次请几组同学对图中人物内容进行问答。

设计目的:充分挖掘听力材料,利用其锻炼学生们的听说能力,并成功实现转换人称的问答,使学生能了解并掌握如何询问其他人正在做什么及其回答。

Step 4:合作学习

展示幻7,T:now,let’s make a survey in your group.What are your friends doing now? I’ll give you 3 minutes.You can ask 4 friends, and write down on the chart, then make a report.3分钟之后,T: Can you make a report?请每组派一代表汇报,并进行奖励,T可以插入问句:what is … doing ?。

设计目的:通过小组活动培养学生的合作学习能力和认真聆听他人的良好习惯。

Step 5:拓展新知

1、展示幻8,T:Look!Tom is doing something.Do you know, what is Tom doing?Oh, let me guess.Is Tom writing? S: No, he isn’t.T继续猜,直到S说Yes, he is.为止。点击可检验答案。再点击出现下一个人物。重复以上老师猜,学生答的活动。

设计目的:因为此片内容是书上有的,学生知道谜底,所以由老师做示范来猜,学生回答,锻炼学生认真听的习惯。

2、展示幻9,T:Now, It’our fun time.Do you know this cat? What’s his name? S:...T: yes, he’s Tom.Now,Let’s talk about these pictures.You can ask your friends in your group,what is Tom doing?3 students as a group.And One ask, the others answer.每组发一份图片进行组内讨论。份图片进行组内讨论。3分钟后请几组学生演示,T:You can ask 2 questions.3人一组,一人用红灯照射图片问,另两人答,奖励表现良好的小组。

设计目的:在重温对话what is he doing?的同时,了解各图的内容,为下一环节做铺垫。

3、点击出现幻10和问句Is Tom sleeping?T: Now, What is Tom doing? Is Tom sleeping?(T做睡觉的动作)全班看着图片齐答:Yes, he is.或No, he isn’t.T:Who wants to guess the next picture?请一个学生上台来背对屏幕玩猜谜游戏:示意全班问他:What is Tom doing?此学生边做动作边猜测:Is Tom drinking?全班齐答Yes,he is.或No,he isn’t.猜到者有奖。

设计目的:在游戏中学,在快乐中锻炼听说能力,避免了枯燥的教与学。

Step 6:语法总结

请一个学生对于此课所学进行总结,老师给予及时的评论,并点击进入幻11展示语法小结:现在进行时态。

设计目的:初一的内容是基础教学,语法在最后有必要呈现出来,让大家知道所学内容的专业术语。让学生自己总结更能加深印象。

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇7

2 give sb sth = give sth to sb 给某人某物 / 把某物给某人

3 help sb do sth 帮助某人作某事 Eg: I want to help my mother do some housework at home.

4 help sb with sth 帮助某人谋事 Eg: I want to help my mother with some housework at home

8 be busy doing sth 忙于做某事 Eg: He is busy listening to the teacher.

① What + is / are + sb?

② What + does/ do + sb + do?

③ What + is/ are + 名词所有格/ 形容词性物主代词 + job?

2 People give me their money or get their money from me.

3 Sometimes I work in the day and sometimes at night.

4 I like talking to people.

5 I work late. I’m very busy when people go out to dinners.

6 Where does your sister work?

7 then we have a job for you as a waiter.

8 Do you want to work for a magazine? Then come and work for us as a reporter.

9 Do you like to work evenings and weekends?

10 We are an international school for children of 5-12.

1 policeman- policemen 2 woman doctor- women doctors 3 thief-thieves

注意:

◎ policeman和policewoman的复数形式是policemen和policewo-men,postman 和post woman也是如此

◎如waiter和waitress、actor和actress是有男女区别的,在形容女士时要注意

原句:I want to be an actor.

Eg: He wants a book. want to do sth 想要做某事

Eg: She wants to go out. want sb to do sth 想让某人做某事

want to be …想成为……

Eg:I want to be an actor.

work for sb as a/an…

1、三种人称:第一人称(I, we),第二人称(you, you),第三人称(he, she, it, Maria)。

2、人称代词的主格,即人称代词位于句子主语位置时的形态:I, We, You, You, He, She, It, Maria。

3、人称代词的宾格,即人称代词位于句子宾语位置时的形态:me, us, you, you, him, her, it。

4、形容词性物主代词:my, our, your, your, his, her, its, their。

5、名词性物主代词:mine, ours, yours, yours, his, hers, its, theirs。

6、反身代词:myself, ourselves, yourself, yourselves, himself, herself, itself, themselves。

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇8

七年级下册完形填空专项训练

On Sundays, Li Lei gets up at six thirty.He hasthe housework(家务劳动).At ten o’clock he leaves18and goes shopping19bike.At about eleven o’clock he comes20home.He likes()25.A.say B.think C.don’t think D.thinking

I have a good friend.Her name is Kate.She is American girl.She is eleven.She with her family in China.There are people in her family.They’re her father, her mother, her brother and herself(她自己).very much.He helps his mother with the cooking.Theylunch at twelve.In the afternoon he often games with his friends.They haveat six thirty.In the evening he does his homework.Sometimes, he TV.He goes to bed at nine.()16.A.foodB.breakfastC.lunchD.supper()17.A.inB.onC.withD.from()18.A.homeB.houseC.roomD.classroom()19.A.byB.onC.inD.at()20.A.forB.toC.backD.from()21.okingC.the cookD.the cooking()22.A.to haveB.havingC.haveD.has()23.A.playsB.is playingC.takesD.is taking()24.B.homeworkC.houseworkD.dinner()25.A.seesB.looksC.is watchingD.watches

It is raining outside.A bus at a small bus stop.A man out of the window.He sees a woman.She is sellinga cake.But he doesn’t want to go out because it is raining.The man sees a boy.The boy isthe window.“Come here, boy, ” the man says, “Do you know the cake is?” “Twenty fen.” the boy says.The manthe boy forty fen and asks him to buy two cakes.“One is for you andis for me, ” he says to the boy.Afterminutes, the boy comes back.He a cake.He gives the man twenty fen and says, “Sorry, there is only one cake left.”()16.A.stop B.is stopping C.stopping D.stops()17.A.looks B.look C.is looking D.are looking()18.A.cake B.bread C.cakes D.flowers()19.A.buy B.buys C.to buy D.buying()20.A.near B.on C.in D.of()21.A.how much B.how many C.whose D.what()22.A.buys B.borrows C.sells D.gives()23.A.another B.the others C.one D.the other()24.A.much B.a C.a few D.a little()25.A.have B.is having C.having D.has

This is our school.There is a very nice in our school.It is big and bright(明亮的).It has allof books and newspapers in it.We canstory books, picture books, English books and manybooks there.We cando some reading there.Maria likes reading very much.She goes to the library every day.Look, she and reading by the window(窗口).Li Ming borrows some books and reads them in it.He likes books.I’m going to borrow an story book.Our English teacher often us to do more speaking and reading.I like English very much.II can do well in English.What about your school?()16.A.dining room B.classroom C.library D.playground()17.A.kind B.kinds C.many D.lots()18.A.borrow B.buy C.look D.see()19.A.others B.another C.the other D.other()20.A.both B.also C.not D.too()21.A.is sitting B.sits C.to sit D.sitting()22.A.never B.seldom C.can’t D.usually()23.A.interesting B.English C.Chinese D.American()24.A.says B.speaks C.tells D.talks

She has a cat.name is Mimi.It’s Sunday today.Theyat home.Look!Kate with Mimi.Her father is reading newspapers.Her mother is cleaning the house.Where is her brother Jim? He is doing homework in his study.Kate’t it very well.Jim likes soccer.He can play it very well.()21.A.a B.an C.the D./()22. B.living C.to live s()23.A.five B.four C.six D.three()24.A.It B.It’s C.Its D.It is()25.A.are all B.are not C.all are D.not are()26.A.play B.plays C.playing D.is playing()27.A.he B.his C.her D.my()28.A.like B.to like C.likes D.liking()29.A.speak B.tell C.say D.talk()30.A.play B.plays C.to play D.playing

Hi!My name is Li Weikang.I’m fourteen years old.I’m Class 4, Grade I’d like you something about our classroom.Wea big and bright(明亮的)classroom.There are twenty-four boys and twenty-two girls in our class.So there aredesks and chairs in the classroom.There are two blackboards in it,desk.Some flowers are on it.There are two maps the wall.One is a map of China, andis a map of the world(世界).There is a book shelf24the back of the classroom.We have lessons here and we our classroom every day.Our classroom is very nice and I like it very much.()16.A.atB.on C.in D.out()17.A.to tell B.telling C.there are D.tell()18.A.there is B.has C.there are D.have()19.A.forty-five B.fifty-six C.forty-eight D.forty-six()20.A.also B.too C.near D.early()21.A.teacher’s B.teacher C.teachers D.teachers’()22.A.on B.in C.under D.behind()23.A.other B.others C.the other D.the others()24.A.in B.on C.at D./()25.A.are cleaning B.clean C.cleaning D.to clean

Different people live in different kinds of houses.Li Lei is a student.He in an apartment.He thinks the apartmentwonderful.Jane’s home isfrom her school.So she lives in the dormitory(宿舍)her classmates and friends.The Greens have a big farm in the countryside.They live in a They think it’s quiet andthere. lives in a townhouse.She lives with her She thinks it’s convenient(方便的).kind of house do you live in? What do you it? Please me an e-mail to wonghong@.Thank you!()16.s es C.studies D.walks()17.A.are B.is C.am D.be()18.A.go B.behind C.near D.far()19.A.at B.on C.with D.in()20.A.apartment B.farmhouse C.townhouse D.dormitory()21.A.beautiful B.quiet C.clean D.careful()22.A.father B.family C.mother D.brother()23.A.Why B.When C.What D.Where

()24.A.like to B.like C.think D.think of()25.A.give B.gives C.giving D.to give

Mrs.Green lives in the country, and she doesn’t know London very well.One day, she goes to London, but she can’t find hera man near the bus stop.“ I can ask him the way,” she,“ Excuse me, will you please

me the way to King Street?”’t say anything.He is ’t speak for a and writes something on it.Then he it to Mrs.Green,“Sorry, I can’t speak English.”()16.A.street B.way C.room D.house()17.A.looks at B.watches C.sees D.looks()18.A.thinks B.to think C.is thinking D.think()19.A.speak B.say C.talk D.tell()20.A.And B.So C.But D.Because()21.A.on B.from C.in D.at()22.A.English B.Japanese C.Chinese D.French()23.A.walk B.swim C.visit D.look()24.A.pencil B.wallet C.book D.glass()25.s B.gives C.gets D.takes

Li Ming comes out of the train station.He wants to see his friend, Lin Tao.Lin Tao is a He works in Zhongshan Hospital in this city.But Li Ming the way to the hospital.This is his Li Ming walks on the street out of the school gate.He comes over and “Excuse me, can you tell me the way to Zhongshan?”

“Yes, I live near here.27uncle works in that hospital, too.It’s not28here.Go along this road to the end, and you’ll find theon your right.You can’t it,”a boy says,“It’s about 500 meters from here.”

“Thank you very much!”()21.A.student B.friend C.teacher D.doctor()22.A.knows B.know C.don’t know D.doesn’t know()23.A.first B.one C.two D.last()24.A.early B.late C.alone D.only()25.A.walks B.to walk C.are walking D.walk()26.A.tells B.asks C.speaks D.talks()27.A.Mine B.Me C.My D.I()28.A.far B.away from C.far away D.far from()29.A.school B.hospital C.station D.bank()30.A.miss B.get C.take D.give

It’s November 6th today.Ben and Lisa want to buy a birthday.It’s their birthday.“What does she ?” Ben asks Lisa.“I don’t know.” Lisa says, “We bought(买)her some chocolates last time.” “Yes, ” Ben says, “and we ate(吃)them!We mustn’t do that.” “Let’s buy her a book.She likes“What kind of books would she like?” Ben asks.“I don’t know.” Lisa says, “Let’s go ask her.”

The children go into the living room.Mrs.Wilson is watching TV.“We want to buy a bookyou, Mom.” Lisa says.“What book do you want?” “money do you have?” Their mother asks them.“We have twenty-five yuan.” Ben says.“Good.That’s enough(足够的)for the book I want.It is Quick and Easy Cooking.”

The children buy their mother the book for her birthday.They her present this time, but they often eat the food she cooksit.They are very happy.()16.A.book B.cake C.cards D.present()17.A.Ben B.Lisa’s C.mother D.mother’s()18.A.need B.needs C.to need D.needing()19.A.before B.when C.again D.after()20.A.read B.is reading C.to read D.reading()21.A.or B.and C.so D.but()22.A.to B.on C.about D.for()23.A.How much B.How often C.How many D.What()24.A.not eat B.eat C.don’t eat D.eats()25.A.from B.about C.with D.for

Han Meimei is a beautiful Chinese girl.She is 14 years old.She is a.She is

Class 4,Grade 7.Music is her favorite at school.In hertime, Meimei likes singing and dancing.She sings and dances at home.And she also likes playing

piano.She can play it very.She wants a musician(音乐家).Tomorrow she will go to birthday party.She’d like to dance and sing at the()16.A.girl B.student C.nurse D.teacher()17.A.at B.on C.in D.out()18.A.subject B.class C.star D.lesson()19. B.study C.rest D.free()20.A.never B.seldom C.often D.too()21.A./B.the C.a D.an()22.A.well B.good C.much D.little()23.A.to B.be C.to be D.being()24.A.Kang kangs’ B.Kangkangs C.Kangkang D.Kangkang’s()25.A.house B.party C.hall D.yard

Junjun wanted to buy a birthday present for his mother.But hemuch money.He was not happy.He thought and thought.Then he had.He could make aa beautiful picture of birds and flowers.And on the back he ,“To my dear mother, I love you very much.Happy birthday!”

his mother’s birthday, Junjun gave her the present.After she saw the , tears(眼泪)fell down her face.“are you crying(哭),Mom?”Junjun asked, “You don’t like it, right?”“”She said, “I love it very much.I’m the happiest(最幸福的)25

because I have a great son like you.”()16.A.didn’t have B.not have C.has D.had()17.A.a problem B.an idea C.a wish D.an office()18.A.present B.plane C.dinner D.book()19.A.draws B.draw C.drew D.drawing()20.A.said B.writes C.wrote D.says()21.A.At B.In C.Out D.On()22.A.bag B.cake C.book D.card()23.A.when B.why C.what D.Where()24.A.Of course B.Of course not C.Yes, it is D.No, it isn’t()25.A.people B.one C.mother D.father

Dear Alice,Yesterday was my thirteenth birthday.I a wonderful day.In the morning my parents

with me.They bought a beautiful dressme.It’s yellow.I like it very much.Then theyme to a restaurant.We had lunch there.The food was After lunch we went to a pet shop.My mother me a little dog.It has big black eyes.It’s very cute.In the evening, I had a birthday with my friends.They bought me a birthday cake.They also me a lot of presents.We sang, danced and played games.All the shows were very and I was so happy.Wish youmy birthday party one day.Write to me soon!

Yours, Lisa

()26.A.have B.has C.am havingD.had

()27.A.went shopping B.go shopping C.goes shoppingD.going shopping()28.A.to B.for C.atD.of()29.A.take B.takes C.tookD.to take()30.A.delicious B.good C.sunnyD.well()31.A.found B.got C.wantedD.put()32.A.cake B.present C.partyD.meeting()33.A.brings B.to bring C.broughtD.bring()34.A.interesting B.late C.earlyD.difficult()35.e to ing to C.to comeD.to come to

Dear Kangkang,How is it going? I have to tell you.Last Sunday, my family went to Beidaihecar.We got there at about 9:30 a.m.It was fine.There were many people in the water.We changed clothes,to the water and swam in it.After an hour, we had a rest andsome water.Then Mom, Kate and I the sand(沙子)to build some beautiful houses.Dad went back to swim again.At noon, the sun and it was very hot.We ate some food a big umbrella.After lunch, we walked on the sand and some photos.Suddenly(突然), it windy and cloudy.We had to go home at once.But when we got back home, it was sunny in Beijing.I had a wonderful day.Yours,Michael

()16.A.everything interesting B.anything interestingC.something interesting D.nothing interesting()17.A.drive B.by C.inD.on()18.A.to swim B.swam C.swimD.swimming()19.A.walk C.ranD.walking()20.A.drank B.ate C.haveD.drink()21.A.use B.used C.makeD.made

()22.A.shines brightly B.shining brightly C.shone brightlyD.shine brightly()23.A.under B.in C.onD.at()24.A.had B.took C.gotD.brought()25.A.changed B.changes C.turnedD.gets

May Day is coming.We are makingfor traveling.We’ll go on a to Hainan.It’s a good for holidays and my aunt lives there, too.I hope with her.My mother also this holiday will come very soon.Sanya is a beautiful city in Hainan.It’s

in May.When we get there, we’ll see flowers everywhere(到处).I canskirts there.We can see the sea(大海)there and swim in the sea.We’lla lot of photos.We also want to visit some other places of.Oh, I think the food there is differentours.It must be very delicious.It’s wonderful!()16.A.cards B.plans C.foodD.clothes()17.A.trip B.picnic C.planD.holiday()18.A.way B.place C.seasonD.time

()19.A.traveled B.traveling C.travelD.to travel

()20.A.hoping B.hopes C.hopeD.hoped()21.A.hot B.warm ()22.A.put on B.puts on C.wearD.wears()23.A.carry B.get C.bringD.take()24.A.interesting B.interested C.interestsD.interest()25.A.from B.of C.forD.at

The Spring Festival is our Chinese people’s special festival.Itin January or February.There are twelve different animal nameseach Chinese year.They are mouse, tiger, rabbit, chicken, dragon 蛇).the Spring Festival, people are busy shopping and cleaning their houses.Every family

many kinds of food and drinks.On the eve of the festival, there isa big family dinner.People like eating jiaozi—dumplings.It reunion(团聚)”and“good luck.”After dinner all the family stay up the New Year.They often watch TV and play games.On the first day of the lunar New Year, peopletheir new clothes and go to visit relatives(亲戚)and friends.They say“Happy New Year”and give the best wishes to25.Everyone has a great time.()16.A.will come es C.came D.is coming()17.A.for B.in C.on D.to()18.A.later on B.right away C.and so on D.as well()19.A.After B.On C.When D.Before()20.A.prepares B.are preparing C.prepare for D.prepared()21.A.never B.seldom C.sometimes D.always()22.A.meant B.means C.like D.likes()23.A.welcome B.stop C.to welcome D.to stop()24.A.wear in B.put on C.dress D.be in()25.A.every other B.the others C.each other D.one other

People celebrate Mother’s Day in the USA.It’s also a holiday in somecountries.It is onSunday in May.It’s a daymothers.On this day mothers usually get flowers and cardstheir children.On the cards children will “Thanks, Mom”,“To my dearest mother”,“Best wishes for Mother’s Day”and so on.How does the for this holidays come? It was from Miss Anna M.Jarris.She in Virginia(弗吉尼亚).Her mother loved her very much.And she loved her mother very much, too.But her mother died(死)she was young.After that, she wrote letters to some important people.In her letters she asked them a day for all mothers.Then the first Mother’s Dayon the second Sunday in May, 1913 in the USA.()21.A.else B.other C.others D.the other()22.A.second B.two C.the second D.twice()23.A.to thank B.for thanks C.for thank D.to miss()24.A.toB.for C.from D.with()25.A.say B.write C.talk D.speak()26.A.sound B.area C.service D.idea()27.A.is born B.were born C.born D.was born()28.A.because B.before C.when D.after()29.A.to decide B.decided C.decide D.deciding()30.A.falls B.fallingC.fell D.fall

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇9

本节是单元第一课时,通过观察多张照片,对其中人物所做事情的讨论,锻炼学生的观察能力及表达能力,通过进一步的游戏环节,拓展新的学习内容,体现了英语教育的趣味性和实用性。

1.掌握现在进行时的运用和表达的意思,关注人称和动词的搭配。

2.句型What are you doing?I’m doing sth..

What is he/she doing?He/she is doing sth..

Is he/she doing sth.?Yes,he/she is.或No,he/she isn’t.

3.掌握肯定句和一般疑问句的句型转换及其回答。

1.培养学生学以致用的能力,养成良好的`观察能力。

2.培养学生主动参与学习,善于与他人合作学习的能力。

培养学生热爱学习,热爱劳动,热爱生活,珍惜生命的积极的人生观。

教学重点:What are you doing?I’m doing sth..

What is he/she doing?He/she is doing sth..

Is he/she doing sth.?Yes,he/she is.或No,he/she isn’t.

教学难点:用be doing来表示说话的瞬间正在做某事。

采用让学生动手操作、合作探究、媒体演示的教学方法来突出重点、突破难点。

本节课主要是对于正在发生的事情进行讨论,先利用欣赏电影片段吸引学生的注意力,教育学生要热爱生活,再利用观看照片来讨论某一瞬间发生的事情。并在课堂教学中将尽量为学生提供参与活动的场景,用任务型教学法让学生进行小组学习,抓住英语交际的机会,感知体验,大胆实践,使学生自得知识、自寻方法、自觅规律、自悟道理。

1.Greeting :

Teacher: Hello, everyone. How are you? Today is a nice day, isn’t it?So what do you want to do? And why?点一个举手的学生回答,再面向全班: I like watching TV at home. Because it’s relaxing. Do you want to watch TV?得到肯定回答后,T:Now let’s go to watch TV.进入幻3,点击右下角的铃铛播放电影《泰坦尼克》结尾片段。看完后,T:Do you know its name? Do you like it? Why?学生回答后,老师显示字幕:Don’t let go. Love your life.

设计目的:通过观看著名的电影片段来吸引学生的注意力,向学生灌输热爱生活珍惜生命的情感教育。

1、T:I have some photos.展示幻4的照片:Look! This is my life.I’mdoing some things at home.用红外线灯照射每张照片,学生可以通过照片明白句子的意思。老师指着每张照片带读句子(同时做出相应的动作):I’m watching TV/cleaning/reading/talking on the phone/playing computer games/teaching.认读完最后一张自己上课的照片后,T: what’s my job? ... yes,I’m a teacher.

然后老师设计打电话的场景:hello, thisisMiss Liu. Today is a nice day. I’m watching TV at home. What about you?进行师生间的对话,起示范作用,让学生能仿造使用幻灯片上的句子回答,并对能使用其他动作回答的同学予以奖励。每个be doing形式都用红色标注,提示学生注意。

设计目的:通过展示老师自己的照片吸引学生的注意,输出新知识,用带读和创设情境的对话形式,让学生初步理解并能表达自己正在做某事。

展示幻5,T:now,let’s look at other photos. Who is in these photos?老师问几个举手的学生:what are you doing?然后让学生仿照进行pairwork活动:Can you ask your friend ‘what are you doing’?并请几组进行演示,每组演示之后,老师问大家:what is…doing?借机转换人称。

设计目的:创情设景,用学生自己的schoollife照片让大家有话可说,并可借机转换人称,转入下一环节。

展示幻6,T:now,we are in a happy apartment. These people are doing some things. Let’s listen to the conversation. Then tell me: What are these people doing?听完录音后,T ask S1:what is Jenny doing? S1: she is watching TV.T点击屏幕检验。T转向S2:Can you ask your friend about Dave and Mary?然后用以上问句依次请几组同学对图中人物内容进行问答。

设计目的:充分挖掘听力材料,利用其锻炼学生们的听说能力,并成功实现转换人称的问答,使学生能了解并掌握如何询问其他人正在做什么及其回答。

展示幻7,T:now,let’s make a survey in your group. What are your friends doing now? I’ll give you 3 minutes. You can ask 4 friends, and write down on the chart, then make a report.3分钟之后,T: Can you make a report?请每组派一代表汇报,并进行奖励,T可以插入问句:what is … doing ?。

设计目的:通过小组活动培养学生的合作学习能力和认真聆听他人的良好习惯。

1、展示幻8,T:Look! Tom is doing something. Do you know, what is Tom doing?Oh, let me guess. Is Tom writing? S: No, he isn’t. T继续猜,直到S说Yes, he is.为止。点击可检验答案。再点击出现下一个人物。重复以上老师猜,学生答的活动。

设计目的:因为此片内容是书上有的,学生知道谜底,所以由老师做示范来猜,学生回答,锻炼学生认真听的习惯。

2、展示幻9,T:Now, It’our fun time. Do you know this cat? What’s his name? S: ... T: yes, he’s Tom.Now,Let’s talk about these pictures. You can ask your friends in your group,what is Tom doing?3 students as a group. And One ask, the others answer .每组发一份图片进行组内讨论。份图片进行组内讨论。3分钟后请几组学生演示,T:You can ask 2 questions.3人一组,一人用红灯照射图片问,另两人答,奖励表现良好的小组。

设计目的:在重温对话what is he doing?的同时,了解各图的内容,为下一环节做铺垫。

3、点击出现幻10和问句Is Tom sleeping?T: Now, What is Tom doing? Is Tom sleeping? (T做睡觉的动作)全班看着图片齐答:Yes, he is.或No, he isn’t.

T:Who wants to guess the next picture?请一个学生上台来背对屏幕玩猜谜游戏:示意全班问他:What is Tom doing?此学生边做动作边猜测:Is Tom drinking?全班齐答Yes,he is.或No,he isn’t.猜到者有奖。

设计目的:在游戏中学,在快乐中锻炼听说能力,避免了枯燥的教与学。

请一个学生对于此课所学进行总结,老师给予及时的评论,并点击进入幻11展示语法小结:现在进行时态。

设计目的:初一的内容是基础教学,语法在最后有必要呈现出来,让大家知道所学内容的专业术语。让学生自己总结更能加深印象。

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇10

课件介绍及使用说明

本课件是为仁爱英语七年级上学期Unit 4 Topic 1 What can I do for you? Section A编写的教学课件。本单元内容主要围绕购物、打电话、表达时间以及谈论自己喜欢的事物和动物展开。本课要求学生学习并掌握购物的基本用语,掌握1000以内数字的读写方法,并能正确回应别人的感谢。本课件紧扣教学目标,直观生动,易于操作。

导入----①课堂活动,齐唱3b歌曲,活跃课堂气氛。

②听课文3a语音部分。

③复习数字1-20。

(幻灯片2-5。注:幻灯片2, 点击影片1播放3b歌曲;幻灯片3, 点击录音1播放3a语音部分。)

呈现----呈现人民币图片,学习数字21-999的读法和写法。

(幻灯片6-12)

巩固----①听2a 录音,跟读,完成表格,并记忆。

②听2b录音,完成连线。

③导入How much,学习价格询问方式。

④导出1a中的重点句型进行训练讲解。

⑤观看1a的动画,回答:How much is the coat?

(幻灯片13-18。注:幻灯片13,点击录音2播放2a录音;幻灯片14,点击录音3播放2b录音;幻灯片18,点击影片2播放1a动画,在听力练习中可以点击动画中的title键消去字幕,增加难度。)

练习----①再听一遍1a,完成1b。

②模仿1a内容进行快乐购物,并完成对话。

(幻灯片19-20。注:幻灯片19,点击影片2播放1a动画,)

小结----①总结数字1-999的读法和写法。

②总结有用的表达方式。

(幻灯片21)

作业----①复习数字21-999的读法和写法。

②背诵1a。

③预习Section B。

(幻灯片22)

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇11

一、说教材

(一)教材的地位和作用: 我今天要说的是初中牛津英语7A第一单元(This is me)中的第四课时的语法这一部分。该单元通过学习,让学生学会介绍自己和别人,从而培养学生学习英语的兴趣。本教材《牛津初中英语》以任务性教学为主导,十分重视语法教学。语法部分是整个单元六个板块中的第四板块,主要是梳理本单元出现的重点语言现象,对前面出现的语言现象进行的归纳和总结,帮助我们更好地掌握语法规则。同时也为本单元后面几个板块中新词汇的运用,尤其是后面的Task写作课奠定基础。本课时的教学内容安排:首先,用图表的形式呈现了本课学习内容,be动词与各种主语人称的搭配用法以及be动词在一般现在时态中的肯定句,否定句以及一般疑问句形式。其次,设置be动词运用的真实语境。第三,综合运用,循序渐进的使学生对be动词的使用规律有更深入的认识。这种安排方法虽然符合学生学习的一般规律,但是直接把语法内容不经修饰呈现出来难免使学生觉得枯燥。

(二)教学目标的确立和依据

be动词学生在小学已经学过,相对来说比较简单。部分学生掌握的比较好,还有部分学生you’re和第三人称单、复数分不清。而本课正好起到一个巩固和扩展延伸的作用。结合教材和本班学生的实际情况,我确定如下教学目标:

1、知识目标:

1).能正确听说读写本课四会单词和短语。如:classroom和overthere

2).能理解be动词一般现在时态中的用法.3).掌握be动词一般现在时的肯定句、否定句、疑问句的构成和一般用法。

2、能力目标:学生会正确完成本科时的相关练习和能流利地用be动词以及所学句型结合本单元话题进行情景会话。

3、情感目标:本节课学生在学习语法知识的同时还能通过讨论发现交流的乐趣,培养合作的精神。通过创设真实的情景激发学生学习英语的兴趣。

(三)重点和难点

重点:学生理解和掌握be动词的相关内容和用法,能够正确使用be动词的三种句型,能较好完成be动词的相关练习题目。

难点:运用be动词结合本单元话题进行简单的情景对话。由于本课内容比较枯燥,如果直接展示语法规则,我通过多媒体教学,创设学生熟悉的情境、师生共同讨论、小组合作等方式,以及不断鼓励的方法突破重难点。

二、说教法

《新课标》强调培养学生的语言综合运用能力,针对本课的内容比较枯燥,对于学生现有的认知水平,采用启发式、情景教学式、导入式和归纳法进行探究性学习。这一教学方法的具体运用分别体现为图片演示以及小组对话两种形式。而“归纳法”主要通过学生的亲身实践归纳总结出来的语法会加深他们对语法的理解,更易于记忆,又使学生在逐步掌握英语知识和技能的同时,养成良好的学习习惯和形成有效的学习策略,发展自主学习的能力。我选用了一些图片并运用计算机辅助教学。

三、说学法 通过新旧知识比较法、小组合作学习法和任务型操练法,从而增加学习内容的趣味性,调动学生的学习兴趣,使全员参与,达到寓教于乐的效果。

四、教学过程 1.Lead in

通过复习Reading部分与be动词有关的重点句子导入本节课的教学内容be动词。并通过语言描述向学生呈现一般现在时和本课的学习目标。

2、Presentation 利用多媒体上的例句和图片创设情境,向学生呈现一般现在时中be动词的各种形式和用法。尤其是指导学生掌握各种人称代词和be动词的正确搭配,缩写形式,以及与名词的正确使用。接下来我安排学生小组合作讨论,归纳总结出be动词的用法。借助多媒体这一教学工具,利用出示图片或英文解释的方式直观教学,学生一目了然,尤其是小口诀的使用能帮助学生很快的记住规则。接下来我做了投影练习以及一个游戏,其目的是想再次帮助学生巩固了be动词的用法。

3、Presentation

利用图片,创设情境向学生呈现be动词的否定句,启发学生根据例句归纳总结改写be动词否定句的变化规则。紧接着我用练习巩固。利用相同的方法,向学生教授了be动词的一般疑问句的变化规则。这种例句感知、讨论归纳总结、实践操练地教学结构符合学生的认知规律,学习效果良好。

4.Practice

再次点出本课学习中的重点和难点,加深学生的印象。并完成书本P12的相关练习巩固本节课的知识。

nsolidation

1).指导学生完成表格内容,简单介绍一下别人。

2).通过课课练本课时的练习查漏补缺、及时巩固

6.Homework

五、教学创新

1、注重教学内容呈现的多样性。通过多媒体教学和图片的展示,可以使学生的听觉、视觉等多种器官参与英语活动,能更容易地引起并保持学生的学习兴趣,最大限度地调动学生的学习积极性。

2、注重课堂互动与以学生为主体

整节课我始终坚持先让学生例句感知、归纳讨论总结规律、再加以练习实践操练地教学模式,符合学生认知规律,以学生为主体,有利于培养学生合作意识和自主学习的能力。

仁爱七年级英语教案 篇12

仁爱英语七年级Unit3 Topic2 Section A教学反思

转载2015-10-12 16:12:24 标签:教学反思

清远市吕丽萍工作室 林燕

2013年11月18日星期一上午第二节课,本人在飞来峡一中七(6)班上了一堂英语公开课,课题为仁爱英语七年级Unit3 Topic2 SectionA 以下是我对这节课的教学反思: 一、七年级仁爱版英语教材,在我市初中学校使用已多年了。本人英语教学经历,对其有些感想。本教材向我们展开了浓缩当今世界原貌的万里画卷,它深入浅出地为我们展示生活的细节,诠释情感的真谛。它不仅给我们文化积淀,而且它那些最美、最人性的元素将会通过语言一点一滴地浸染,渗透我们的血液。它让我们胸怀天下,让我们感觉我们不仅是中国公民,而且也是世界的一员。

二、本人施教小结反思如下:

1、利用直观教具,通过出示图画或照片,使语言学习更加容易。

2、对重点掌握的英语词和句子结构进行备课。

3、指导学生结对,两人一组对语言互动练习,在课堂上展示各小组成绩,或完成一段对话或一段表演。

4、运用交际游戏,为学习语言互动创造机会。

5、把全班学生分成合作学习小组。分组协作共同完成一项任务。

6、角色表演学习词汇,创设情景短剧达到学习新词汇并使用词汇。

三、今后工作将在以下几点上下功夫。

1、努力改善学生学习的方式,提倡参与、探究、体验、主动、创新、合作、自主等方式。

2、学习“用教材”而不是“教教材”。努力开发学习资源,整合学习资料。

3、创设英语学习环境,课堂尽量使用英语教学,每月举办一次英语活动,多用可视资料。

在本节课中我创设了真实情景,设置了一些问题吸引学生导入新课。在授课中注意了呈现知识点从简单到难。针对本节课的内容,设置了不同的任务让学生成为课堂的主要表演者。通过出示一些生动的图片、简笔画、合适的竞争来练习学生的英语口语和激发学生的学习兴趣。在课堂中充分地肯定、表扬学生,这样学生就能自信而快乐地学习英语。激发学生积极性的方法是很多的,只要用心去想,用心去做,总会有意想不到的收获。

jk251.cOm扩展阅读

七年级下册英语教案锦集五篇


如果您正在寻找关于“七年级下册英语教案”方面的建议。每位老师不可或缺的课件是教案课件,因此教案课件可能就需要每天都去写。教案反映了教师的专业水平和实践经验。希望我的故事能够让您更加感受到人性的美好!

七年级下册英语教案 篇1

Can you play theguitar?

教学过程

1、第一次“先学后教”:(认读词汇、记汉语意思和校正发音。)

(1)、出示学习指导

1) 能掌握以下单词:(能做到四会)

guitar, sing,swim, dance, chess, play chess, draw, speak, speak English, join, club…

(2)、先学。

1、学生根据自己掌握的语音知识,认读英语单词并记住汉语意思。

2、学生听单词录音,画出自己读错的或不会读的单词。

(3)、后教。

教师播放单词录音,学生跟读,校正自己的发音,对于难以记忆的单词,教师指导学生根据字母组合、发音要领寻找规律,进行记忆。有必要时教师写在黑板上让学生记住并积累字母组合的发音。

(4)、当堂训练

1)、单词默写训练、开火车拼读单词训练。

2)、Ss look at the picture in 1a.Then read the words and phrases. Let Ss match the activities with the people.Then Check the answers with the class together.

3)、Presentation

出示一些反映各种活动的图片、幻灯片或播放课件,引导学生谈论活动:

He/Shecan dance/swim/sing/"··ButI can’t dance/swim/sing/...等,学习表达活动的动词短语。

4)、Game (What can I do?)

T: Tell yourpartners what you can do. For example:

I can playthe guitar. I can sing and dance.

Ss work in groups. The let some Ss talk totheir classmates in front of the class.

2、第二次“先学后教”:(听录音,理解课文大意)

(!)、出示自学指导。

1)、用最快的速度大概的看看听力题,对题的内容有一点了解。

2)、仔细听录音能听懂录音内容并独立完成填序号题和填空题。

(2)、先学。

1、根据学情,适当增加或减少录音播放次数。

2、学生听录音,并回答浅层次问题。

(3)、后教

1)、能了解以下语法:情态动词can的用法和want todo sth.的用法。

2)、教师公布答案,学生同桌相互改,教师统计学生的自学结果。(分优、良、差)

3)、积极鼓励后进生回答,出现问题学生更正。

4)、难度较大通过讨论仍解决不了的问题,教师通过启发诱导进行点拔解决,并板书于黑板。

Listening

1. T: Now let’s listen to the tape, findout the right conversation, and number them 1-3.

(播放lb部分的录音让学生听,引导学生根据所听到的内容,选出对话的顺序,完成1b部分的教学任务。)

2. Check theanswers: (3, 2, 1 )

Pair work

1.Askthe Ss to practice the conversations in 1b with a partner. Then make their ownconversations.

(引导学生展开Pairwork活动,完成lc部分口语交际的教学任务,学会运用can询问和表达能力。)

Listening

1. Work on 2a;

T: Now, look atthe pictures on P2, listen to the four conversations. Just listen.

(Play therecording for the first time, students only listen carefully.)

Then, listen tothe recording again, and circle the clubs you hear.

Check the answerswith the class.

2. Work on 2b;

引导学生根据对话内容用正确的单词填空,补全对话,再播放听力材料一遍。让学生进行校对,练习听力和写作能力,完成2b部分的教学任务。

Check the answers with the Ss.

(4)当堂训练。

1. Look at 2b andtalk about what the people can do and the clubs they want to join.

老师可以和一名优秀的学生做一个对话的例子,让学生们明白如何去问答,例如:

T: What clubdoes Lisa want to join?

S1: She wants to join the chess club.

T: Can sheplay chess?

S1: No, shecan't.

2. Ss work inpairs to practice asking and answer about Lisa, Bob and Mary.

3. Ask some pairsto act out their conversations.

3、第三次“先学后教”(学生读默读或朗读课文,勾出不认识的单词、短语及句句型,读后回答问题。)

(1)、出示学习指导

1)、用最快的速度朗读课文,理解课文大意,勾出不理解的短语,或语言点及语法结构。

能掌握以下句型:

2)、① —Can you play the guitar? —Yes, I can./No, I can't.

② —What can you do? —I can dance.

③ —What club doyou want to join? —I want to join the chess club.

3)用最快的速度朗读课文,理解课文大意,勾出不理解的短语,或语言点及语法结构。

4)回答课文相关问题。

(2)、先学。

1、学生读短文,教师密切关注学生的自读情况,进行行间巡视。

2、画出不懂得语言点、表达方式和语法现象。

(3)、后教。

1)、学习询问和谈论彼此的能力和特长;

2) 掌握一些弹奏乐器的表达方式。。

3、学生自学后回答理解性问题。

4、对学生不会的,通过启发诱导的方式让学生理解。

5、学生难以理解的短语、句型或者语言点,适当点拔、举例、归纳等,并板书。

(4)、当堂训练

1、口述课文内容。

2、分角色朗读课文。

3、围绕本节课讲的语法项目,设计当堂训练题目。

Role-play

1. Ask Ss to look at the picture in 2d. ThenSs read the dialogue by themselves and try to find out the answers to thesequestions.

① What club does Bob join?

② What club does Jane join?

Ss read theconversation by themselves and find the answers to the questions. Then checkthe answers:

① Bob joins the soccer club. ② Janejoins the English and art club.

2. Explainsomething that Ss can't understand.

3. Let Ss read after the teacher or play therecording and let Ss read after the recording.

4. Ss work inpairs to act out the conversation.

5. Ask somepairs come to the front of the classroom. They try to act out the conversation.See which group is the best.

板书设计:

七年级下册英语教案 篇2

学习目标

1.认识并记住这些单词: this, pencil, pen, book, eraser, ruler, case, pencil case, backpack, pencil sharpener, dictionary, that, yes, no, not, isn't=is not

2.操练并运用这些句子:Is this/that a/an ...?

Yes, it is. /No, it isn't.

Is this/that your pencil?

Yes, it is. /No, it isn't. It's her pencil.

学习重点

认识并掌握新单词的音形意,熟练的操练新句型

学习难点

运用新学的词句与人熟练的交流

学 习 过 程

学习内容及预见性问题

时间

学习要求

Step1 Warm-up (巩固旧知,激趣导入)

1.Dictation

your, his, her, first name, last name, telephone number, phone number,

ID card, family name, given name.

2.Leading-in

A story:

Tom →go to school →with his backpack

New words: backpack

Step2 Presentation(明确目标,新授学习)

1. Learn the new words.

a backpack

a book a pencil case a dictionary

a pencil a pencil sharpener a pen a ruler an eraser

Remember these words before class.

(课前记住这些单词)

Arouse the students' interest.(激发学生学习兴趣)

They should study with their whole heart.(全心全意的学习)

学习内容及预见性问题

学习要求

1. Words Games

2.Read together

3.PK

Step3 Practice(合作探究,落实目标)

1.Sentences:

Show some things and learn the sentences

This is a/an... .

Is this/that a/an ....? Yes, it is. /No, it isn't.

Is this/that your/his/her ... ? Is this/that your... ?

Yes, it is. No, it isn't. It's his ....

2. Games:

Ask and answer

Guess

Step4 Production(交流展示,体验成功)

1.Find the owner

2.Let students make own dialogues and prepare to reveal..

3.Ask some groups to act out.

4.Finish 1a and 1b.

Step5 Test(抽测达标,拓展延伸)

⑴Do some exercises.

按要求完成下列各题

1.This is a .

2.That is . It's his .

3.Is this your ?

No, it isn't.

4.( )--Is that her backpack?

-- .

A.Yes, it isn't. B.No, it is. C.Yes, it is. D.No, she isn't.

5.( )--Is this English dictionary?

--No, it's Chinese dictionary.

A.an, an B.a, an C.an, a D.a, a

⑵Extracurricular practices.

(课时先锋P18选做)

Take study seriously.

(认真对待学习。)

Work hard at openings.

(勤于动口说)

Make own dialogue.(组自己的对话)

Prepare to reveal.(准备展示)

Feel free to try.(大胆尝试)

It's very important to practise listening。(练习听力是非常重要的)

Do these exercises by yourself.(独立完成练习)

七年级下册英语教案 篇3

Mr.Wu 七年级英语教案

Unit 1  Making New Friends Topic 1  Welcome to China! Section A Teaching aims and demands 1.(1)Learn the letters Aa-Kk. (2)Learn some new words: good, morning, welcome, to, China, thank, you, hello, I, am, are, yes, no, not, nice, meet, too (3)Learn some phonetics:20 vowels 2. Use greetings and introductions to make some dialogues: (1)―Good morning. ―Good morning. (2)―Welcome to China! ―Thank you./Thanks. (3)―Hello/Hi! ―Hello/Hi! (4)―I’m … Are you …? ―Yes, I am./No, I’m not. I’m … (5)―Nice to meet you. ―Nice to meet you, too. Step 1  Warming up  (5’) 1.Sing an English song You are my sunshine 2.Everyday English: Nice to meet you! Step 2  Presentation   (15’) 1.Learn the letters Aa-Kk. (1)Listen to me and read the letters after me. (2)let’s learn how to write the letters. 2.Learn some new words: good, morning, welcome, to, China, thank, you, hello, I, am, are, yes, no, not, nice, meet, too (1) Read after me (2) Read it by yourself (3) Play a game: Bomb (4)Contest:who is the best? Group A B C D, if you read it right and good,you will get a star. 3.Learn some phonetics:20 vowels (1)Listen to me and read the vowels after me. (2)let’s learn how to write the vowels Step 3  Consolidation (10’) Read the text ,then practice a dialog according to 1a and 3a in pairs, and act it out. A:Good morning! B:Good morning! A:I’m … Are you …? B:Yes, I am. A:Nice to meet you. B:Nice to meet you, too. A:Welcome to China! B: Thanks./Thank you. Act out the dialog with your own names. A: Hi! B: Hi! A: I’m … Are you …? A: Yes, I am. B: Hello! Are you …? A: No, I’m not. I’m … B: Nice to meet you. A: Nice to meet you, too. B: Hi! Are you …? A: Yes, I am. B: Welcome to China! A: hanks./Thank you. Step 4  Practice (10’) 1.The exercise in your English book 2. Exercise book (1)―Welcome to Beijing! ―____ A. Welcome to Beijing, too. B. Thank you. C. Fine, thank you. (2)―____ you Mingming? ―Yes, I ____. A. Are; are   B. Am; am C. Are; am (3) ―______________________________ ―Good morning, Miss Gao. (4) ―Nice to see you. ―______________________________ Match A B (1)Hi! a.Thanks./Thank you. (2)Welcome to China! b.Hello! (3)Nice to meet you. c.Nice to meet you, too. (4)Good morning! d.Good morning! (5)Hello! e.Yes, I am. (6)I’m Kangkang. Are you Michael? f. Hi! 3.Practice the vowels 4. Homework: (1)letters Aa-Kk  3 times (2)greeting and vowels  read it 5.Board design: Welcome to China! Section A 1.― Good morning! 5.― Are you Maria? ― Good morning! ― No, I’m not. I’m Jane. 2.― Hello!     6.― Nice to meet you. ― Hello! ― Nice to meet you, too. 3.― Hi! 7.― Welcome to China. ― Hi! ― Thanks./Thank you. 4.― I’m Kangkang. Are you Michael? ― Yes, I am.   

七年级下册英语教案 篇4

教学目标 1. Get the students learn the new words: guitar, sing, swim, dance, chess, play chess, draw, speak, speak English, join, club

2. Get the students learn the sentence patterns: ① —Can you play the guitar? —Yes, I can./ No, I can't. ② —What can you do? —I can dance. ③ —What club do you want to join? —I want to join the chess club.

3. Learn the grammar focus: modal verb “can” and “want to do sth”

4.Raises student's group consciousness

教学重点

难点 1. Learn to talk about the abilities.

2. The usage of modal verb “can”

教学

方法 Task-based, grading method、audio-visual instruction、demonstration、Situational Teaching Method.

教学过程 Ⅰ. Lead in

1. Ss look at the picture in 1a. Then read the words and phrases. Let Ss match the activities with the people.

2. Then Check the answers with the class together.

Ⅱ. Presentation

Show the pictures about the abilities and say:

He/She can dance/swim/sing/"??But I can’t dance/swim/sing/...

Ⅲ. Game (What can I do?)

T: Tell your partners what you can do. For example:

I can play the guitar. I can sing and dance.

Ss work in groups. The let some Ss talk to their classmates in front of the class.

Ⅳ. Listening

1. T: Now let’s listen to the tape, find out the right conversation, and number them 1-3.

2. Check the answers: (3, 2, 1 )

Ⅴ. Pair work

1. Ask the Ss to practice the conversations in 1b with a partner. Then make their own conversations. Ⅵ. Listening

1. Work on 2a;

T: Now, look at the pictures on P2, listen to the four conversations. Just listen.

(Play the recording for the first time, students only listen carefully.)

Then, listen to the recording again, and circle the clubs you hear.

Check the answers with the class.

2. Work on 2b;

3. Check the answers with the Ss.

Ⅶ. Pair work

1. Look at 2b and talk about what the people can do and the clubs they want to join.

T: What club does Lisa want to join?

S1: She wants to join the chess club.

T: Can she play chess?

S1: No, she can't.

2. Ss work in pairs to practice asking and answer about Lisa, Bob and Mary.

3. Ask some pairs to act out their conversations.

Ⅷ.Homework:

1. Remember the new words and expressions after class.

2. Recite the conversation after class.

3. Write English names as many as possible in the exercises book.

Ⅸ.Blackboard design Section A 1 (1a-2d)

Drills:

1. —Can you sing? —Yes, I can./No, I can't.

2. 2b: 1. chess, chess 2. English; English 3. sing, dance, music

4. ① What club does Bob join?

② What club does Jane join?

5. want to do sth

They want to have some rice and vegetables.

七年级下册英语教案 篇5

教学目标:

1.语音和句子的重读。

2.了解有关超市的知识。

3.初步认识美元。

4。 初步学习美英人士购物时所用的度量衡。

5.学会谈谈自家附近的超市。

教学用具:

录音机,实物投影仪,图片或实物等。 如有条件搞一份麦当劳或肯德基的菜单。

教学步骤:

Step 1 Revision

听录音并跟读第116课第一部分和第二部分。让几个同学在全班示范,看谁模仿的最好。可给一些生词让学生试着读一读,看看他们本课语音掌握的如何。

值日生Duty Report。

让值日生事先准备一有关超市的短文,在Duty时在全班讲,为新课做好铺垫。

Step 2 Presentation

引出今日新单词:all day The shopkeepers in this shop work hard all day。

a lot of The supermarket has a lot of things。

This shop sells a lot of things。

open: not close

This supermarket is open from 9 a。m。 to 9 p。m。

This shop is open at 9 a。m。 and is closed at 9 p。m。

market On Saturdays and Sundays the markets are full of

people。

教单词过程当中,尽量把课文中的句子重复几遍。为下一步听课文做好铺垫。

Step 3 Read and answer

1。 老师可先复述课文,让学生们了解main ideas,然后让学生们听录音,提醒他们不看书。

2.也可让学生们先看书一分钟,然后听录音。

3.听完第一遍时,可让学生先做几道判断题,一下几题供参考。

如:

( ) 1。 A big supermarket is near my home。

A。 Yes B。 No C。 The text doesn’t tell us

( ) 2。 It has no name。

A。 Yes B。 No C。 The text doesn’t tell us

( ) 3。 It sells a lot of things, almost everything。

A。 Yes B。 No C。 The text doesn’t tell us

( ) 4。 If you want to buy “house”, does the supermarket sell?

A。 Yes B。 No C。 The text doesn’t tell us

( ) 5。 All things in the supermarket are not expensive。

A。 Yes B。 No C。 The text doesn’t tell us

( ) 6。 The supermarket is open 12 hours a day。

A。 Yes B。 No C。 The text doesn’t tell us

( ) 7。 All the shopkeepers are friendly。

A。 Yes B。 No C。 The text doesn’t tell us

用投影仪打出,供学生们练习。

4.听第二遍,回答书上的问题。

5.听第三遍,复述,可把书上问题的答案连起来,成为一篇复述的短文。

6.编对话。

给出一情景:同学A,B去逛超市,想买些小礼品送给美国的笔友。

7.读课文。

8.谈谈自家附近的超市或农贸市场(Free Market),并写成书面的文字。

老师可根据班上同学的水平,酌情增减内容。

Step 4 Read and write

1.学习116第四部分。

2.新单词:dollar one dollar is equal about 8。3 yuan。

cent

pound 镑,(重量单位)

如有条件,可那一张真的美元或英镑让学生可看一看。

步骤同Step 3。

3.把对话写成书面文字。

Step 5 Practice

用麦当劳肯德基的菜单或Workbook P147 Menu编一对话。

你只有15元如何吃一顿物美价廉的午餐。

Blackboard Handwriting

Unit 29 Shopping

Lesson 116 参考词

New Words: all day a lot of open market dollar

Useful expressions cent

It has a lot of things。 This supermarket is open from 9 a。m。 to 9 p。m。 pound

探究活动

任 务:《跳蚤市场》或叫《垃圾市场》

语言技能:listening,talking and writing

所用材料:人民币、家中闲置的物品、购物单等

活动形式:可全或半班

提示词语及句型:

basketball volleyball medicine box English book corner

Do you have a pen / a pencil-sharpener / a ruler / doll / English book / story book?

Yes, I do。 / No, I don’t。

How much is it? / are they? It’s / They are…yuan。

Here you are。

Here is the money。 Thank you。

I want to buy…

操作过程:

1。 老师布置任务:同学们把集中闲置的物品如:学习用品、生活用品、玩具、和书籍等带到学校。

2.老师把课堂虚拟成一跳蚤市场,把同学们带到学校的物品都表上价格,大件2元,小件1元。

3.同学们可购买自己喜欢的或需要的物品,整个买卖过程用英语完成,现金交易。

4.所得款项,可归个人也各用作班费。

任 务: 班费的使用

语言技能:listening,talking and writing

所用材料:dictionary、学过的句型和单词

活动形式:以四人小组为单位

提示词语及句型:

How much is our class fees?

What do we buy with this money?

We can buy something that we all like。

What about buying a basketball?

I don’t agree to buy … because it’s no use。

I think we should buy a …, because it is very useful to everyone。

操作过程:

1.小组讨论班费的用法。共有班费208元。小组每位成员谈谈对班费用法的看法。(每位组员应事先作一番调查,看看班上同学都想买什么东西,并准备好发言)

2。 每位成员必须发言,阐明自己的观点,并说明理由。

3.每组找一位同学代表发言,看那一组买的东西物美价廉,符合同学们的心意。

4.把本组的讨论结果写成一书面材料交给老师,并;评出《班费最佳利用方案》。

任 务:购物:老外买饺子

目 的:练习做生意

语言技能:listening,talking and writing

所用材料:字典和所学句型

活动形式:两人小组

提示词语及句型:

traditional(传统) food in Spring Festival

What’s in it?

There is meat and all kinds of vegetables。

操作过程:

可用以课外活动时间,并实现准备好一些画片,正面画画,背面写单词。

1。 老师布置任务:一“老外”要买中国的传统食品“饺子”,但又不知怎么说,根据这一情景编一对话。

2.小组复习总结购物用语。

3.模拟一主食厨房,用以大纸盒里面放些画片。编对话。对话应10组AB以上。内容包括:老外描述“饺子”的外形、味道和售货员向老外介绍“饺子”特点、食用的方法等。

4.对话编好后,请几组同学在全班展示,看那一组最精彩。

5.老师可随意在找一组同学,抽一画片,即兴编对话。

任 务:介绍一种食品

语言技能:listening,talking and writing

所用材料:字典和所学句型

活动形式:三人或四人小组

提示词语及句型:

mineral,(矿物质) nutrition,(营养) vitamin,(维生素) crisp and tasty (又香又脆), tasty refreshing (爽滑可口),health food (保健食品) promote sales(促销)

操作过程:

1。 一顾客想买一保健食品,你向他介绍了最近新研制的一种方便面。

2.小组讨论如何向顾客介绍这种面。介绍内容有:这种面含有多种营养,生吃又香又脆,煮着吃爽滑可口,而且久煮不烂,只比普通同的方便面贵一点点,每袋只售5元。现在正在促销。

3.每组都派一位代表推销自己的产品。

4。 听了的介绍,看那一组卖出的面最多。

任 务: 看生病的同学,买礼物

目 的:学会计划花钱

语言技能:listening,talking and writing

所用材料:字典和所学句型

活动形式:四人小组

提示词语及句型:

What about …?

1。 班上一同学生病住院,老师想派几位同学去看望,打算从班费总抽出50元买些礼品。让同学们讨论一下,这50元钱买些什么。

2.四人小组中讨论50元钱买什么,每人阐明自己的观点,说明理由。

3.每组推选一代表,宣讲本组的观点,竞争“上岗”争取老师派你们组去。

4.老师根据每组的演讲,看那一组买的东西物美价廉,就派这一组去看生病的同学。

仁爱初中英语教案七年级(经典5篇)


仁爱初中英语教案七年级 篇1

一、基本情况:

本学期我担任七年级3班和七年级4班的英语课。绝大多数学生虽然小学阶段都学过英语,但大部分学生的英语基础都比较差。缺少学习的主动性和热情,自觉性也较差,相应的学习习惯也较差,对学习英语有为难情绪。针对这些情况,在本学期的英语教学中,本人将致力于一方面应加强英语基础知识的讲解和基本技能的训练,让学生掌握词汇、语法、句型的基础知识和听、说、读、写等基本技能,为进一步学习英语打下坚实的基础;另一方面,又要采取多种措施,注意培养学生对英语学习的兴趣;让学生掌握记忆语音、单词、阅读和写作等英语学习技巧,培养良好的学习习惯和自主探索、合作探究能力,充分调动学生的学习积极性和主动性。教学上采取任务型教学方式,运用灵活多变的方法,实现学生语言运用能力的迁移和拓展。尊重并理解学生,与学生一起分享学习中的苦与乐,使每一位学生的英语成绩有所提高,有所进步。

二、指导思想:

社会生活的信息化和经济的.全球化,使英语的重要性日益突出,在基础教育阶段中,英语教育也是一个重要组成部分,通过英语学习,激发学生的兴趣,掌握知识,提高口语水平和交际能力,同时又能磨砺意志,陶冶情操,拓宽视野,发展个性。在本学期的英语教学中,坚持以下理念的应用:

1、要面向全体学生,关注每个学生的情感,激发他们学习英语的兴趣,帮助他们建立学习的成就感和自信心,培养创新精神;

2、整体设计目标,体现灵活开放,目标设计以学生技能,语言知识,情感态度,学习策略和文化意识的发展为基础;

3、突出学生主体,尊重个体差异。

三、本学期的教学重、难点:

一、语法知识点。

1、一般疑问句及回答;

2、指示代词、人称代词、物主代词

3、名词复数的变化;

4、方位介词;

5、特殊疑问句的构成、回答和对划线部分提问

6、实义动词的第三人称单数及变化;

7、名词所有格;

8、一般现在时

9、时间表达法;

二、交际用语(略)

四、本学期将采用的教育教学方法:

英语的教育教学方法很多,各有优、缺点,我们可以针对不同的情况采用不同的教学方法来加以弥补。针对我教的班级,本学期本人打算用下列方法对他们进行教育教学:

1、用英语教英语(TeachEnglishinEnglish);

英语毕竟是一门语言,训练的是学生的听、说、读、写、译的综合能力,在教学的过程中需要对学生的听、说、读、写、译的能力进行很多的训练,这就要求我们用英语来教英语,在课堂上对学生进行各种能力的训练。

2、用英语想英语(ThinkEnglishinEnglish);

用英语想,也就是用英语思考。学英语而不用英语思考,一定学不好。用英语思考就是在用英语进行表达和理解时,没有本族语思考的介入,或者说本族语思考的介入被压缩到了极不明显的程度。这是真正流利、熟练的境界和标志。

3、背诵和多种练习结合

实事求是的说,大量背诵课文与大量多种练习的结合,乃是对于一切各不相同条件下的英语教学的普遍有效的方法。

4、针对不同的教学内容采用不同的教学方法;

英语的内容较多,包括语音、词汇、语法、交际等等内容,如果对每一项内容都采用同样的方法来进行教育教学,那么即使是再好的学生也不可能学好,再好的教师也不可能教好。因而,针对不同的内容采用不同的教学方法是不可违背的。

五、本学期提高教育教学质量的方法:

1、体现学生的主体地位,发挥教师的指导作用。充分发挥学生的主动性和积极性,激发学生的学习兴趣,帮助学生摸索适合自己的学习方法,了解和掌握记忆规律,养成良好的学习习惯,培养学生自主学习的能力。

2、突出语言的实践性,注重培养学生综合运用英语的能力。

3、尽量使用英语,适当使用母语。

4、备好学生、课本、课标,确立最佳教案。

5、根据教学内容,进行教学创新,尝试不同的教学方式,激发学生的学习欲望。

6、语言点讲解要做到精讲多练,举一反三,使学生理解准确、深刻、透彻。

7、扩大学生的课外阅读量。增强语感,循序渐进,逐渐提高阅读理解能力。

8、加强书面表达训练,每一单元结合内容布置相应的书面表达练习,择优选读,讲解技巧,使学生逐渐找到英语写作的窍门。

9、实行分层次教学。制定出培优扶差的目标生,分层次辅导,分层次练习,分层次要求,使不同程度的学生都能有所提高。

10、合理利用课外资料,重点题要重点练习、重点讲解,做到主次分明,讲求实效。

六、教学计划安排:

Unit

Topic

Week

Unit1

Topic1

第1—2周

Topic2—topic3

第3—4周

Unit2

Topic1—topic2

第5—7周

Topic3—topic4

第8—9周

Revision

ReviewUnit1—unit2

第10周

Unit3

Topic1—topic2

第11—12周

Topic3—topic4

第13—15周

Unit4

Topic1—topic2

第16—17周

Topic3—topic4

第18—19周

Revision

ReviewUnit3—unit4

第20周

仁爱初中英语教案七年级 篇2

主要介绍了日常生活的交际用语以及一些西方国家的文化背景和风俗习惯,教材通俗易懂,旨在使初一级学生基本能用英语进行简单的交流。这套教材采用任务型语言教学模式,融汇话题、交际功能和语言结构,形成了一套循序渐进的生活化的学习程序。与原教材相比还增加了文化背景和学习策略等部分,并增加了任务型学习成份和语篇的输入。本书每个单元都列出明确的语言目标、主要的功能项目与语法结构、需要掌握的基本词汇,并分为A和B两部分。A部分是基本的语言内容,B部分是知识的扩展和综合的语言运用。这套教材是基于城市学生的状况编写的,对于我们农村学生来说,由于小学基础不好,到初中以后学起来的确有些吃力,光是一千多个单词就吓退了不少学生学习英语的兴趣。但我们还必须知难而上,为了提高农村的英语教学成绩而努力。指导学生通过活动把它们有机地联系起来,从而完成了知识迁移过程。常用的训练活动有以下几项:

(1)Daily report:值日生介绍自己、家庭成员或朋友的情况,其它学生可互相提问题,询问个人职业。

(2)Play a guessing game:用问题“what does he do?”引入任务,让学生猜测多媒体课件中人物的'职业,以此激发学生的学习兴趣,并训练学生的发散思维能力。

(3)Ask the way :创设问路情景,根据实际情况 telling the way,eg, I want to go the hospital 完成对话活动。

(4)See the doctor、go shopping等:学生可扮演角色,进行对话。

(5)Have a discussion :学生分小组讨论。

(6)What do you want to be when you grow up?通过训练把课内的语言学习与课外的语言活动结合起来,改变了过去老师一言堂的模式,变学生为主体,课堂主要是提供了一个学生获取知识的平台。学生在活动中主动地获取知识。

一、教学理念

1 遵循教学课标,认真备教材备学生,上好每一节课,向45分钟要质量。

2、要面向全体学生,关爱每个学生,激发他们学习英语的兴趣,帮助他们建立学习的成就感和自信心,培养自主学习的能力。

3、设计教师的整体教学目标,目标设计以学生的学习技能,语言知识,情感态度,学习策略和文化意识的发展为基础;同时尊重个体差异,体现每个学生的主体意识,帮助学生制定小目标;

4、采用任务型教学模式,让学生在老师的指导下通过感知、体验、实践、参与和合作等方式,实现任务的目标,感受成功,给每个学生带来喜悦;

5、注重过程评价,促进学生能力发展,建立能激励学生学习兴趣和自主学习能力发展的评价体系。给学生充分的信心和支持,使他们在使用和学习英语的过程中,体会到轻松和成功的快乐,让学生在快乐中学习,让英语的工具功能得到充分体现;

6、重视学生的思想品质教育,体现教育培养全面合格人才的方针政策。

二,学情分析

我所教的本届七年级8和9两班基础很差,学生在写的技能方面基本上没有得到过训练,连音标没讲过,甚至有一半的学生的拼读都没有掌握好。开学三周了,经过我和学生的不懈努力,并对学生思想教育,学习态度也有所好转。部分学生有了主动学习的动力,但是整体的惰性还是很强,我要积极主动的帮助他们重新建立学习兴趣。另外,学生在学习策略方面还存在很多需要进一步体会掌握的地方。很多学生不能明确学习英语的目的,没有真正认识到学习英语的目的在于交流;有些同学在学习中缺乏小组合作意识,不愿和其他学生交流,不能共同完成学习任务;大多数同学不能做好课前预习和课后复习,学习没有计划性,完全在老师的指挥棒之下学习,没能力做到总结语言规律和知识的巩固、积累。这些都是我和学生要长期作战艰苦努力才能解决的问题。我会慢慢给学生们信心去完成这些任务的,急是没有用的。让学生们乐于接受我的教学指导,并找到自成体系的办法才是解决问题的关键。

三 具体实施方案

1.学生坚持每单元一篇与所学内容相仿的作文,并及时批阅让学生及时发现不足加以改进;

2.每天背诵课文中的文章。要求学生背诵并默写,培养语感,掌握语法知识的应用技巧;利用“组长检查及教师重点抽查”的方法及时检查,并给与及时的表扬。

3.坚持周测、月测(可用作业进行)的形成性评价制度,给学生鼓励、表扬,不使用消极的语言打击学生;

4. 对后进生进行专门辅导,布置单独的作业。制定合适的学习评价方法,让他们树立学习的自信;

5. 加强对学生学习策略的指导,为他们终身学习奠定基础;

6. 要充分利用学校先进的教育技术,使用计算机和多媒体教学设施,探索新的教学模式,开发英语教学资源,拓宽学生学习渠道,提教学效果。

仁爱初中英语教案七年级 篇3

一、指导思想

以“英语课程标准”为宗旨,适应新课程改革的需要,面向全体学生,提高学生的人文素养,增强实践能力和创新精神。正确把握英语学科特点,积极倡导合作探究的学习方式。培养学生积极地情感态度和正确的人生价值观,提高学生综合素质为学生全面发展和终身发展奠定基础。

二、全期教学总目标

学生应有较明确的英语学习动机和积极主动的学习态度。能听懂教师对有关熟悉话题的陈述并能参与讨论。能读供七年级学生阅读的简单读物和报纸杂志,克服生词障碍,理解大意。能根据阅读目的运用适当的阅读策略。能与他人合作,解决问题并报告结果,共同完成学习任务。能在学习中互相帮助,克服困难。能合理计划和安排学习任务,积极探索适合自己的学习方法。在学习和日常交际中能注意到中外文化的差异。

三、教材简要分析

《新目标英语》七年级(下册),全书共有十二个单元,另两个复习单元。本教材各单元话题灵活,贴近生活实际。本册书将学习的一些语法知识点有:一般现在时、一般过去时、现在进行时、一般疑问句等。同时每个单元后都提供了一则笑话,用以训练学生的思维能力,提高学生的兴趣。

四、学情简要分析

通过半年的英语学习,大多数学生已能听懂有关熟悉话题的语段和简短的故事。能与教师或同学就熟悉的话题交换信息。能读懂短篇故事,能写便条和简单的书信。但由于各种因素的.影响,学生发展参差不齐。有少数学生因为基础不够好,学习很吃力而自暴自弃,有的因此扰乱课堂次序,这给教学带来不少困难。

五、提高教学质量的可行措施及教改措施五

一、面向全体学生,注重素质教育。

二、以学生为主体,尊重学生个体差异。

三、采用活动途径,倡导体验与参与。

四、开发课程资源,拓展学用渠道。

具体来说:

1.认真专研教材和课标,精心备课,认真上好每一堂课。确定每堂课的基础内容,预备内容和拓展内容,满足不同层次学生的不同需求。

2.充分利用现有的现代化教学设备,加强直观教学,提高课堂效率。

3.多与学生沟通,了解学生学习状况和需求,及时改进教学中存在的问题和不足。

4.积极开展丰富多彩的英语活动,提高学生兴趣。如英语演讲比赛、单词听写比赛、朗读比赛、英语手抄报比赛、学唱英文歌曲,课前五分钟活动等。

5.注重个别辅导,在面向全体学生的基础上,培优补差。

6.不断学习,加强自身素质和业务能力的提高。

六、教学进度安排

Unit 1-2复习 6课时 第一周----第三周

Unit 3 5课时 第三周---第四周

Unit 4 5课时 第五周---第六周

Unit 5 5课时 第六周---第七周

Unit 6 6课时 第七周---第八周

Review1-6 and Mid-Test 5课时 第九周

Unit 7 5课时 第十周------第十二周

Unit 8 5课时 第十二周---第十三周

Unit 9 5课时 第十三周---第十四周

Unit 10 5课时 第十五周---第十六周

Unit 11 12 5课时 第十七周---第十八周

Review and Final-Test 11 课时 第十八周—第二十周

仁爱初中英语教案七年级 篇4

一、指导思想

根据初一学生的生理和心理以及发展需求,英语课程的目的是:激发学生学习英语的兴趣,培养他们学习英语的积极态度,使他们建立学习英语的自信心;培养学生的语感和良好的语音、语调基础,使他们形成初步运用英语进行日常交流的能力,为进一步学习打下基础。同时用新课标理念,结合新课标精神,进行课堂改革,实行教与学的互动。采用任务型语言教学模式,努力用一套行之有效的课堂教学模式,提高教学效率。

二、基本情况

经过一学期的学习,大部分学生学习目的明确,态度端正,掌握了英语学习的一些基本方法,能够积极主动认真地学习,学习成绩较好。但还有少部分学生没有明确的学习目的`,缺少学习的热情和主动性,自觉性较差,相应的学习习惯也差。主要原因是没有激发学生学习英语的兴趣,学生觉得英语学习是一种负担,而不是一种乐趣。一部分学生没有掌握记忆单词的方法,连基本的单词听写也不过关,导致看不懂,听不懂,学不懂。学生的听力也还有待提高,在这方面失分也较多。主要是听的时间太少,接触英语的时间不多。针对种种问题,在本学期的英语教学中,教师一方面应加强基础知识的讲解和基本技能的训练,让学生掌握词汇、语法、句型等基础知识和听、说、读、写等基本技能,为进一步学习英语打下坚实的基础;另一方面,又要采取多种措施,注意培养学生对英语的兴趣;让学生掌握记忆单词、听力、写作等英语学习技艺,培养良好的学习习惯和自主探索,合作探究能力。

三、教学内容和教学要求

初一下册共10个单元,加上复习单元1个。全书采取任务型语言教学模式,融汇话题、交际功能和语言结构,形成了一套循序渐进的生活化的学习程序。每个单元都列出明确的语言目标,主要的功能项目与语法结构,需要掌握的基本词汇,并分为A、B两部分。A部分是基本的语言内容,B部分是知识的扩展和综合的语言运用。每个单元还有selfcheck部分,供学生自我检测本单元所学的语言知识之用。它采用“语言的输入——学生的消化吸收——学生的语言输出”为主线编排的。通过确定languageGoal,采用听、说、读、写,自我检测等手段,有效提高学习效率,体现了以学生为主体的思想。

本学期主要是继续培养学生对英语的学习兴趣,形成有效的学习策略,同时要求学生懂得课堂上的用语和一些基本的对话、短文,能够看图说话,以提高学生的听、说、读、写的能力,使学生初步获得运用英语的能力,达到语言运用能力的迁移和拓展。

四、教学措施和方法

措施:

1、培养学习兴趣,引导学生掌握正确的学习方法和策略,提高学习效率;

2、发挥学生主体和教师主导作用;

3、用良好的师生关系,协调课堂气氛,培养学生开口说英语的勇气和信心;

4、引导学生实现语言的迁移,加强日常生活中英语口语的运用;

5、鼓励学生自主探索,合作探究,共同提高。

。加强听力训练,拟每天晚上课进行20分钟听力训练。

方法:合作探究教学:教师设计好导学案,学生自学讨论。听说领先,读写跟上。综合训练,扎实双基。抓好英语的常规教学,确保基础知识过关

1、单词过关利用自习时间、早读时间,由科代表主持听写、默书。

2、词组过关把学过的词组归纳,方便学生记忆。用词组造句和中译英训练。在各个教学班内进行竞赛。

3、句型过关组织学生结对子,一有空就你问我答,营造学习氛围,同时加强笔头的练习,使学生能熟能生巧。

4、课文过关把课文分段,按学习组为单位,进行朗读比赛,对学过的课文尽量做到人人会背,有些课文还要求学生会默写。

教学工作及课时安排

第一周:Unit1

第二周:Unit2

第三周:Unit3

第四周:复习月考

第五周:Unit4

第六周:Unit5

第七周:Unit6

第八周:复习期中考试

第九周:Unit7

第十周:Unit8

第十一周:复习7、8单元

第十二周:Unit9

第十三周:Unit10

第十四周:复习9、10单元

第十五周:复习考试

仁爱初中英语教案七年级 篇5

一、 指导思想:

东方市海之南学校主要以李阳疯狂英语“最大声、最快速、最清晰”的三最口腔法为主。以学生达到脱口而出课文的文章为主。我们的主要教学是“杜郎口”模式,素质教育、感恩教育、励志教育、相结合的主要教学方法。为使课堂教学优化,高效,也为适应素质教学改革与发展规律的需要,培养新时代多能智慧型的学生,根据八年级英语教学大纲、仁爱英语教材七年级(下)、本期教学时间、以学生的实际情况出发。

二、教学目的

在本学期的教学中,要求培养学生对英语学习的积极性和自信心;能把每一个topic的`对话打到脱口而出。能听懂对话和故事;能主要在大展示环节参扮演各种角色活动,;能用李阳疯狂英语的学习方法,克服学习中的困难;能意识到语言交际中存在的文化差异;使学生在掌握一定的语言基础知识和基本技能的基础上,提高用英语获取信息、处理信息、分析和解决问题的能力,培养语感获得初步的运用英语的能力。

三、教材特点。

初中英语第二册(下)主要介绍了日常生活的交际用语以及一些西方国家的文化背景和风俗习惯,教材通俗易懂,能听懂有关熟悉话题的语段和简短的故事,能与教师或同学就熟悉的话题(如学校、家庭生活)交换信息。能读懂小故事及其他文体的简单书面材料。能参照范例或借助图片写出简单的句子。能参与简单的角色扮演等活动。能尝试使用适当的学习方法,克服学习中的困难。能意识到语言交际中存在文化差异。

四、教学措施

本教材阶梯性强,内容丰富,练习形式多样,生动活泼,图文并茂,根据这些特点,可以尝试下面几点措施。

1.狠抓教学常规,重点放在差生的管理上。如经常检查课堂指南,培养学生良好的学习习惯和纪律行为。

2.认真备好课堂指南,对知识重,难点精讲精练。以落实书本知识为主,利用好每一次爬黑板,让学生记住单词句子。

3.做到教音标、单词、句子、短对话、课文的一次环节。学生能够达到脱口而出。

4.日过三关、周周测、半月测、月月测。多组织单元测试,以定期进行质量分析,发现问题,及时采取措施。

5.注重培养学生学英语的方法和好习惯,多读;多听;多练;多说。 课堂以“对子帮扶、师傅徒弟” 活动,以优带差,互帮互助。

6.关注学生的情感,营造宽松、民主、和谐的教学氛围。

七年级英语教案精品


在给学生上课之前老师早早准备好教案课件,因此老师最好能认真写好每个教案课件。设计教案需要注重对学生的关爱和支持,应该从什么角度去写教案课件呢?推荐一篇有关“七年级英语教案”的文章希望能够给大家带来启示,本文内容愿为您提供一些有益的帮助!

七年级英语教案【篇1】

单词水平测试七

班级 ______________ 姓名 ______________ 分数 ______________

1. French is one of the o _______________ languages in Canada.

2. If you taste the sea water, you’ll find it s _______________.

3. He has broken the agreement by not doing the work he p _______________.

4. I know you are very busy, but if you can m _______________ to come on Saturday afternoon, I shall be very thankful.

5. A good p _______________ is very important for a teacher of English who teaches small children.

6. A national conference will be held next _______________ (周三) to discuss the economic problems.

7. The hostess takes pride in careful _______________ (准备) of special dishes.

8. While they were away from home, they put all their valuable in the bank, just for _______________ (安全).

9. Mr. Smith turns lawyer but Mr. Brown _______________ (仍然) a worker.

10. Susan is talkative, but she never talks to _______________ (陌生人) .

11. I can’t go to the party, but I’m going to have some flowers d _______________ for her birthday.

12. The picture shows four g _______________, great grandfather, grandfather, parents and baby.

13. My English teacher always e _______________ me when I meet with difficulties.

14. The c _______________ made me worn out when I reached the top of the mountain.

15. I’ll have to buy a pair of t _______________ to match my new T-shirt.

16. Robin is a cold-blooded killer; he has _______________ (谋杀) a lot of people.

17. The worst part of the divorce was the _______________ (分离) from his three children. He wanted to be with them.

18. The show had a very large audience, _______________ (范围) from children to grandparents.

19. Do you think the teaching in _______________ (私人的) schools is better than in state schools?

20. Your plan sounds good, and it you raise the plan at the meeting I’ll _______________ (支持) you.

单词水平测试八

班级 ______________ 姓名 ______________ 分数 ______________

1. My brother enjoys c _______________ stamps.

2. You seem to have a fever. Let me take your t _______________.

3. The air around the earth is called a _______________.

4. What he said e _______________ me greatly and I made up my mind to continue learning.

5. The manager can speak several f _______________ languages.

6. Dreams are just _______________ (记忆) to be.

7. Nowadays most people use paper _______________ (手帕) .

8. Nie Haishen and Fei Jun long have become _______________ (熟悉的) faces to millions of fans of space travel.

9. Not surprisingly, praise usually makes children _______________ (提高) greatly.

10. The boy spoke in a very low voice _______________ (承认) he had broken the glass.

11. When a soldier meets an officer, the soldier often s _______________ him.

12. When the crops are r _______________, they are ready to be harvested.

13. The fridge does not f _______________ very well; you’d better get it repaired.

14. I know you are very busy. Would you mind s _______________ me a few minutes?

15. A bicycle is far more c _______________ than a car or a bus in busy cities.

16. The car accident has caused _______________ damage to Mary’s eyesight; she will not be able to see things for the rest of her life.

17. Hand _______________ () is the small bags that you carry with you when you are traveling on a plane.

18. The boy was happy to see many colorful _______________ () go up into the sky.

19. Although the painting looked old, it’s really a _______________ ().

20. One of his _______________ () is to become the CEO of the international company.

Key

单词水平测试七

1. official 2. salty 3. promised 4. manage 5. pronunciation 6. Wednesday 7. preparation 8. safety 9. remains 10. strangers 11. delivered 12. generations 13. encourages 14. climbing 15. trousers 16. murdered 17. separation 18. ranging 19. private 20. support

单词水平测试八

1. collecting 2. temperature 3. atmosphere 4. encouraged 5. foreign 6. memories 7. handkerchiefs 8. familiar 9. improve 10. admitting 11. salutes 12. ripe 13. function 14. sparing 15. convenient 16. permanent 17. luggage 18. balloons 19. fake 20. ambitions

七年级英语教案【篇2】

No. 110 Middle School of Chongqing By Cao Yi

Unit 6 Where are the jazz CDs?

单元整体说明

单元教材分析

本单元的核心内容是用英语问路及谈论爱好,因此本单元的主要交际功能项目为“asking for and giving directions”and“talking about favorites,’本单元通过在音乐节Music Festivals)上问路,让学生在问路与指路的同时,又掌握了本单元中出现的音乐名词(Names of musical styles, such as jazz, pop, country)。在Section A中的3 ,4和1a,lb,2a,2b,2c为谈论自己的爱好,学生可当堂表演。

单元知识结构

词汇

名词:jazz, pop, country,dance, video, floor,!!section, group,singer, sound,fan,are, direction, culture, palace, hall, painting, gate

形容词: classical, traditional, amazing, awful, bad, western

副词: upstairs

词组:not bad,and so on

句型:

1 Where’s the pop music?

Go upstairs and turn right.It's next to the jazz.

2 What's your favorite kind of music, Judy?

My favorite kind of music is...

语法:

1. Where are the jazz CDs?

Go upstairs /Go straight and turn right /left.

They are between the pop and the country

2 The use of the sentences structures.

单元整体目标

1.Master the vocabulary.

2.Master and use:Where are the country CDs?

Go upstairs /Go straight and turn right /left.

They are between …and …/next to… behind …

单元教学重难点一览

重点 难点

I The vocabulary.

2 The Grammar. 1 Asking for and giving directions.

2 Talking about favorite.

单元学情分析

本单元与前几个单元的学习自然衔接,继续学习询问和指点方向,而且与学生愿意接触的“音乐“有关,很大程度上能调动学生的学习积极性。

单元教学建议

听、说、读、写全面训练,在说写的基础上,充分借助听力材料和补充阅读材料,训练学生的听力阅读水平。

a口语训练:本单元的口语活动主要是询问和指点方向及谈论爱好,教学时可以将学生分组设置情景〔例如问学校里的某个地方,最喜欢的歌等)展开训练。

b阅读训练:教师要求学生在阅读完SelfCheck中的3后,除了可以在地图上找出正确的地点外,还要培养学生猜测个别生词词义的能力。

c写的训练:写是检查学生英语水平的重要手段,写的训练要在听、说、读训练的基础上进行,任务型的写的训练有助于培养学生综合运用英语解决实际问题的能力。设计如“目标调查”这样的练习,把听、说、读与写的训练结合起来。

第一步,要求学生写几句话,谈谈他们喜欢的歌曲类型,歌手及歌曲。例如:

My favorite kind of music is country, and The Smith Family is my favorite group …

第二步,小组活动。

1提问:一个学生向另一个学生提问,了解对方的爱好。例如:

A:What’s your favorite kind of music?

B:My favorite kind of music is country.

A:Who’s your favorite country group?

B:My favorite group is The Smith Family.

A:……

2朗读:学生朗读自己的爱好。

单元课时分配

本单元4课时:

Section A(一)1课时

Section A(二)1课时

Section B(一)1课时

Section B(二)1课时

Section A(一)

教学内容

Section A中la.lb.lc.2a.2b.2c Grammar focus

教学目标

知识与能力

1、Match the vocabulary: jazz,classical,dance, pop,country, upstairs,video,floor, section,

2、Master and use:Where’s the jazz music?

Go straight /upstairs and turn left/right.It' s next to…/behind... /between…and…

过程与方法

学生在前几个单元已经学会了询问和指点方向,能自然地与本课知识相连接。通过“Where’s the jazz music?”引入创设情景,引起学生的兴趣。并借助媒体来调动学生的积极性。

情感态度价值观

明确相关音乐分类的英文表达法,巩固方位感的表达方式。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

1、The vocabulary

2、language points:

Where’s the jazz music?

Go straight /upstairs and turn left /right. It’s next to … / behind …/between…and …

难点

1 Asking for and giving directions

2 Kind- of music

教学突破

1对于本课的单词短语通过卡片、实物来强化记忆。

2 Language points的学习,借助于Where is……?的练习和课件的图画来使其形象化。

教学准备

教师准备

录音机、磁带、课件、光碟

学生准备

1、预习生词和课文。

2、带自己最喜欢的光碟或歌曲带。

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师时间 学生活动 媒体应用

Step 1

Organization (1’) Organize Ss by greeting each other. Greetings

Step 2

Free talk (2’) Ask the student

1. “who is on duty?”

If there’s a student who doesn’t come, then ask.

2. “Is everyone here?”

3. “Where is he/she?”

4. “Why he/she isn’t here today?” The student who is on duty answer.

Step

Presentation 20’ 1. Ask eight Ss to come to the front of the room and stand in two rows, leaving a few feet between Ss. Let the other Ss ask and answer questions about “Where is …? “He is between…and…”

“Where is…?” “She is behind…?/next to…”

2. Tell the Ss “Do as I told you”.(point to a student) “Wang Ming, go straight/go ahead, and then turn left, then turn right.” Let the Ss follow the directions. 学生模仿练习(impairs)

并表演

“Where is …” “He is between … and …”

“Where is …”

“She is behind …/ next to …

学生模仿表演(in pairs)

A student do as the other student told him/her.

go straight/go ahead, and then turn left, then turn right.”

3. Let the Ss practice in pairs using the CDs they have brought.

Such as one student ask “Which kind of music do you like best?”

Let the other Ss answer.

“Jazz or Country or Dance or pop or classical music.”

4. Let the Ss look at the Section A (la)

Ask the Ss to tell what they see.

Guide Ss to understand that the pictures shows different types of music. (Point: teach the new word “upstairs” with a picture.

At the same time, can teach “downstairs”)

5. Ask Ss to match each picture with one of the words on the left. Say “Write the letter of each picture. next to the words on the left”. Point out the sample answer.

Check the answer. (Answers: 1b, 2c, 3d, 4e, 5a)

6. (For 1b) Draw a set of stairs on the board. At the top of the stairs, write “jazz” in a box at the eight.

Write the three conversations on the Bb, then read it as you use your fingers to “walk” up the stairs and turn left to the “jazz” section. Then ask various Ss to come to the front of the Bb to read the other conversations, at the same time, use their fingers to walk to each section mentioned.

Play the recording the first time.

Play the recording the second time. This time, ask the Ss to listen to the recording and write the number of each conversation in the correct box. Point out the Sample answer.

Correct the answers.

(Answers: From left to right: 3, 2, 1)

7. (1c, Pair work)

Point to the conversations in 1b and ask Ss to read after you.

Use the stairs you drew on the board earlier. Erase the words you wrote before and write in the words “country” and “pop” to the left of the stairs, “dance” straight ahead of the stairs and “jazz” and “classical” to the right of the stairs.

8 (For 2a)

Ask four Ss to come to the front of the classroom. Arrange the Ss so that one is in the middle and the others are to the left of, to the right of, and behind the first student. Then describe the location of the Ss using the words “behind, next to and between”. For example, “Li Peng is behind Zhou Wen. Cao Ying is next Zhou Wen is between Cao Ying and Cong Zheng.”

Letn the Ss look at the pictures. Ask Ss to tell what they see in each picture.

Ask Ss to match each numbered sentence with one of the pictures. Say “Write the letter of each picture next to the correct sentence.

Check the answers. 小组表演

One student ask “Which kind of music do you like best?” Let the other Ss answer “Jazz or Country or Dance or pop or classical music”

到黑板前表演,并用手指按照所说的指引方向。

“Where’s the dance music?”

“Go straight and turn left.”

“Where’s the classical music?”

“Go upstairs and turn right.”

Ss listen to the tape carefully

Ask Ss to match each numbered sentence with one of the pictures 多媒体放映图一

录音机

(The answers are 1a, 2c, 3b)

9 (For 2b)

First, tell the Ss that suppose they are clerks of a music store, if someone asks them the directions, what they should do?

Notices

注意CDs和 videos 中的s 发的[z] 解说在以元音或浊辅音([z], [v], [dv]除外)结尾的名词后读[z]。

例如:play [pleiz], doogs [z].

10 Ask Ss to work in pairs. Suppose one student is a clerk of a music store, the other is asking him/her for different kinds of CDs, show her the Ss listen to the tape carefully and label the map of the CD store Ss write them down

分角色扮演

directions by looking.

At the map at Page 36, 2b.

Step 4

Practice (6’) Pairwork

Practice the conversations by looking at the screen and pictures on the Bb, ask and answer questions about other places in the pictures. Ss practice the dialogue in pairs “Where’s the pop music?” “It’s …” 多媒体放映 2a, 2b

Step 5

Just for fun (5’) 1. Ask all Ss to read the conversation. Have Ss identify the two characters in the cartoon.

2. Ask pairs of Ss to present the dialogue to the rest of the class.

3. Ask Ss to play both roles.

Work in pairs

Step6

Summary (2) 1. Summary the language points of this lesson.

2. Words and phrases of this class.

3. Language points.

Step 7

Test (4’) 同“练习设计 Do it by themselves.

Step 8

Consolidtion (4’) 1. Let’s Ss keep the Grammar Focus in their hearts.

2. Ss practice the Grammar Focus in pairs by looking at the pictures on the Bb.

Practice in pairs.

Homework (1’) Practice the dialogues according to the pictures on Page 35 and 36

本课小结

本节课学习了10个生词,和?句式的练习运用及学习了。通过本节课的学习,学生能熟练的用英语询问和指点方向,也能用英语说出不同类型的音乐。

问题探究与拓展活动

本节课主要学习问路、指路和各种类型的音乐。学生掌握后,可以问学生如果别人问路而他不知道时该如何办?本课的拓展活动为Shelf - Check中的Just for fun,同时增进本课所学。如:

When’s the pop music/dance music?

Where are the country CDs/jazz CDs?

I don’t know! You don't? No, I don’t. I don't work here.

练习设计

随堂练习设计

按要求做题

downstairs(反义词) videos,

将下列词组翻译成英语。

在…的旁边 在…和…之间 上楼 下楼

一直往前走 向右转 爵士音乐 古典音乐

个性练习设计

翻译下列句子:

1、流行乐在哪里?上楼后向右转。在舞曲的旁边

2、舞曲在哪里?上楼后一直往前走。它在流行乐和乡村乐的旁边。

3. 乡村乐碟在哪里?他们在舞曲碟的旁边

4. 爵士乐碟在哪里?它们在乡村乐的旁边。

板书设计

Unit 6 Where um the jam CDs?

1, Where’s the pop music? go straight

Go upstairs and turn right. go upstairs-go downstairs

It’s next to the dance music. pop music

2,Where are the country CDs? Between …and …

They are behind the jazz CDs.turn right/left

Section A(二)

教学内容

Section A中3,4以及Self check中1,2两部分

教学目标

知识与能力

1. Match the vocabulary : group, singer

2. Master and use:What’s yaw favorite kind of music?

My favorite kind of music is country.

过程与方法

通过“What’s Bob’s favorite kind of music?”引入创设情景,引起学生的兴趣。并借助多媒体来提高学生的主动性,让其大量练习。

情感态度价值观

在上节课的基础上,对于音乐分类的表达和指点位置更加熟练,运用自如。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

1. The vocabulary.

2. language points: What's your favorite kind of music?

My favorite kind of music is country.

Who's your favorite group?

My favorite group is The Smith Family.

难点

The language points

教学突破

在摹仿的基础上逐渐能用单词替换的方式熟记表达法。

教学准备

教师准备

录音机、磁带、课件、光碟

学生准备

预习生词和课文。

将自己最喜欢的歌手或乐队列出,并将其歌曲分类。

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用

Step 1

Organization(1’) Organize Ss by greeting each other.

Step 2

Free talk (2’) Ask the students

1. “Who is on duty?”

If there’s a student who doesn’t come, then ask

2. “Is everyone here?”

3. “Where is he /she?”

4. “Why he/she isn’t here today?” Answer.

Step 3

Revision (5’) 1. Draw a set of stairs on the Bb, at the top of the stairs, write “dance” in a box, and “pop” in a box in its right, and “country” on its left, behind the pop box write “jazz”, and behind the country box write “classical”

2. 2. Let the Ss works in pairs, practice the dialogues by looking at the picture. Ss work in pairs

1. “Where’s the pop music?” “Go upstairs and turn right. It’s next to the dance music.”

2. “Where’s the jazz music?” “Go straight and turn left. It’s …

3. …4. …

Step 4

Presentation (15’) 1.处是些听风的一张图片,问学生 “Who is he?”

Let the Ss answer. Then say: “Yes, you’re right, he is xie tingfeng.”

Ask a student “What is he? /What does he do?” (student can answer in Chinese.)

“Yes, he is a singer.” Teach the word ‘singer’.(sing-singer)

2. 让学生无人一组谈论

“Who is your favorite singer?”

“Who is your favorite group?”

“What’s your favorite kind of music?”

Let the Ss write their answers in the chart on the book (SectionA, 4)

3. Ask a student the other four’s favorite singer/goup/kind of music. eg, ask Wang Ping:

“Who is Li Ming’s favorite singer/group?”

“What’s Li Ming’s favorite kind of music?”

4. Let the Ss work in pairs. Ask the other three Ss in their group their favorite singer/group/kind of music.

5. Let a student describe the musical tasts of the other Ss in thir groups. Such as: Liu Fang’s favorite kind of music is dance, and his favorite singer is Sun Yue.

6. Tell the Ss “If I’m student A, if I want to know what Bob’s favorite kind of music is, what should I ask?” “Yes, I should ask ‘What’s favorite kind of music?’”

7. Ask the pairs to continue on their own.

Move around the room monitoring the progress of the pairs.

8. Go over the answers.

The answer are:

Bob: classical The Boston Orchestra

Carla: jazz Boys from Brzil

Mary: dance Patsy Street

Joe: country The Smith Family

Ss answer: ‘He is Xie Tingfeng.”

Answer my question in Chinese or English

Ss work in group of

five.

“Who is your favorite singer?”

“Who is your favorite group?”

“What’s your favorite kind of music?”

Ask the other’s favorite singer/group/kind of music Work in groups.

Ss describe the musical tastes of the other Ss in their group.

Ss listen carefully

Work in pairs

Student A in each pair look at the chart on Page 37. Student B look at e the chart on Page92

Ask and answer

“What’s Bob’s/Carla’s/Mary’s/Joe’s favorite kind of music?” and so on. 多媒体放映

Step5

Consolidation(6’) Give Ss five minutes to consolidate the language points by practicing the dialogues which this class have learned in pairs. Work in pairs.

Step 6

Summary

(2’) Summa the language points of this lesson.

Show the teaching aims. Ss read after the teacher. 多媒体放映

Step 7

Test(8’) Self Check1, 2.

Ask Ss to check all the words they know.

Ask Ss to find out the meaning of any words they don’t know. They can do this by reviewing to unit, asking the teacher, asking their classmates, or using dictionaries.

Ask Ss to write five new words in their Vocabulary on Page 106.

After Ss to have recorded their new words, ask to have recorded their new words, ask them to share their lists with other Ss.

2. 同练习设计 Check all the words they know.

Find out the meaning of any words they don’t know.

Work in groups.

Homework

(1’) 1 Practice the dialogue in pairs after class.

“What ‘s your favorite kind of music?”

“Who’s your favorite singer/group?”

2 预习Section B 中的1a, 1b, 2a, 2b, 2c.

本课小结

本节学习了2个生词和What's your favorite kind of music?及Who's Bob's favorit group/singer句式的练习和运用。通过本节课的学习,学生能熟练地用英语谈论自〔喜欢的歌词和乐队。

教学探讨与反思

教师通过展示明星卡片,来引起学生的兴趣,通过对自己喜欢的歌手和乐队的谈论,(例如小组谈论”Who is your favorite singer?’’“Who is your favorite group?’

“What's your favorite kind of music?’),引导学生联系实际,谈论一下当前国内-些较为流行的音乐,歌手及乐队等.

练习设计

(A类学生全做,B类学生只做1)

1按要求变换下列句子。

(1) My favorite kind of music is country.(划线提问)

(2) Bob’s favorite group is the Smith Family.(划线提问)

(3 ) My mother's favorite singer is Cheng Long.(划线提问)

2在横线上填上适当的介词

(1) Please look ______this page.

(2) Work ______small groups. Ask your classmates ______ their favorite groups or singers.

(3) Where's the pop music?It's next ________ the dance music.

(4) What's your favorite kind ______ music?

板书设计

Unit 6 Where are the jazz CDs

1 What’s Bob’s favorite kind of music? sing-singer

His favorite kind of music is … in small groups

2. Who’s Carla’s favorite group? Look at

Her favorite group is …

教学内容

Section B中1a, 1b, 2a, 2b, 2c

教学目标

知识能力

1. Master the vocabulary: amazing awful bad Latin sound

2. Can talk about singers or musical groups

过程与方法

学生在本单元Section A中已学过不同风格的音乐如;jazz music, dance music, classical music等,已具备了学习本课的初步知识,课前通过放不同风格的乐曲录音来导人新课,让学生通过听录音后的感受,来谈论他们喜欢的歌手或乐队。

情感态度价值观

教育学生学会欣赏不同风格的音乐,陶冶他们的情操。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

1 The vocabulary

2 Language:Talk about singer or musical groups

难点

Talk about singers or musical groups

教学突破

1. 本课学习的单词主要是一些表示感情色彩的形容词,可通过丰富的表情演示来学习

2. Language放音乐录音,让学生边听边谈

教学准备

教师准备

录音机、磁带(不同风格的音乐磁带)课件

学生准备

预习生词,收集自己喜欢的歌手或乐队的资料

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用

Step l

Organization

(1’) Organize Ss by greeting each other

Step 2

Free talk(2}) Ask the student:

1 “Who is on duty?”

2 “What’s your favorite kind of music?”

3“Who’s your favorite singer/ group?” The student talk about something

Step3

Presentation

(15') la:

1.Focus attention on the three faces:

Guide students to understand the meanings of the three faces: the snide face means“I like it”.The middle face with no smile means “I don’t like it or dislike it“. The frown face means ”I don’t like it“ 读单词并根据单词意思做出不同的表情

2.Then call attention to the list of words. Say each one and ask student's to repeat then talk about what it means.

(借助面部表情及声音来解释单词并让学生根据不同的单词做出不同的表情)

3.Ask students to draw the correct face on the line to each word. Draw the correct face

on the line.

1b:

1.Play a piece of dance music let students listen then ask them:Do you like the dance music?

Guide the students to answer:

”Yes,I do. It’s awful.” Then play another type of music, such as classical, jazz, country and so on

2.Ask each student to make a list of three singers or musical groups then ask them to work on pairs:

A: Do you like the Latin Sound?

B:No,I don’t.They’re awful.

C:Do you like?

D: Yes,I do.No, I don’t.

2a:

1.Let the Ss look at the chart and the pictures of the four students,tell them they will listen to recording of these four persons.Write the name

of each person’s favorite kind of music/favorite groups/singer and Description word in the blank under their photo,Then play the recording the first time, Ss only listen

2. Play the recording again.This time students listen and write their answers in the chart. Listen the music and

answer the question.

Make a list

Work in pairs

Do you like?

Yes …

No, ….

Listen to the cording

Listen and write.

Look at the chart.

Listen and complete

the chart.

2b Play the

tape

录音机

录音机

1. let Ss look at the chart on the right, tell them that we will listen the recording again. listen and complete the chart.

2. Play the tape,students write the favorite group or singer and the description words in the chart.

Step 4

Practice

(5’) 2c:

Tell the students: This activity we will work in pain,you are Mike and your deskmate is Judy. Have a conversation about music like 2b. Talk about the music in pairs

Step 5

Summary

(2') 1.Words and phrases of this class

2. Language points talk about singers and musical groups. Talk about the music in pairs

Step 6

Consolidation

(8') Show the pictures of Tian Zhen, Na Ying.,Sun Nan,Beyound group,Yuquan and play their music,

let the students talk about them. Look, listen and talk 课件

(二)

Step 7

Homework(1’) 1.预习Section B中句3a,3b,3c

2画张学校的平面图

本课小结

本节课学习了5个生词和Do you like? What's your favorite句式的练习和运用。通过本节课的学习,学生能更加熟练地用英语谈论自己喜欢的歌词和乐队。

教学探讨与反思

通过对国外某些歌手和乐队(Who’s your favorite singer/group?What’s your favorite kind of music?)的谈论,引导学生联系实际,谈论一下当前国内一些较为流行的音乐,歌手及乐队等.

练习设计

(见课件Test)

板书设计

Unit 6. Where are the jazz CDs?

1 amazing, awful,bad, 3 Do you like The Latin

great sound,terrible, No,I don’t.They’re awful /fantastic

2 What' your favorite... 4 Do you like Livinia Casey?

My favorite…is… Yes,I do.She's cool.

Section B(二)

教学内容

Section B中3a,3b,3c,4和Self Check中3.

教学目标

知识与能力

1. The words(three skills): direction,culture, palace, area,western,eastern,hall,traditional,and,painting, by, and so on,gate

2. Master: How to give directions to the places that people ask you.

过程与方法

学生在第一课时就已经学会指引方向,已具备了学习本课的知识,这是第一课时的进一步学习。通过询问学生其学校所在地来引人创设情景,让学生有身临其境之感。需大量练习口头表达,同时提高学生的英语阅读能力。

情感态度价值观

正确表达各种情绪:

喜欢,不喜欢等等。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

1 The vocabulary

2 How to give directions

难点

How to give directions.

教学突破

1、对于生词学生只要会读、说、听就可以了,学生通过查阅字典或问老师或问同伴来自己解决,提高学生的自学能力。

2、对于方向的指引,通过大量的练习和课件的图画来突破解决。

教学准备

教师准备

课件

学生准备

预习生词和课文。

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用

Step 1

Organization

(1’) Organize Ss by greeting each other.

Step 2

Free talk

(2') Ask the students:

1.“Who is on duty?”

2.“What's your favorite kind of music?”

3. “Who’s your favorite singer / group?” Students answer my questions

Step3

Presentation

(15’) 1.“Now,pop music fans,listen carefully,if you,here”.(Start with a circle and label it.“You are here“)

Read the first set of instructions,draw a map of the pop store.

For example,when you read the words “Go straight’,draw an arrow straight up.

When you read the words “Turn left at the classical music’,

draw a box and label it‘classical music’,Then continue your first arrow around this box to the left.

Let Ss draw a map on the exercises books.

At the same time,let the other Ss look at the country music section, draw a map.in groups of four.

Let Ss work in groups of four,check the accuracy of the map by reading the instructions as their fingers through the map.

2.(3b),First,let the Ss look at the Big Sound music store map Point to each section of the store and ask Ss to read all the labels on the drawing.

Then ask Ss to fill in the missing words by themselves.

(As Ss work,the teacher can move around the room monitoring progress and answering any questions they may have.)The third,ask the Ss to check each other' s

won,and the teacher check the answers Pop music fans draw a map on their Exs books.

Draw maps

Ss work in groups of four.

Ss use their fingers to trace the path.

to the classical music section. 多媒体

投影地

3,Let the Ss write directions to the jazz/dance/country/pop sections. They can use the same kind of sentences.(As Ss work,the teacher can move around the mom monitoring progress and answering any questions they may have.)Ask Ss to check each other's work.Then

check the answers. Write directions 多媒体

投影地

图多媒

体投影

Step 4

Practice

(7’) From each group to be the first to give directions to be a location somewhere in the school.Tell the students that the first student to correctly guess the answer takes the next turn.

Self check(3a)

1.Let the students read the article by themselves.Find out the words that don't know list it. They can learn them by looking them up the directions or asking the teacher or the classmates or looking at the books.

2.Let the students read the words they don’t know after the teacher. Summa, the language points of this unit.

(见小结)

见练习设计。 Work in groups

Ss do the activity 多媒体

投影学

校平面

本课小结

本节课还是主要练习了问路与指路,同时在selfcheck中接触到了一些生词,学生只要做到会听、说就可以了。

问题探究与拓展活动

本节课中,可以让学生在知道west一western,east ---eastern的同时,自己找出表示方向的名词转换为形容词时在其后面直接加ern就可以了。(例如south一southern, north一northern, southeast一southeastern northeast一northeastern,…等等。)并出训练题,如个性练习。

练习设计

随堂练习设计

用适当的介词填空:

1.Direction _____ the Country Music section.

2.Turn left _____ the classical music

3.Pop music is _____ jazz and dance.

4.Look _____ the Big Sound music store map.Then fill ______ the blanks.

5.The classical music is next ______ the country music.

6. Welcome ________ the Culture Palace.

7.You can listen _______ classical music ______ Area E.

8.There you can see the traditional paintings ______ Qi Baishi.

个性练习设计

用所给词的适当形式填空。

1.We have a _______ (west) section,the left,and on ______ (east)section on the right.

2.a _______ (northeast)wind(东北风)

A _________(southeast)wind(东南风)

3.the _______ States of the U.S.A.(south)(美国南部各州)

4.The _______ (north)States of the U.S.A

注:解说表示方向的n.+ern就成了形容词

板书设计

Unit 6.Where are the jazz CDs?

Go straight west一western

Turn left at the east一eastern

pop section. south一southern

The classical music is north一northern

next to the country southeast一southeastern

music northwest一northwestern

教学探讨与反思

在本单元的教学中,多数学生能按照老师的要求掌握好大纲的内容,而且本单元的内容与学生的生活息息相关,在现实生活中经常遇到,也经常谈论。通过小组练习、讨论,练习“Where’s the jazz music?” “It's …”. ”What’s your favorite kind of music?”“It’s …” “Who's your favorite singer?……多数学生掌握得相当好。但是学生的自主学习能力尚待提高。

七年级英语教案【篇3】

【学习目标】:

1、熟练掌握本课13个单词.

2、谈论对方喜欢或不喜欢的食物。

【学习重点】:

名词的复数形式。

【学习过程】:

一、自主学习(教师寄语:knowledge is power.)

学习任务一: 会读写本课13个单词.

1.个人自读,记忆本课单词.

2.小组互相检查单词读写情况.

3.根据汉语写出下列英语单词并展示

喜欢___________香蕉_____________汉堡包___________西红柿_________

花椰菜_________薯条_____________橙子_____________冰____________

奶油__________ 冰淇淋_________ 沙拉___________ 草莓_________梨__________

学习任务二: 谈论对方喜欢或不喜欢的食物。

1. 录音完成1b ( 面的对话编号)

2. 两人一组练习1b 对话.

3. pair work 和你同伴模仿1b对话.编新对话.

二、合作共建(教师寄语:many hands make light work. )

小组讨论你所学的不可数名词.

_______________________________________________________

三、系统总结(教师寄语:no man can do two things at once.)

i. 一般情况下加 -s . 如: book books

hamburger _____________pear__________ banana_______________ orange_________ ii. 以 o 结尾的加 -s 或-es 如: photo photos

tomato _______________

iii. 以 s . sh ch . x 结尾的`加-es 如: watch watches

bus _________

iv . 以辅音字母加 y 结尾的变 y 为 i 加 es . 如: dictionary dictionaries

strawberry __________ family _______________

四、 诊断评价:

(一) 翻译下列句子.

1.我喜欢花椰菜。

____________________________________________________________

2.我不喜欢橘子。

__________________________________________________________

3.他喜欢西红柿.

__________________________________________________________

4.她不喜欢梨.

____________________________________________________________

5.你喜欢冰淇淋吗?不,我不喜欢

__________________________________________________________

6.你喜欢草莓吗?是的,我喜欢。

________________________________________________________

(二) 根据句意及汉意写出下列单词

(1) do you l ________ salad ?

(2) i want to eat some b _________.

七年级英语教案【篇4】

七年级上册语文知识点教案第一课

开学第一课

欢迎大家来到崭新的语文课堂,上次我们已经接受了小初中衔接的辅导,同学们拿到这本七年级上的语文课本也有很长时间了,已经翻阅过的请举手?你们感觉初中语文和小学语文有什么不同的地方?

今天这节课,我们先不进入我们的课文学习,我们不妨先进行一场进入初中语文课堂的的欢迎仪式,或者说是语文学习的启动仪式。这场欢迎仪式将分为三个主题:一、欢迎大家来到语文大课堂;二、欢迎大家来到语文大乐园;三、确定语文学习的目标。

切入主题之前,我首先要讲一下学习上的要求:

⒈准备四本本子:

①笔记本(学习日志):每一天都记号日期,记下错题、基础字词知识、上课要求、作业要求、课堂重点内容,来不及先记书上,课后整理,课下反反复复多回顾。

②作业本③听写默写本④作文本⑤课余读书摘抄本 读书札记

⒉准备好语文学习工具书:《现代汉语词典》 《古汉语常用字字典》 商务印书馆

⒊上课要求:

①双手放桌上

②除规定的讨论朗读时间外,保持教室安静,不讲和上课内容无关的话,树立公共课堂的公共意识,上课不认真不守纪律由课代表扣分记入期末总评成绩

③主动答疑:课上完之后,都可以到办公室提出疑问。

⒋作业要求:

按时完成作业,字写端正,第二天到校立即上交小组长,没有做完的(包括听默写没有通过)中午到办公室检查,完成后回家

预习:字词摘录、课文熟读、思考课后问题

一、欢迎大家来到语文大课堂

我们看到幻灯片上特别凸显了这个“大”字,所谓海纳百川,有容乃大,语文两个字的解释是:语言和文字以及语言和文学。它有一个很大的彰显其特色的学习范围,你的视野会变得非常开阔。

初中语文的学习内容:

⒈课文:

现代诗歌、现代散文、民间传说、说明文(科学技术、经济社会)、新闻通讯、人物传记、小说节选、微型小说、文言文、古典诗词。

人物分析、语言分析、情感分析、段落分析、语义分析、自我启发和感悟

⒉语言文字基础:

现代文:注音、字形、多音字、成语、熟语、造句、词义、句型、修辞、语法、标点符号。

文言文、古诗词:文言实词、文言虚词、文言句式、通假字、古今异义

⒊写作:以记叙、抒情、议论文章为主

以上这些是我们三年系统性的学习要接触的内容,由此可见第一即是内容范围上的大,跨越古今、国别,现代性、古典性、启蒙性、社会性相杂糅。第二则是学习效用之大,小学时你们的老师肯定说过,学好语文就意味着为其他学科的审题解答奠定基础,语言文字是人类沟通交流最基本的条件,在一些思想家比如卢梭看来,语言文字认识和接受的不平等是人类不平等的起源之一,语言被划为了贵族语言和平民语言,文字只有少数人才能掌握,导致了人类的贵贱有别,而我们现代教育的语文学习即是要打破这种不平等,要每个人都掌握相同的语言文字运用才能,获得人类文明中平等的认知权、沟通权和思考权。

二、欢迎大家来到语文大乐园

下面我们来继续探讨语文学习的第二个主题,我们学习语文的概念,不仅仅局限在简单地阅读分析课文,写命题考场作文,以及反复的做题上,这是理科的学习方法。语文学习在课堂外有很大的延伸空间,这就是所谓的大乐园主题。学习应该是充满乐趣的,我们应该提倡一种快乐语文的学习方式,这些乐趣总的体现在:

⒈阅读的乐趣

上课,完成作业,只是我们看到的学习的表面,学好语文,离不开阅读大量的文字,阅读应该与我们的生活密切联系,一本课外的好书可以提前几年提升你的知识境界,可以更新你的知识含量,21世纪一份报纸一周的信息量比18世纪人类一生掌握的信息量还多。你们不用抱着学会什么的任务心态去阅读,要利用课余非学习的时间,仅仅是捧起一本书,随意的翻开,不用怕读不懂,第一遍不懂,多读几遍肯定就会有自己的理解。抄下你感到有意义的句子,当你确实有了很深的感悟想要抒发的话,写一篇读后感是水到渠成的事。

有这么一个一个故事,俄国作家契诃夫写过一篇短篇小说叫做《打赌》,讲的是一次晚会上,银行家和一个年轻的律师打赌,律师将在一间小屋里囚禁,“规定在十五年间他无权跨出门槛,看见活人,听见人声,收到信件和报纸。允许他有一样乐器,可以读书、写信、喝酒和抽烟。跟外界的联系,根据契约,他只能通过一个为此特设的小窗口进行,而且不许说话。他需要的东西,如书,乐谱,酒等等,他可以写在纸条上,要多少给多少,但只能通过窗口。”按照约定,15年后,他将得到银行家的大半财产。15年过去了,年轻人除了每天要求外界给他送书,始终没有走出过屋子一步,到达规定日期的前一天,银行家反悔了,他决定在深夜潜入屋子,杀死那个年轻律师,守住自己的财富。一根将要燃尽的蜡烛旁边,他看到已经骨瘦如柴的年轻人正熟睡着,旁边放着一封刚刚写好的信:信中说,他感谢企业家,十五年来他读了许多书,这些知识将是他终身用不尽的财富,他还明白了许多道理。他决定不再要企业家的财产,他将于明天拂晓前破窗而出,自动毁约。一起来听一下信中的一段话:

十五年来,我潜心研究人间的生活。的确,我看不见天地和人们,但在你们的书里我喝着香醇的美酒,我唱歌,在树林里追逐鹿群和野猪,和女人谈情说爱……由你们天才的诗人凭借神来之笔创造出的无数美女,轻盈得犹如臼云,夜里常常来探访我,对我小声讲述着神奇的故事,听得我神迷心醉。在你们的书里,我攀登上艾尔布鲁士和勃朗峰的顶巅,从那里观看早晨的日出,观看如血的晚霞如何染红了天空、海洋和林立的山峰。我站在那里,看到在我的上空雷电如何劈开乌云,像人蛇般游弋;我看到绿色的森林、原野、河流、湖泊、城市,听到塞王的歌唱和牧笛的吹奏;我甚至触摸过美丽的魔鬼的翅膀,它们飞来居然跟我谈论上帝……在你们的书里我也坠入过无底的深渊,我创造奇迹,行凶杀人,烧毁城市,宣扬新的宗教,征服了无数王国……

你们的书给了我智慧。不倦的人类思想千百年来所创造的一切,如今浓缩成一团,藏在我的头颅里。我知道我比你们所有的人都聪明。

我也蔑视你们的书,蔑视人间的各种幸福和智慧。一切都微不足道,转瞬即逝,虚幻莫测,不足为信,有如海市蜃楼。虽然你们骄傲、聪明而美丽,然而死亡会把你们彻底消灭,就降消灭地窖里的耗子一样,而你们的子孙后代,你们的历史,你们的不朽天才,将随着地球一起或者冻结成冰,或者烧毁。为了用行动向你们表明我蔑视你们赖以生活的一切,我放弃那两百万,虽说我曾经对它像对天堂一样梦寐以求,可是现在我蔑视它。为了放弃这一权利,我决定在规定期限之前五个小时离开这里,从而违反契约……

银行家最后放弃了杀他的打算,律师则在第二天早晨偷偷地离开了屋子。他的感悟虽然有些极端,但我们可以看到,真正的阅读是充满无限吸引力的。

你们处在中考的学习压力下,课堂语文学习会以考试做题为中心,这很容易让你们沦为考试工具,失去思想和智慧的发展潜能,为了开阔视野,我们更需要培养阅读兴趣,把读书当做信仰一般,这样,不久的将来,你们既能升入好的高中,同时也会装满丰富的思想,让自己的人生充满更多乐趣。

⒉电影、音乐的乐趣

一本好电影比我们的课文有更深的心灵震荡,一首好的歌词会有诗一样的语言,让我们获得更美的文字体验。

三、确定语文学习的目标

阅读、欣赏电影和音乐,提升的是我们的文艺素养和气质,我希望这是你们一辈子都离不开的事。但是三年,我们有一个短期的目标,每一学期的期末考,三年后的中考,要检查你掌握的知识能力,决定你能不能升入杭二、学军、杭高这样的全国名校。所以我们的学习目标是这样的:掌握良好的阅读文章能力、文字运用及写作能力;会背诵一定篇目的古诗词、文章;掌握现代文、文言文的基础字词知识。我的要求是:把我当做你们的向导,跟着我,多思考,把每一次课当做一步楼梯,一步一步的走,认认真真地上好课,做好作业,背诵好文字,持之以恒,千万不要落下。

确定课代表、组长

作业:预习第一篇课文

我的语文学习目标

我最喜欢的一本书

我期待一个什么样的语文老师

学习语文的方法

1、注重日常积累:语文考验的是自己肚中的墨水,若是自己没有一定知识累积的话,语文成绩自然不高。所以想要提升语文成绩,平时更应该注重诗词好句的积累。

2、学会理解文章:通过理清文章的结构层次,明确课文的内在逻辑,把结构层级作为记忆线索,形成知识网络,更能方便记忆。

3、学会观察周围:写作是源于生活的,最打动人的往往是细节之处。所以平时要多观察生活,写作时多做细节描写,才能真正为作文进行润色,让老师能眼前一亮。

学习语文的技巧

1、学习未动,兴趣先行

2、务学与求道

3、自信是成功的第一秘诀

4、态度决定一切

5、不强调进步

6、练就过硬的本领是学习的根本目的

7、会玩、会偷懒、然后会学

8、考试、分析考试结果、做出下一步计划、调整自己

9、学习别人

七年级英语教案【篇5】

1.词汇(略)。

2.句型:

1) What would you/he/she like?

2)Would you like…?

3)I/He/Shed like…

4)What about…?

1.复习。重复上一课步骤4。

2.教师手持食物和饮料的图片,问某个同学:Would you like some bread? 让学生猜这句话意思。如猜不出,教师可加以解释,并板书这个句子。如果这个同学答:Yes,则请他(或她)站在前面,手持画有几个面包的图片,面向大家。

问答继续进行。先后请4位同学,手里各持一张表示自己想要的食物(或饮料)的图片。这时教师手指这4位同学,向全班提问:

让学生猜这句话含义,并板书这句话。启发大家按前面4位同学手中图画的内容,分别答出:

…would like some bread… would like some apples, etc.

教师可以再问这4位同学一次,启发他们分别用以下句型回答问题:

T:…, what would you like?

3.打开课本,按课文第一部分所列的问题,两人一组先找出答案,然后进行问答练习。请几组同学读出自己的小对话。

4.指导学生看课文第二部分插图,教师解释当时的情景,并教本课生词。

5.放课文录音。教师先板书一个问题:

What would they like?

学生听两遍录音,回答教师的问题。再放录音,学生跟读两至三遍。

6.教师重点讲解本课表示征求意见、表达愿望的几个主要句型。

7.两人一组,用课文第三部分所提供的替换词,编新的小对话。请两组同学表演。

8.指导学生做练习册习题,教师重点讲解习题2的内容。

1)抄写生词、练习朗读本课对话,牢记本课主要句型;

1.Can I help you? 您要点什么?

这是一句服务用语,类似的句子还有:What can I do for you? 例如:

A:What can I do for you? 您要点什么?

B:Id like some cakes, please. 我要些蛋糕。

2.What would you like? 你喜欢要点什么?

这是很客气的用语,来征求对方意见。服务人员,如:售货员、饭店服务员等在工作中经常使用这种语言。

如果家里来了客人,你请别人吃东西时,也可以使用这句话,让客人根据个人爱好去选择食品。询问对方是否喜欢吃某种食品,使用这个句型的一般疑问形式。

如:Would you like some bananas? 你吃点香蕉吗?

当表示自己想要什么东西时,可以用 I would like…这个句子来表达。

例如:

I would like a cup of tea, and four cakes, please. 我想要一杯茶,四块蛋糕。

在口语中,I would like通常缩略为:Id like…

3.What about something to eat? 来点吃的东西怎么样?

在这个短语中,动词不定式to eat放在something之后,起定语作用。可以理解为吃的东西。而something to drink就是喝的饮料了。

something是不定代词,不定代词被定语修饰时,一般定语要后置。

例如:Thats something very old. 这东西太旧了。

1. — What would you like?

— Id like some bread.

2. What would they like?

3. Can I help you?

4. What about something to eat?

七年级英语教案【篇6】

七年级英语上册复习教案

以下是为您推荐的七年级英语上册Unit3复习学案,希望本篇文章对您学习有所帮助。

一、重点句型。

1.I’mdressingupasaghost.我在装扮成一个魔鬼。

(1)dressup通常指小孩穿别人的衣服闹着玩,装扮;还只“穿上盛装,打扮”

MrSmithdressesupasFatherChristmasonChristmasEve.

史密斯先生在平安夜装扮成圣诞老人。

(2)as在句中用作介词,意为“好像”。(注意与dressupin的区别)

Asastudent,youshouldworkhard.作为学生,你应该努力学习。

2.GettingreadyforHalloween.为万圣节做准备。

getreadyfor意为“为……做准备”,后接名词或代词。

Wearegetreadyfortheparty.我们正在为聚会做准备。

3.Weplayagamecalled“trickortreat”.我们玩一个叫“不招待就是坏”的游戏。

agamecalled……:一个叫……的游戏;

called“trickortreat”是后置定语,用来修饰前面的游戏

a.Themancalled(named)Jamesismycousin.那个叫詹姆斯的'人是我的表哥。

b.TheycallhimJames.他们叫他詹姆斯。

4.Weknockonpeople’sdoorsandshout“trickortreat”.

(1)knockonpeople’sdoors意为“敲人家的门”,此处on可以用at代替。

Theteacherknockson(at)hisdesk.

(2)shout可以和at或者to连用,意为“朝着……喊叫”

Don’tshoutatothers.It’snotpolite.不要朝别人喊叫,这是不礼貌的

5.Usually,theygiveussomecandyasatreat.通常他们都用糖果招待我们。

givesbsthasatreat=givesbatreatofsth=givesthtosb.asatreat用某物招待某人

Theygiveusdumplingsasatreat.他们给我们饺子作为招待。

.=______________________________________=___________________________________

6.Iftheydon’tgiveusatreat,wecanplayatrickonthem.(if表示如果,假如)

(1)giveusatreat意为“招待我们”,这是givesb.sth.的结构,可用givesth.tosb.代替

(2)playatrick(tricks)onsb.属于固定结构,意为“作弄某人”。

Don’tplaytricksontheoldman.

7.Sometimeswepaintourfacesandpeopledonotknowwhoweare.

paint意为“给…..涂色”通常用于“paint+sth.+颜色”的结构。

Pleasepaintthewallgreen.请把墙涂绿。

8.Wecutouttheeyes,thenoseandthesharpteeth.

cutout在句子中意为“剪出,切出”

Ioftencutoutarticlesfromnewspapers.我经常从报纸上剪文章。

9.wearspecialcostumeswithmaskswith表示有或伴随的状态,是介词

Isawagirlwithredhair.我看见一个红头发的女孩。

10.make......outof……用…制成…

Wemakemodelplanesoutofpaper.我们用纸做成了模型飞机。

11.Wehavehotdrinksandeatlotsofnice,hotfood.

(1)drink饮料,food食物。一般是不可数,表示各种饮料和食物时,可当可数名词。

Let’shavesomedrink./manydifferentknidsofdrinks

(2)hotdrinks,热饮;colddrinks,冷饮。

(3)drimk也有动词是意思。如:Iwanttodrinksomewater.

二、词组归纳。

1.Let’scelebrate!

2.Whatareyoudoing?

3.dressupas

4.peopleintheUSA

5.getcardsandpresents

6.paintourfaces

7.ChineseNewYear

8.DragonBoatFestival

9.Mid-Autumnfestival

10.atHalloween

11.liketodosth.

12.atigercostume

13.getreadyfor

14.makelanternsoutoforanges

15.thanksb.fordoingsth.

16.tellsb.aboutsth.

17.celebrateChristmas

18.haveaspecialparty

19.ontheeveningofOctober31st

20.dosth.for

21.agamecalled“trickortreat”

22.knockon/at

23.givesb.sth.asatreat

24.playatrickonsb.

25.specialcostumeswithmasks

26.makepumpkinlanterns

27.cutoutthesharpteeth

28.eatturkey

29.eatricedumplings

让我们来庆祝!

你在干什么?

装扮成……样子

美国人

收到卡片和礼物

涂脸

中国的新年(春节)

端午节

中秋节

在万圣节

喜欢做某事

一件老虎戏服

为……做准备

用橘子做灯笼

感谢某人做某事

告诉某人有关某事

庆祝圣诞节

举行特殊的晚会

在十月三十一日的晚上

为……做某事

一个叫“不招待就使坏”的游戏

敲(门或窗)

以……招待某人

对某人使恶作剧

带面具的特别服装

制作南瓜灯

切、割出锋利的牙齿

吃火鸡

吃粽子

七年级英语教案【篇7】

一、作者简介

巴金,现代著名作家。原名李尧棠,字芾甘,19生于四川成都。建国后曾任中国文联副主席,中国作家协会副主席、主席,作协上海分会主席,上海文联主席,《收获》主编。主要作品有:长篇小说《爱情三部曲》(《雾》《雨》《电》),《激流三部曲》(《家》《春》《秋》);中篇小说《憩园》,《寒夜》;散文集《保卫和平的人们》,《友谊集》,《随想录》;散文、小说、特写集《新声集》,《赞歌集》,还有不少短篇小说、童话、杂文等。

二、《繁星》的写作背景

这篇文章选自巴金的《海上杂记》。1923年,19岁的巴金和三哥毅然冲破封建家庭的樊笼到了上海,南京,考入东南大学附中补习班。在学习期间,参加了一些社会活动,著名的五卅运动对他的影响较大,他的民主思想得到进一步发展。1927年1月15日,他乘法国轮船昂热号离沪赴法,卫惠林同行,先后同船的中国学生计9人。他去法国是为了学习经济学,向西方找真理,进一步研究无政府主义理论,考察欧洲的社会活动。法国既是无政府主义的发源地,也是当时欧洲的政治流放者的庇护所。2月18日,昂热号邮轮抵达马赛。19日巴金抵达巴黎。在邮船航行期间,巴金撰写了《海上杂记》38则。《繁星》是其中的一篇游记,写于1927年1月。

七年级英语教案【篇8】

一、教学目标:

1. 语言知识目标:

1) 能掌握以下单词: rain, windy, cloudy, sunny, snow, weather, cook, bad, park,

message, take a message, could, back, problem

能掌握以下句型:

① —How's the weather in Beijing?

—It's sunny.

② —Can I take a message for him?

—Yes. Could you just tell him to call me back?

—Sure, no problem.

2) 能用所学的知识描述天气情况。

3)描述正在发生的动作。

2. 情感态度价值观目标:

教育学生善于观察天气,善于调整自己的情绪;了解世界各地的天气情况,增加世界观念。知道大自然的力量是神奇而伟大的,我们应当好好学习,立志学好科学知识,为长大后探索神奇的大自然,打好基础。

二、教学重难点

1. 教学重点:

1) The vocabulary and useful expressions.

2) —How’s the weather?

—It's raining/ windy.

3) —What are you doing?

—I'm playing basketball.

2. 教学难点:

运用目标语言来对天气进行问答,并且会问答其他人正在进行的活动。

三、教学过程

Ⅰ. Warming-up and Lead in

1. Greet the Ss and check the homework.

2. Watch a video program about the weather.

Ⅱ. Presentation

1. (Show some pictures of the weather)

Let Ss look at the pictures and ask them how the weather is.

Ss learn the new words and expressions with the help of the pictures.

2. Look at the pictures in 1a. Then read the new words on the right. Ask the Ss to match the words with pictures.

3. Check the answers.

Ⅲ. Game (How's the weather?)

1. (Showing some pictures on the big screen.) Ask Ss "How's the weather?"

2. Ss guess and answer the question.

Ⅳ. Listening

1. Now let's look at the city names in the box in 1b. Please read after me.

Ss read the cities after the teacher.

2. Now, We’ll hear four conversations. Listen carefully, point out each city in the picture as it comes upon the tape. Play the recording a second time. Ask Ss to write the name of the city in the picture of its weather.

3. Check the answers.

Ⅴ. Pair work

1. Tell the Ss: If you are in one of the places in the picture above. Talk about the weather

with your friends in another city on the phone.

2. Make a model with a student like this:

T: Hi! How's the weather in Beijing?

S1: It's sunny.

3. Ss work in pairs. Ask and answer about the weather in the cities.

Ⅵ. Listening

1. Work on 2a.

Let's see what Joe's families are doing. Point to the 4 pictures.

2. Ask Ss tell each person is doing in each picture. More attentions should be paid

to the correct use of the Present Progressive Tense.

3. Play the recording for the Ss to listen and number the pictures [1-4].

4. Play the tape for Ss to check the answers.

5. With the whole picture, get some Ss to tell the story of it.

6. Brainstorming

Play the tape for another time. Then do a memory test.

Ask Ss: What's Uncle Joe/Jeff/Mary/Aunt Sarah doing?

What're Scott and Lucy doing?

Is Jeff watching TV? etc.

7. Let Ss match the names with the activities in 2b.

Play the recording for the Ss to check the answers.

Ⅶ. Pair work

1. Look at the pictures and talk about the people in 2a with a partner.

2. Ask a student the questions as a model:

T: What's Uncle Joe doing?

S1: He's playing basketball.

3. Ss work in pairs. Ask and answer about the pictures.

Ⅷ. Role-play

1. Ask Ss to read the conversation and answer the questions:

① What's Steve doing?

② What's Rick's brother doing?

Ss read the conversations and answer the questions. Then check the answers together.

2. Let Ss role-play the conversation in pairs.

IX. Language points.

X. Exercises

Homework:

一、总结有关天气的词汇。

二、编写三个有关天气问答的对话。

七年级英语教案(分享12篇)


教师的教学工作是有计划性的,在正式上课之前,对要进行的教学任务及流程进行详细的计划,小编准备了新人教版七年级英语上册教学计划,一起来看看吧!

七年级英语教案 篇1

新学期开始,我校就如火如荼的开展了“高效课堂教学模式”,六、七年级是我校“高效课堂实验班”这要求我要改变多年来轻车熟路的教学方式、教学行为。这对我是一个挑战、一次考验,如何把新教材教好,提高运用新课程的能力和水平,我决定以高昂的热情,虚心的态度,本着“加强理论学习的同时,在实践中反复摸索,在反思中进步”的原则,花了心思,下了苦功,有了收获。现总结如下:

1.加强理论学习,转变教学观念。

学校开学初就对全体任课教师进行了高效课堂理论学习。高效课堂主要是转变教学理念“生主体,师主导”调动学生学习的主动、积极性,让学生全面的参与课堂学习,争取班级全面丰收。高效课堂教学先给学生分组,我们班5—6人一组,共四组,每个小组设一名组长,其余为组员。组长负责带领小组提出问题、研讨问题、整理答案、小组汇报。小组成员也可以积极的提出问题,帮助组内成员解决问题,协助组长,解决小组问题。小组一盘棋,每个小组成员获得的分值计入总分,也算平时成绩,学生的学习热情非常高涨。回答问题时争先恐后。转变了教学观念,学生学习的积极性提高了

2.培养自主质疑的学习方法。“学贵有疑,小疑则小进,大疑则大进。”为达到自主质疑的要求,我逐步要求学生养成了书不读熟不开讲、每一次我都在讲新课的时候要求六、七年级的学生自学生字词、圈点批注等习惯,提出疑难问题。

3.在教学形式上,力图改变把学生禁锢在小小的课堂里、日复一日地重复单调枯燥的教学状况,采取多种多样的能充分体现学生自主学习、自主实践的形式,如:课内外找错别字、病句交流与展示,月球知识擂台赛,讨论会《风筝》,朗诵比赛《理想》、《天上的街市》、《静夜》,演课本剧《皇帝的新装》、《妈妈的唠叨》举办手抄报展览,学生在这一过程中收获很多,如在《钓鱼的启示》一文中我在与学生学习时我们发现课文中的一处错误,文中将“鱼竿”的鱼字写成“渔”同学们发现之后非常兴奋,“老师,我们头一次从课文中找到错别字”;“老师,咱们给出版社打电话告诉他们赶紧改过来”。

4.重视创设学习语文的环境,提供展示学生成果的机会。如在教室里开设《语文园地》、《优秀作业展》、等栏目,把学生的优秀作业、作文,课外书找到的资料,如讲到《化石吟》用1课时,要求学生在书上、报刊上、电脑上搜集有关化石的`文字资料或图片资料。

5.老师在课上努力营造融洽的氛围,学生只要有疑问,随时可以提出,只要有想法,随时可以发表,师生平等对话,同学间无拘无束地交流。课外充分利用学校、家庭、自然、社会中的语文教育资源,特别是那些鲜活的、密切联系现实、密切联系学生经验世界的教育资源,如节日、纪念日、刚发生的身边事、国家大事、国际新闻等,使语文课程内容不再局限于教科书,成为不断充实、不断更新的长流活水,在期末考试中我们班古玉波结合时事写的作文“与小月月并肩而行”写出了一个中学生可贵的爱你心,也能感受她强烈的社会责任感。

以上是我本学期教学过程的一个小结,当然还存在像读书交流会开展过少、作文写作缺乏指导等问题,以备今后改进。

七年级英语教案 篇2

新的一学期开始了,对于刚刚升入初一的学生来说,什么都是新的,为了更好地完成七年级教学任务,使他们尽快适应新的学习环境,特制定英语教学工作计划。

一、教学目标

努力使学生对英语学习表现出积极性和初步的自信心吗,让他们刚刚接触到英语就能良好地奴驾英语,让他们在起始阶段不产生为难情绪,能与老师或同学就熟悉的话题交换信息,能读懂小故事及其他问题的简单书面材料参观范例或借助图片写出材料,能尝试使用适当的学习方法客服学习中遇到的困难,能意识到语言交际中存在的人文差异。

二、教学重点

26个字母,48个音标,语法方面:名词,数词的用法,人称代词的用法,一般现在时的用法基础知识方面掌握各单元四会单词和一些交际用语,一些月份的单词和星期的单词。元音字母与元音字母组合在重读音节中的读音,辅音字母和辅音字母组合的`读音。

三、教学难点

掌握48个音标的读音,人称代词主格和宾格的用法,物主代词中形容词性物主代词和名词性物主代词的用法,动词的种类,如何用音节记忆单词,名词的复数不规则变化,句子的种类,陈述句疑问句祈使句感叹句般现在时态在结构与用法上的差异。

四、对教材分析

本套教材七年级下册有12个单元,每个单元分为sectionA和sectionB两部分组成。sectionA是该单元基本教学内容,包括词汇、语法、功能以及听力输入、口语输出,sectionB是词汇拓展。GrammarFocus部分通过例句呈现各单元重点语言现象,教材内容有利于学生的全面发展,教材应尽可能采用探究式促进学生拓展视野,培养创新精神和实践能力。

五、学情分析

初一年级学生刚刚升入初中,各种学习习惯还没有养成,上课不会听课,上课纪律差,学习态度散漫,各种学习方法还没有掌握,没有养成写作业习惯。

六、采取的措施

1.备课方面

认真专研课程标准,抓住教材的重点难点和关键词,从教学过程、教法知识与能力的培养,认真备课,努力采用“任务型”课堂教学方法,积极开展师生双边活动,努力提高学习效果,鼓励学生课上课下多讲英语,教师应尽量用英语组织教学,努力营造一个宽松、民主、和谐的英语教学氛围。

2.上课方面

上课鼓励学生通过讨论、合作、探究等方式发展听、说、读、写的语言运用技能。

3.作业布置及批改方面

分层次布置作业,根据因材施教原则,给尖子生要特殊留些难题,中等生做些基础题,差生可以做些简单题。

4.课外辅导及打算

对于基础差的学生,要对基础知识及时补救,同时对本册教材进行分单元辅导。

七年级英语教案 篇3

我校本学期七年级英语用的是新版教材,由于我校新生都来自农村,小学未开设英语,教学难度大,学生刚开始学习它费力费神。现就前一段教学情况小结如下:

第一册课本头几个单元都是从听说入手,听说训练的比重较大。围绕“问候”、“介绍”,说明人和物等题材教学日常用语,只要求听说,不要求读写。同时,第一二周从教学26个字母和少量单词开始教,要求听、说、读、写“四会”掌握。

1、字母教学。字母教学可以通过例词、例句来帮助学生掌握音和形,并以快速听写和快速认读卡片的练习方式来加强字母的音形在学生头脑中的印象,开展各种形式的字母音形联系比赛。

2、书写教学。在教学之前可先让学生观看书上和老师在黑板上的示范,在大脑里形成明晰的英语字母形象和老师在书写时的连续性,整体性示范动作形象。因此,就要严格要求学生认真观察,要使学生养成看——想——写三们一体,或动眼、动脑、动手一休化的良好习惯。

3、单词的拼读。语音与词江有着直接的联系,可以用音、形、义结合的方法记忆单词。因此,首先要从教字母起逐步让学生掌握拼读规则。其次是通过每课教学几个符合基本拼读规则的单音单词,使学生对拼读规则有个初步的概念。再就是以元音字母为中心,组合成更多的单词,设计不同的听、说、写的口头、笔头练习,让学生反复操练,可以达到看到符合拼读规则的'单词就能念出来,听到符合拼读规则的单词就能写出来的程度。

4、激发学生学习英语的积极性,培养学生学习英语的兴趣。好的开端是成功的一半,这样入门阶段的课堂教学显得尤为重要老师应昼用直观、形象的教学方法并结合简笔画、挂图、表演等进行教学,使学生感到新颖,有趣味,调节课堂气氛,充分发挥学生的主体作用。鼓励学生大胆地说英语。

通过以上四方面的教学,慢慢地让学生产生对学英语的兴趣。但是通过学生的学习英语来看还存在许多困惑:

1、词汇量大,学生记不住单词。

2、语法现象多,学生搞不清。

3、学生胆量小,怕羞,不善于交际。

4、学英语气氛不浓。

总之,学习英语一定要勤学苦练,要日积月累地坚持学习,要不怕困难,只有这样才能逐渐达到熟练运用的程度,达到能听懂、看懂英语,能用这个工具进行交际的目的。

七年级英语教案 篇4

一、指导思想

坚持“教书育人,为人师表”的教育宗旨,关心每一位学生的发展,爱岗敬业,以身作则,使学生了解英语在当今社会的重要性,增强学生世界观和人生观,使学生初步形成健全合格的中的学生,做一个对社会有用的人。

二、学生情况分析

我所教的本届七年级新生基础很差,由于在小学英语课并未受到足够的重视,学生在写的技能方面基本上没有得到过训练,连音标没讲过,甚至有一半的学生26个字母的拼读都没有掌握好。经过这两个星期我和学生的不懈努力,他们的基础知识得到了加强,学习态度也有所好转。部分学生有了主动学习的动力,但是整体的惰性还是很强,我要积极主动的帮助他们重新建立学习兴趣。

另外,学生在学习策略方面还存在很多需要进一步体会掌握的地方。很多学生不能明确学习英语的目的,没有真正认识到学习英语的'目的在于交流;有些同学在学习中缺乏小组合作意识,不愿和其他学生交流,不能共同完成学习任务;大多数同学不能做好课前预习和课后复习,学习没有计划性,完全在老师的指挥棒之下学习,没能力做到总结语言规律和知识的巩固、积累。这些都是我和学生要长期作战艰苦努力才能解决的问题。我会慢慢给学生们信心去完成这些任务的,急是没有用的。让学生们乐于接受我的教学指导,并找到自成体系的办法才是解决问题的关键。

三、教材分析

本册书主要介绍了日常生活的交际用语以及一些西方国家的文化背景和风俗习惯,教材通俗易懂,旨在使七年级学生基本能用英语进行简单的交流。本册书由两部分组成,即预备篇(4个模块)和正式篇(10个模块)。本书除提供语言材料外,还配有大量插图和原声录音磁带。

四、教学目标

通过努力,力求每一位学生能开口讲英语,能用英语进行简单的会话。通过努力使大部分学生继续保持学英语的兴趣。能保持浓厚的学习英语兴趣和积极主动参与实践,以点带面,力争达学校教学质量的要求。

五、教学措施和方法

措施:

1.培养学习兴趣,引导学生掌握正确的学习方法和策略,提高学习效率;

2.发挥学生主体和教师主导作用:

3.用良好的师生关系,协调课堂气氛,培养学生开口说英语的勇气和信心;

4.引导学生实现语言的迁移,加强日常生活中英语口语的运用;

5.鼓励学生自主探索,合用探究,共同提高;

6.加强听力训练。

方法:

任务型教学:教师提出指令,学生规范操作。听说领先,读写跟上。综合训练,扎实双基。

六、教学进度

略。

七年级英语教案 篇5

本学期我担任七年级英语教学工作,由于已经教了他们一个学期了,对他们的知识结构和本事比较了解。但我仍然坚持认真备课和批改作业,在教学、教研中继续探索和创新教学方法,并且总结经验教训,向教学经验丰富的教师学习,互补有无,取长补短,以提高自我的教学水平。总的来说,在本期的教学当中,我做了以下的工作:

一、教学工作:

本人对工作扎扎实实、兢兢业业,认为无论什么工作只要尽心尽力地去做,都会有一种成就感。在这种正确的思想和理念指导下,工作起来就如鱼得水。首先,我 认真地分析教材的编写特色及体系,懂得了中学英语必须要求掌握的学习资料,然后就有的放矢地结合中学生的生活实际进行口语、词汇、句型的练习。每次备课 时,我都细心研究教材、研究学生的分层和知识差异,穿插一些生动趣味的游戏活动以及中西方文化差异故事。经过这些活动,增强了学生的英语学习热情和兴趣。 并且,我经常有意识地给学生们创设说英语的环境,与同学们相遇时,尽可能用英语问候,当学生来办公室请教问题时,也总是要求他们用英语提问,课堂上也尽量 要求他们用英语提问。总之,经过一系列的`手段让学生体会到学、用英语的乐趣,养成使用英语的良好习惯和意识。

二、差生转化工作

差生转化工作也是英语教学的一个重要环节。如果教师只注重好生的教学那么我敢断定他的教学是失败的。好的教师应是经过抓两头,促中间的方法到达班级语言 水平的平衡、和谐发展。认识到这一点后,我经常利用课间和放学后的课余时光给差生补课。每次重点选择两个学生,根据课堂里发现的不足给他们“加餐”。这样 反复地重复所学知识,大部分学生能对本学期的资料很熟练地运用。为了提高学生的成绩,我还组织了英语兴趣小组,采取互帮互助的活动形式,使他们养成对英语 的浓厚兴趣。另外,英语课本剧的排练也是一个很好的兴趣培养方法,如英语剧《SARS Bedroom》。同学们经过排练增强了他们对英语学习的浓厚兴趣。

三、其他工作

在尽量教好本学期教学资料的同时,我还给学生补充了很多课外知识,这一切不仅仅扩大了学生的知识面,并且提高了学生的学习积极性。我看到很多教师都在课余时光对学生进行辅导,效果很好。逐步提高了上来。

总之,本期工作中的成绩是引以为豪的,不足之处也是在所难免的。我相信大家都一样,重要的是在下一学期的工作中戒骄戒躁,各项工作都能以更大的起色去博得家长挑剔目光的赞许、同仁敬佩目光的羡慕,领导钦佩目光的认同。

七年级英语教案 篇6

一、学生情况分析。

今年我担任七(5)(6)两个班的英语课,两个班共有学生113人,其中两个班的学生情况分析如下:学生在小学学过的英语已严重造成两极分化。勤奋对英语感兴趣的学生基础较好,每班6——10人,比较懒散缺乏良好学习习惯的连字母都认不清;大部分学生在读音,单词记忆尤其是音标上都有缺憾。从两班的优秀学生看,有缺腿现象,已经不同程度的出现了两极分化现象。

通过一周的观察,在学习习惯上需要拨正管理。班级人多,在听讲,字体书写、读书,回答问题等方面都需要细节上的.培养。

二、措施。

1、重点抓基础,抓单词,在教单词前先教会音标。

计划用三个星期时间教学48个音标。让学生学会通过音标记单词,课上教给学生记好笔记,重点单词、句子结构的用法,精讲多练,每天进行单词小测验。

2、抓早自习晨读,让学生大声朗读,通过开口读,达到增加语感,背诵课文目的。一开始先由教师师范领读,逐渐熟悉后选出朗读好的每天领读规定的课文和单词。时间为6:30-6:40。

3、课上注重语音、语调、语速的培养,快速流利的朗读课文,大声干脆的朗读课文。检查朗读情况,以小组为单位,组长负责把关,并且定期举行朗读比赛。

3、重点抓尖子生,鼓励低要求后进生,促进中间层。尖子生多提问,多布置作业,多鼓励高要求,对学困生采取兵教兵之术,及时进行课下辅导。

4、利用课余时间进行听课,取长补短,不断完善自己。

5、定期进行考试,检查。

三、教学进度表。

第1、2周:第一单元School and numbers。

第3、4周:第二单元Colour and clothes。

第5周:国庆放假。

第6、7周:第三单元Body and feerings单词竞赛。

第8、9周:第四单元Food and restaurants。

第10周:复习、期中考试。

第11、12周:第5单元Family and home。

第13、14周:第六单元Let’s go。

第15、16周:第七单元Days and months。

第17、18周:第八单元My country and English—speaking countries。

第19周:期末考试。

七年级英语教案 篇7

回顾这学期的工作,我圆满地完成了本学期的工作,使我感到既繁忙又充实,在不断的学习中,我的教学思想和教学水平都得到了很大的提高,并取得了一些成绩。但也存在不足,为了使我在今后的教育教学工作中取得更大的进步。下面我将这一学期的工作总结如下:

一、思想政治方面

在这学期的教学工作中,我自始至终以认真、严谨的工作态度,勤恳、坚持不懈的工作精神从事英语教学。我积极响应学校的各项号召,积极参加政治学习,认真领会学习内容,以教师职业道德规范为准绳,严格要自己。思想积极向上,要求进步。在教学中,能够做到为人师表,关爱学生,帮助学生对英语学习充满学习热情和信心,以健康文明的形象言传身教。

二、业务素质方面

为了适应农村中小学英语的需要,我不断地钻研新的教学理念,探索新的教学方法,不断将自己的所学运用到课堂教学之中,并取得了很好的教学效果。平时,注重业务资料的撰写,每天认真备课,认真上课,向课堂45分钟要质量。认真批改作业,定期对学生的学习效果进行测试,认真总结,查找不足。

三、教育教学工作方面

这学期我担任的是七年级的.英语教学。经验告诉我,对于这个年段的英语教学,如果不认真研究教法和学法,结合教材和学生的实际情况来教学,就会使学生失去对英语学习的兴趣。兴趣没了,英语自然也不会学好。因此,我对教学工作不敢怠慢,认真学习,勤于专研,注重在实践中积极探索新的教学方式,潜心研究英语课堂教学,深刻领会新课改的理念,注重激发和培养学生学习英语的兴趣,自制教具,自编儿歌等,使学生在轻松、愉快的氛围中学习和运用语言,树立学习英语的自信心,注重形成性评价在英语教学中的运用,并能够及时总结经验,提高自己的科研水平。

四、考勤请假方面。

我在做好各项教育教学工作的同时,严格遵守学校的各项规章制度。处理好学校工作与个人之间的关系,一年里尽量做到没有迟到现象,做到有事请假,坚持天天上班,一边完成学校的各项任务,一边准备教材和学习自己的专业知识。在新的一年里,我应更加勤奋,为学校作更多的事,自己更加努力学习专业知识,使自己的业务水平更上一层楼。

五、努力提高方向。

1、加强自身基本功的训练,注重对学生能力的培养;

2、对差生多些关心爱心和耐心,使他们在各方面有更大进步。

3、利用各种方法,训练学生提高、集中注意力。

4、在教学上狠下功夫,努力使学生的道德修养有更大的提高。

总之,在今后的工作中,我会更加努力学习,提高自身素质,严格要求自己,完善自我,以百倍的信心与努力去迎接未来的挑战!

七年级英语教案 篇8

一学期来,本人热爱本职工作,认真学习新的教育理论,广泛涉猎各种知识,形成比较完整的知识结构,严格要求学生,尊重学生,发扬教学民主,使学生学有所得,不断提高,从而不断提高自己的教学水平和思想觉悟,为了下一学年的教育工作做的更好,下面是本人的本学期的教学工作总结:

一、政治思想方面:

认真学习新的教育理论,及时更新教育理念。积极参加校本培训,并做了大量的政治笔记与理论笔记。新的教育形式不允许我们在课堂上重复讲书,我们必须具有先进的教育观念,才能适应教育的发展。所以我不但注重集体的政治理论学习,还注意从书本中汲取营养,认真学习仔细体会新形势下怎样做一名好教师。

二、教育教学方面:

要提高教学质量,关键是上好课。为了上好课,我做了下面的工作:

1、课前准备:备好课。

2、认真钻研教材,对教材的基本思想、基本概念,每句话、每个字都弄清楚,了解教材的结构,重点与难点,掌握知识的逻辑,能运用自如,知道应补充哪些资料,怎样才能教好。

3、了解学生原有的知识技能的质量,他们的兴趣、需要、方法、习惯,学习新知识可能会有哪些困难,采取相应的预防措施。

4、考虑教法,解决如何把已掌握的教材传授给学生,包括如何组织教材、如何安排每节课的活动。

5、课堂上的情况。组织好课堂教学,关注全体学生,注意信息反馈,调动学生的有意注意,使其保持相对稳定性,同时,激发学生的情感,使他们产生愉悦的心境,创造良好的课堂气氛,课堂语言简洁明了,课堂提问面向全体学生,注意引发学生学数学的兴趣,课堂上讲练结合,布置好家庭作业,作业少而精,减轻学生的负担。

6、要提高教学质量,还要做好课后辅导工作,小学生爱动、好玩,缺乏自控能力,常在学习上不能按时完成作业,有的学生抄袭作业,针对这种问题,就要抓好学生的思想教育,并使这一工作贯彻到对学生的学习指导中去,还要做好对学生学习的辅导和帮助工作,尤其在后进生的转化上,对后进生努力做到从友善开始,比如,握握他的手,摸摸他的头,或帮助整理衣服。从赞美着手,所有的人都渴望得到别人的理解和尊重,所以,和差生交谈时,对他的处境、想法表示深刻的理解和尊重,还有在批评学生之前,先谈谈自己工作的`不足。

7、积极参与听课、评课,虚心向同行学习教学方法,博采众长,提高教学水平。

8、热爱学生,平等的对待每一个学生,让他们都感受到老师的关心,良好的师生关系促进了学生的学习。

三、工作考勤方面:

我热爱自己的事业,从不因为个人的私事耽误工作的时间。每天早来晚走,积极运用有效的工作时间做好自己分内的工作。

当然了,在工作中还存在一些不尽人意的地方:

1、词汇教学手段单一词汇教学是英语教学中最重要的环节,学生对词汇的感觉也是难、难、难,在很大程度上,解决了词汇问题,学好英语就轻而易举了。但有时我在词汇教学方面疲于应付、手段单一、简单机械。往往是利用一节课时间专攻单词,解释、教读、听写,由于单词多而难,大部分学生掌握很差。

2、教学评价观念陈旧

评价是英语课程重要的有机组成部分,它在课程实施中起着激励、导向和质量监控的作用。科学的评价体系是实现课程目标的重要保证。新课程的评价理念强调以人为本,强调评价的实效,强调促进发展。但我在评价学生时仍然受传统评价方式的影响严重,评价方式简单、方法单调、内容片面、标准机械,只过分注重结果,忽视了学生在活动的各个时期的进步状况和努力程度。

针对自己存在的不足,今后的教学中要力求做到以下几点:

1、面向全体学生,注重素质教育

2、整体设计目标,体现灵活开放

3、突出学生主体,尊重个体差异

4、采用活动途径,倡导体验参与

5、注重过程评价,促进学生发展

6、开发课程资源,拓展学用渠道

走进21世纪,社会对教师的素质要求更高,在今后的教育教学工作中,我将更严格要求自己,努力工作,发扬优点,改正缺点,开拓前进,为美好的明天奉献自己的力量。

七年级英语教案 篇9

1、学生整体情况分析及相关对策

前几天,去学校给新生监考,在监考的过程中,我校的新生都能够自觉遵守考场纪律,这让我感到我校学生良好的素质,下午在阅卷的过程中,我分析了学生成绩情况,学生成绩整体不错,但学生成绩两级分化比较严重,我想,对学生掌握英语的程度不同,可以试着采用整体教学和分层教学相结合的方式完成教学任务,做到因材施教。另外,学生词汇、基本句型和语法方面有待于进一步提高,提高是为了更好的应用,我想这样才能做到基本英语对话的脱口而出。对此,在以后的教学中,我会以这些方面作为重点来提高学生英语的综合素质。

2、教材简析

之前通过对小学和初中教材的分析,我认为,初一教材不仅对四年小学英语的词汇和语法方面有一系列的巩固,而且还增加了一些新的元素,这就要求,教师的教学要从巩固到渗透,从渗透到创新。这样进行循序渐进的教学,不会由于知识过难而打消学生学习英语的积极性,也不会由于内容过于简单而使学生失去兴趣,进行科学系统的教学。

初一上册共有三个单元的预备篇和十二个单元的正式篇,每个单元都有sectionA和sectionB以及selfcheck三部分组成,以下对三部分简要分析:

SectionA:1a呈现了本单元的重点词汇,句型和相应的语法结构,1b起到承接1a的作用,为听力练习,1c是学生之间进行的对话练习2a和2b是扩展性的.听力练习,2c是扩展性的对话练习,另外,GrammarFocus,这一部分系统直观地呈现了之前练习到的语法知识。从3a到4部分是课堂活动部分,这部分整体起到学习新知识和巩固作用。

SectionB:1a和1b是在旧知识的基础上添加新知识,若有1c的话,一般为对话的练习,2a和2b都属扩展性的听力,若有2c的话,一般为对话的练习,3a到4部分是多样性的课堂活动,这部分整体起到巩固和扩展作用。

Selfcheck:测验同学用自己所学的知识,有一个自我评价,教材的趣味化也在此部分体现出来。

3、教学目标

首先,知识目标

运用“直观性、启发性、巩固性、循序渐进、因材施教等教学原则使学生能够正确认识书本知识,采用讲授、谈话、讨论、演示、练习、参观、实验等教学方法,使学生掌握重点词汇、句型和语法知识并应用,鼓励他们大胆的说出来,做到基本英语对话的脱口而出。

其次,能力目标

通过对初一上册英语知识的学习,使学生在听、说、读、写整体能力上有所提高,其中,我认为,为了深化双语实验学校教学特色,应该重点抓学生的听和说的能力。

最后,道德目标

要使学生真正明白,学习知识是为了什么?是为了提高自身的素质,是为了提高自身的能力,是为了在走出双语实验学校的校门后,能以焕然一新的面貌面对任何人。

4、教学措施

初一,是学习英语的关键时期,起着基础性作用,初中英语学习的状况,会直接影响到高中,还有大学的学习,所以初一英语教学起着至关重要的作用,对此,在教学中,我制定了以下的措施:

(一)备课

上好一堂,我认为备课起着很重要的作用,任何一堂高质量的课,都离不开教师的精心备课,对此,我将做到,全心投入,在遇到不明白的地方,及时和其他英语老师讨论研究,直到问题解决为止,多听听有经验老师的课堂教学(可以用视频在方式在网上观看),学习其教学方法,并加以总结,并鼓励自己进行创新。另外,了解学生原有的知识和能力基础及学习需要,对学生学习新知识可能存在的困难和问题进行预测。

(二)课堂教学

此方面是教学措施的中心环节,是引导学生掌握知识,提高思想素质和能力的关键。对此,我将做到以下几点:

首先,目标明确,明确每节课通过老师的课堂教学后,学习应达到的水平(在心理学上,叫做最近发展区),要最大限度的扩大学生的最近发展区,这里主要包括:知识水平、能力水平、素质水平。

其次,内容正确,要保证教给学生知识的科学性、系统性和正确性。

第三,方法得当,要选择合理的教学方法,并且科学地运用其方法,尽量做到因材施教,最大限度地发展学生的潜能。

第四,组织有效,我认为这个方面起到主导作用,一个班级拥有一个良好的课堂秩序,是保证教学效果的基础性因素,作为一名教师,要把课堂秩序组织的井然有序,气氛活跃,这样,才有利于学生思考深入。

第五,相互体验,“教学”教师的教要起到主导作用,学生的学要起到主动作用,学生和教师要以积极的状态体验教学,这样才能提高教学的效果。

(三)课外作业的布置和批改

我将做到几下几点:

第一,形式多样:根据不同的教学内容,给学生布置可以锻炼其各方面能力的作业,难易要适中。

第二,要求明确:对所布置的作用提出明确的要求,便于学生及时有效的完成。

第三,及时反馈:要及时给学生批改作业,并在批改的过程中,发现学生的优缺点,尤其是大多数同学存在的典型错误,分析产生的原因,以便于下次讲解,并对作业进行鉴定。

(四)课外辅导

课外辅导环节是对以上几个环节的补充,在此方面,我将做到:从实际出发,对学生进行因材施教,加强思想教育的指导,提高学生学习的积极性和主动性。

(五)教学评价

首先,教师自我评价,通过自己体验到的教学过程,总结自己教学的长处与不足,发扬长处,努力改进不足,及时和其他教师进行交流。

其次,学生评价,可以通过考试、竞赛等途径,对学习学生情况进行总结评价(注意德育),进而指导学生调整学习目标和方式。

结语:我将克服困难,不断学习,求真求实,为使英语教学成为历城双语实验学校特色多做贡献。

七年级英语教案 篇10

本学期,我担任的是七年级一班和二班的英语教学。本人遵守学校各项制度,勤勤恳恳,兢兢业业,使教学有计划、有组织、有步骤地开展。结合本校的实际条件和学生的实际情况,我获取了很多宝贵的经验,学到了实用的教学方法。现对本学期以来的教学教育工作做以下总结,希望不断发扬优点,克服缺点,总结经验,吸取教训,使自己的教学工作更上一层楼。

一、坚持既定的教学计划。

按照学生的学情与开学初制定了本学期的教学指导思想和教学计划,在实际操作中大体沿着既定的方针前进,局部根据实际情况变动。开学初就决定本学期在坚持七上的多朗读,尽量避免开口难的情况下,加入背诵,每个模块选取一小段来进行背诵,加强学生的语音语感,课堂行业平时多使用录音,提高学生的语音语调。其次,针对上学期的'不足多进行笔头落实。再次,七年级的单词关在本学期尽可能多的解决,加强学生的单词识记能力,针对单词识记能力较弱的部分学生进行帮扶,秉承着单词先行的原则,在课堂中也可以让学生学着自读自学单词,便于学生背诵单词和学会学习。最后,关注作文。在背诵和单词双重落实的情况下,再加入适当的翻译。一定量的机械的汉译中在英语学习初级阶段还是必要的。

二、 尽可能的认真备课。

作为一名教师,上号一堂课很难,备好一堂课更难。备课的过程中,积极专研教材,将手头的材料集中整合,考虑实际情况进行侧重,确定重难点。站在学生角度设计,让学生尽可能的有效学习,如将文中一些生活习惯用语设计成为课堂用语,注重文本的应用性。同时考虑不同设计环节课堂可能出现的情况进行优化。课后积极针对课堂效果再次优化,以备日后使用。针对一些单元备课不顺的地方,积极寻求学科组内帮助。

三、 认真组织课堂教学,保证学生课堂学习的效果。

上课时,本着“传道、授业、解惑”的原则,努力提高教学质量,使讲解有条理、清晰、准确、生动。使每堂课学生有所获,努力使学生打好基础,培养能力,发展智慧,培养学生的正确思维方式,养成良好的学习习惯。坚持学生的主体地位和教师的主导作用。在课堂上,用英语教学,让学生处于英语语言的感知和刺激下,同时特别注意调动学生的积极性,加强师生交流,鼓励为主,让学生敢于表达,乐于表达。同时根据不同学生设计不同层次的问题,让每个学生都能参与到课堂中来,都有开口说英语的机会,让各层次的学生都得到提高。

另外发挥早自习的作用,让学生大声朗读,增强语感,组织个人的朗读比赛和班级之间集体朗读比赛等。同时平时加大课本录音的听力从而让学生得以模仿语音语调。

四、 认真批改作业和试卷。

坚持布置适量的作业,使学生所学知识得以巩固和提高,布置作业时,尽可能的做到有针对性,层次性和多样化。同时要求鼓励学生背诵适当的好句和简短的段落。听写秉承着“少吃多餐”的原则。少量多次的进行以免学生疲劳。在模块结束后再整体默写一次检测和加深。同时积极发挥组长的作用来对小组成员督促和帮助。作业认真批改及时校对,考试前进行有系统的复习,考试后进行学科总结分析。听写和背诵都限时完成,杜绝拖拉。

五、 做好课后辅导工作。

班级总会有一些后进生。针对这部分学生首先应当从思想上鼓励他们不抛弃,不放弃。让他们树立起学习的信心,唤起学习的欲望。同时以尊重和引导代替谩骂和偏见,对他们多一些帮助。课后进行适当的辅导。从平时的课堂反应,课后交流,抓住他们的特点和个性,有的放矢地与其进行交流,及时给予关怀和关爱。善于发现学生的优点,并给予表扬。教师适当的放大他们的优点而缩小他们的缺点。引导他们自觉的投入到学习中去。

六、 积极参与听课、评课。

多听其他老师上课和外面的公开课。虚心向同行学习教学方法,博采众长,提高教学水平。阅读各种教育教学的书籍,通过各种渠道不断扩宽知识面,为教学内容注入新鲜血液。

在这一学期的教学过程中,我尽力地做好每项工作。在今后的教学工作中,我将虚心求教,总结经验,发扬优点,改进缺点,加强自身各个方面的修养,提高自己的教学质量,力争做一位合格的人民教师。

七年级英语教案 篇11

一提起任七年级英语课,听起来似乎很简单,很多人都认为七年级课程浅显,而且学生好管理,老师当然要简单一些。其实不然。七年级正是打基础的阶段,培养学生良好的听、说、读、写的潜力对以后初中英语学习很重要。因此,我觉得自我肩上的任务重大,教学上不敢有一丝的懈怠。现将我对七年级英语教学的一些认识总结如下:

关于书写

英文书写的端正与规范,是开学阶段务必要抓好的。从新生入学第一次在英语四线格上落笔写英文字母,就要向学生们提出要求:任何一位学生都务必书写端正,否则将会受到惩罚。吓唬之余,在最初阶段还不妨特意抓几位敢“顶风作案”的学生(如果有的话),以惩一儆百;同时对书写端正的任何一个学生都给予鼓励。之后我惊奇的发现,那些中文汉字写的歪歪扭扭的学生,英文却完全能够写的十分端正,俨然一个优秀生的卷面一般,感觉很有成就感。

在后期进行英文写作评分时,依然贯彻字迹端正者得高分,否则从重扣分的原则。经过一段时间的狠抓整治,同学们构成一个端正书写的良好氛围。

关于朗读

英语作为一门语言,让学生在基础学习阶段养成大声朗读,敢于开口是十分必要的。在日常教学中,我最害怕不开口的学生。我认为只要他(她)开口读、说英语了,那么他(她)这一生学习英语都将不会存在任何的障碍了。所以在开学最初的几个星期阶段,我时刻提醒我的学生们,必须要开口出声且大声的朗读英语。针对个别性格内向、羞于开口的学生,则要将其列为重点关注对象,致力于先张口,再出声,最后大声朗读。

一天之计在于晨,这句名言对于英语学习来说,更是如此。早自习上,我想尽办法让学生们去读,以不一样的形式,朗读不一样的资料,充分挖掘学生们读的潜能,让学生们都能开口说英语。

关于单词教学

很多时候我们不得不承认,学生的英语考试成绩是和学生的单词量完全成正比的。新目标英语这套教材的单词量大是众所周知的。为了让学生从识记单词拼写这个繁重的负担中解脱出来,我想我们就应在第一时间向全班学生讲述正确的识记单词拼写的方法,同时帮忙其摒弃他们在小学阶段可能业已构成的死记硬背的方法。在教学过程中,我坚决要求学生依据单词发音来识记单词的拼写。所以在单词教学方面,我一般遵循三步走的顺序。

1、跟读。让学生先学会读单词,做到看到单词,读音能够脱口而出。

2、记住汉语意思。能够由老师报中文解释,学生读出英文单词;在课堂句型操练中,进一步巩固单词的读音和中文意思的联合掌握和运用。

3、最后才要求学生开始识记单词的拼写。事实上,此时由于学生对很多单词的过目率十分的'高,他们可能已经在不知不觉中掌握了本单元里为数不少的新单词的拼写了。

此外,在新目标英语教材的starters和前几个单元部分,我想最好能坚持每一天渗透“直拼法”拼写规则,逐步引导学生养成利用单词读音来识记单词拼写的习惯。(虽然做到这一点十分难,一个班级大概只有30%的学生能快速理解并掌握这个方法,大部分学生可能会坚持沿袭死记硬背的方法。这甚至和学生小学阶段的汉语拼音基础有很大的联系)

在开学阶段,对单词识记的听写检查方面,我们最好是能因生而异,区别对待。我们既要让所有学生认识到单词拼写识记的重要性以及单词拼写但是关的严重后果,同时我们也要避免一小部分学生可能因为单词听写但是关,而产生对英语的畏学、厌学心理。

关于音标

不一样的英语老师对音标的出现时机看法不一样。我想只要适合班级学生特点和自我教学风格的,都是可行的。尽管如此,我个人认为在七年级下学期或八年级上学期再逐步渗透音标教学,可能更为合理。因为经过七年级上学期的英语学习之后,每个学生各自都会自觉不自觉的构成一套适合自我的英语学习方法与方式,随后我们增加音标的教学,以促进他们进一步自学英语的效果,能够说是水到渠成,一气呵成了。

并且一个班级中,肯定有部分学生的英语基础薄弱,他们对字母掌握都是似懂非懂,如果我们在七年级开学阶段立刻引入音标,我想无疑大大的加重了这一部分学生对英语学习的负担,这同样可能导致他们产生畏难心理,甚至放下英语学习。

此外,音标教学的目的无非是为了让学生能够利用音标自学单词,所以我比较同意利用渗透教学,在一段时期内逐渐地让学生认识大部分的音标,逐步的掌握利用音标拼读大部分单词;而不要急着在两、三节课里专门进行音标教学。相信学生在之后的英语学习中,会越来越熟练的运用音标自学单词的。

关于课堂活动模式

英语课堂上的同桌对话模式,我想就应一向被提倡。因此,在七在教学过程编排上,也尽量多的编排对话操练,以争取让学生有尽量多的机会展示,尤其是每个单元的SectionA(包括SectionB的前半部分)句型,更是有必要以两人或四人一组等模式充分操练。而此时,教材后面的听力材料则完全能够作为早自修朗读资料,其中个别超纲单词,不妨也加以解释,以作为扩展学生单词量的一个辅助手段。

关于课件制作

如今利用网络资源共享,我们能够获得丰富的教案设计、课件素材、课本录音、教材图片甚至完整的flash或video等教学资料。即使如此,我认为依然不就应全部照搬挪用,而就应利用所获得的教学资源进行二次整理与加工,使之更适合自我的教学风格与班级学生学习特点。

同时,针对自我的课堂模式及教学程序,我们还能够专门为自我制作一个课件模板,这将为我们日常烦琐的课件制作带来很大的便利。

关于后进生控制与转化

众所周知,英语学习的两极分化现象,是令我们英语老师最头痛的。我们甚至能够发现,即使在小学毕业生中,就已经存在必须程度上的两极分化了。为此,在七年级开学阶段,根据初步的观察、调查与测试,尽快掌握班级中英语学习后进生的状况,并且在教学过程中给予更多的关注与关心,持续地给予他们精神上的鼓励,用心帮忙他们重树学好英语的信心,在课堂设计上更多的向后进生倾斜,并努力取得学生家长的配合。总之,采取一切措施控制并缩小班级内英语学习后进生的数量,并非完全不可能的事情。

综上所述,七年级开学阶段只要我们英语老师用心去教,只要我们学生用心去学,相信我们就能圆满的完成初中三年的英语教学工作,为学生之后的更高层次的英语学习奠定扎实的基础。

七年级英语教案 篇12

一、教学目的

培养学生对英语的学习兴趣,形成有效的学习策略,有效提高学习效率,发展双基能力,培养听、说、读、写的能力,使学生初步获得运用英语的能力,达到语言运用能力的迁移和拓展。

二、教材分析

《Go forit》七年级下册共12个单元,加上复习单元2个,背景知识和学习策略等部分补充材料。全书采取任务型语言教学模式,融汇话题、交际功能和语言结构,形成了一套循序渐进的生活化的学习程序。每个单元都列出明确的语言目标,主要的功能项目与语法结构,需要掌握的基本词汇,并分为A、B两部分。A部分是基本的语言内容,B部分是知识的扩展和综合的语言运用。每个单元还有selfcheck部分,供学生自我检测本单元所学的语言知识之用。它采用“语言的输入——学生的'消化吸收——学生的语言输出”为主线编排的。通过确定language Goal,采用听、说、读、写,自我检测等手段,有效提高语言习得者的学习效率,有利于习得者的语言产出,体现了以学生为主体的思想。

三、学情分析

经过一学期的学习,从上期期末成绩来看,学生学习目的明确,态度端正,掌握了的一些基本,能够积极主动认真地学习,大部分学生学习成绩优秀,但还有极少部分学生没有明确的学习目的,缺少学习的热情和主动性,自觉性较差,相应的学习习惯也差。主要原因是没有激发学生的兴趣,学生觉得英语学习是一种负担,而不是一种乐趣。一部分学生没有掌握记忆单词的方法,连基本的单词听写也不过关,导致看不懂,听不懂,学不懂。学生的听力也还有待提高,在这方面失分也较多。主要是听的时间太少,接触英语的时间不多。针对种种问题,在本期的英语教学中,教师一方面应加强基础知识的讲解和基本技能的训练,让学生掌握词汇、语法、句型等基础知识和听、说、读、写等基本技能,为进一步学习英语打下坚实的基础;另一方面,又要采取多种,注意培养学生对英语的兴趣;让学生掌握记忆单词、听音、写作等英语学习技艺,培养良好的学习习惯和自主探索,合作探究能力。充分调动学生的学习积极性和主动性。教学上采取任务型教学,运用灵活多变的方法,实现学生语言运用能力的迁移和拓展。还要注意培养良好的师生关系,尊重理解学生,与学生一起分享学习中的苦与乐。使每一位学生都能在学习中取得很大成绩,有所进步。

四、教学措施和方法

措施:

1、培养学习兴趣,引导学生掌握正确的和策略,提高学习效率

2、发挥学生主体和教师主导作用

3、用良好的师生关系,协调课堂气氛,培养学生开口说英语的勇气和信心

4、引导学生实现语言的迁移,加强日常生活中的运用

5、鼓励学生自主探索,合用探究,共同提高

6、加强听力训练

方法:任务型教学:教师提出指令,学生规范操作。听说,读写跟上。综合训练,扎实双基。

五、教改打算

用新课标理念,结合新课标精神,进行课堂改革,实行教与学的互动。采用任务型语言教学模式,努力用一套行之有效的课堂教学模式,提高教学效率。

七年级英语教案经典15篇


老师会对课本中的主要教学内容整理到教案课件中,所以老师写教案可不能随便对待。教案是评估学生学习效果的有效依据,好的教案课件是怎么写成的?我们听了一场关于“七年级英语教案”的演讲让我们思考了很多,经过阅读本页你的认识会更加全面!

七年级英语教案 篇1

SectionA主要通过谈论话题“Thingsaroundthehouse”学习询问“物品的位置”,使学生学会基本句型“Where’smybackpack?It’sunderthechair.”,进一步体会“Wherequestions”疑问句的用法;学会运用方位介词“on/in/under”表达物品的位置。

采用Personalizing、Pairwork、Groupwork和Roleplaying的学习策略,利用多媒体教室教学环境来展开课堂Pairwork问答式的口语交际活动,使学生学会基本句型“Where’smybackpack?It’sunderthechair.”及方位介词

该部分学习内容贴近学生的生活,谈论的主题是学生最关心的问题,促使学生了解自己的生存环境,热爱自己的学校和家庭。

学习运用重点句型“Wherequestions”疑问句的用法;语法焦点在于学会运用方位介词“on/in/under”表达物品的位置。

通过使用方位介词“on/in/under”表达物品的位置及学习“Wherequestions”。

收集课文中所涉及的或学生常见的学习、生活用品、家具或有关的教学幻灯片或图片;制作la部分的'插图和人物对话的课件,将听力部分的内容插入,通过询问“物品的位置”,以及回答来引入新课。

搜集自己所了解的或曾经见过的学习、生活用品、家具的名称,及思考如何表示物体的方位。

SectionA主要内容是通过询问“物品的位置”,使学生学会“Where”疑问句的用法;学会运用方位介词表达物品的位置。所以在教学中可采取问答式导人法:

1.教师进行实物演示:Ihaveamobilephone。“Whereisit?”自己回答:“Itisinmypocket,以此方法教学一些学习、生活用品、家具名词及“on/in/under”。

2.让学生将单词与图相连,熟悉一些学习、生活用品、家具名词及“on/in/under”。

3.看教师演示:Ihaveapen。“Whereisit?Itison/in/under---”学一些学习、生活用品、家具名词及“on/in/under---“。

4.将单词与图相连,熟悉一些学习、生活用品、家具名词及“on/in/under”。

1.教室朗读1b部分的材料让学生听,引导学生写出所听到的单词的号码,完成lb部分的教学任务。

2.引导学生展开PairWork活动,完成lc部分口语交际的教学任务,学会运用“Where’smybackpack?It’sunderthechair.”,及方位介词“on/in/under”表达物品的位置。

引导学生展开PairWork活动,完成4部分口语交际练习的教学任务。要求一个学生看第4部分的图,另外一个学生看19页的图,找出两幅图的差别,操练“Whereis/are---?”句型。

今天有一位小学李老师来听课(她准备考初中英语教师资格证),遗憾的是今天我忘记把昨天制作的课件带来,很多听力材料只好自己读。由于我的学生全部来自农村,虽然他们也在小学学过英语,但是学得很粗糙,因此,我这节课仅内容完成p19(1a―1c)。通过自己朗读,让学生抓住本节课的关键,如本单元SectionAla通过操练句型“Where’smybackpack?It’sin/under/on….”,听关键词“in/on…”,同时,通过听关键词加深对“Where’s…?”句型的理解。这种技巧的运用有利于培养学生的注意力。教师通过对不同事物在何方位的提问,将学生注意力集中在不懂的方位上,教师在提问之后,自己回答问题并有意识的加重方位词“in,on,under”的读音,同时要求学生重复自己的回答。听关键词不仅仅是有利于培养学生的注意力,而且能培养学生的判断能力,勤于思考的习惯,在思考中遇到困难自我处理或向他人寻求帮助的习惯。

七年级英语教案 篇2

1.语言知识目标:

1) 能掌握以下单词: newspaper, use, soup, wash, movie, just

能掌握以下句型:

① -What are you doing? -I'm watching TV.

② -What's he doing? -He's using the computer.

③ -What are they doing? -They're listening to a CD.

④ -This is Jenny.-It's Laura here.

2) 能掌握语法:现在进行时态的用法。

3) 能运用所学的知识,描述人们正在干的事情。

2.情感态度价值观目标:

通过对本单元的学习活动,能培养培养学生学习英语的强烈兴趣,善于发现生活中正在发生的事情,积极思考,乐于助人,乐于参加各种活动的积极情感,培养学生团结合作的精神。

1.教学重点:

1) 词汇、词组搭配和现在进行时的用法。能用现在进行时的各种形式进行准确的描述和表达正在发生的动作。

2) 能掌握现在进行时态及一些表示具体动作的词组搭配,如: doing homework, using the computer, watching TV, eating dinner… 等

2.教学难点:

现在进行时中现在分词的结构及读音,能在交际中准确地运用现在进行时来描述或表达正在进行的动作。

Ⅰ.Warming-up and Lead in

1.Greet the Ss and check the homework.

2.Watch a video program.

Ⅱ.Presentation

some pictures on the big screen.Present the new words and expreions.

七年级英语教案 篇3

Unit 4 My Holiday  第一课时 一、教学内容:Let’s learn  Let’s play Let’s chant 二、教学目标与要求 1.能够听、说、读、写以下动词短语:learned Chinese, sang and danced, took pictures, climbed a mountain, ate good food. 2.能够询问别人在假期里所做的事情并做答。 三、教学重点 本课时的教学重点是掌握五个动词短语的过去式形式。 四、教学难点 本课时的教学难点是以下六个单词的拼读和拼写:took, learned, sang, danced, ate, climbed。教师要多示范,通过有针对性的反复操练知道学生熟练掌握。 五、课前准备 1、教师准备本课时所需的单词卡。 2、一架照相机、食物、一首歌曲,一张照片。 3、教师准备本单元的挂图。 六、教学过程 1.Warm-up 1.教师放五年级下册的歌谣“Let’s go on a field trip…” 学生边唱歌边跟教师作相应的动作。 2.教师放Let’s chant的录音,学生跟着录音说。  2.Preview 1.“猜一猜”游戏:教师呈现学生小时候的照片问:Who’s he/she? 引导学生回答。然后教师拿出自己小时候的照片让学生猜。学生猜出后,教师指着照片说:Yes, it’s me. I was … years old then. 教师依次拿出几张风景照,问:Guess. What place is it? 引导学生回答。 3 Let’s start 教师展示本部分的挂图问:Do you like holidays? What do you usually do on your holiday? Do you go on trip? What do you usually do during your trips? 引导学生根据提示图回答。 4.Presentation and Practise Let’s learn 1.教师问一名学生:What’s your hobby? 引导学生回答。教师指着自己说:I like taking pictures. I have many beautiful pictures. 然后拿出一张风景照说:Look at this picture. I took the picture last week. 教师板书took pictures和take pictures,请学生认真观察并说出两个短语的不同之处,然后指导学生拼写。 2.教师拿出一张自己爬山的照片,说:I went to Xinjiang/…last year. Guess. What did I do there? 请学生猜。如果有学生猜到climb a mountain,教师就向学生展示照片:Yes, that’s right. I climbed a mountain. 教师板书climbed a mountain,带读,引导学生对东词原形和过去式形式进行比较。教师继续问:Have you ever been to any famous mountains? Where have you been? 引导学生说:I climbed Hua/Yandang/…Mountain.教师可继续提问:When did you climb Yandang Mountain? I climbed Yandang Mountain in spring/April 8th. 3.教师再次展示爬山的照片,说:I climbed Huang Mountain. Then I was hungry. I went to a restaurant. Guess. What did I do there? 如果学生猜到吃东西,教师就拿出一张美食的照片说:Yes, I ate. I ate good food. 板书ate good food和eat good food,带领学生比较不同之处。教师带读,注意强调ate的发音。 4.教师依次出示爬山和美食的照片说:I climbed a mountain. I ate good food, too. What else did I do there? Guess. 5.教师放课前准备的歌曲录音,放完一遍后,问学生:Do you like it? Would you like to sing along? 教师和学生一起跟着录音哼唱歌曲。教师问学生:What did we do just now? 引导学生回答:We sang a song. 教师板书sang和sing,带领学生进行比较。教师带读单词。教师边做动作边说:People in Xinjiang like singing. They like dancing, too. 教师板书sang and danced,带读。 6.教师出示本部分的教学挂图,介绍说:Mike and John went to Xinjiang together. Mike likes taking pictures. He took many pictures. What else did he do? 手指Mike学中文的图说:He learned Chinese. 板书 learned Chinese,带读。教师再问学生:What did John do? 引导学生回答:He climbed a mountain. He ate good food. He sang and danced. 7.教师放A Let’s learn部分的录音,学生跟读。 8.教师带领学生说唱下面歌谣: What did you do on your holiday? What did you do on your holiday? I took, took pictures. What did you do on your holiday? I climbed, climbed a mountain. What did you do on your holiday? I learned, learned Chinese. What did you do on your holiday? I sang, sang and danced. 9.快速抢答:全班学生分成四大组。请一名学生上来抽取两张卡片并依次做相应的动作,四个组的学生根据表演者的动作猜:He ate good food/ … and climbed a mountain/… 哪个小组手先猜出正确答案就得一分,最后总分最高的小组获胜。 10.  学生两人一组,轮流抽取学生卡片编对话。 Let’s play 学生两人一组,每人在长纸条上写过去式时的句子,然后把句子在单词间空隙处剪开。学生交换剪下来的单词,看谁能最先把同伴的两个句子排列好。 Good to know 1. 教师介绍普通相机一些基本零部件的名称和简单的摄影常识。 2. 教师一边介绍摄影的基本步骤一边用相机给学生照一张照片。 nsolidation and Extension 1. Activity Book 2.学生课后进一步熟悉照相的基本步骤,教师鼓励有条件的学生拍下几张照片,下节课进行班级交流   Unit 4  My holiday   Learned Chinese sang and danced ate good food   Took pictures climbed a mountain   第二课时一、教学内容: A Let’s try  Let’s talk  Let’s play 二、教学目标与要求 1. 能够听、说、读、写句型:Where did you go on your holiday? I went to Xinjiang. 2. 能够听懂Let’s try部分的录音并完成练习。 3. 能够理解、说唱歌谣“Where did you go on your holiday?”。 4. 会使用英汉字典查新词。 三、教学重点 本课时的教学重点是句型:Where did you go on your holiday? I went to Xinjiang. 四、教学难点 本课时的教学难点是在实际情景中正确运用所学对话。 五、课前准备 1.教师准备本课时所需的词卡。 2.教师准备录音机和录音带。 3.调查表格;几张地名卡片,几张照片;英汉字典。 六、教学过程 1、Warm-up 1. 教师与学生的日常会话。 2. 复习上一课时新课呈现部分所学的歌谣。 2.Preview 1. 教师放A Let’s learn 部分的录音,学生跟读并拼读动词短语。 2.“打擂台”游戏 请五名学生到教室前面,教师任意抽取一张短语卡片,让五名学生根据卡片上的内容造句,如:I learned Chinese at school. 不能正确造句的`学生即被淘汰出局。然后教师出示另一张卡片,留在台上的学生继续比赛。能最后留在台上的学生成为擂主。 3.Presentation and Practise Let’s try 1. 学生听Let’s try部分的录音,完成练习。 2. 教师提问:What do people in Xinjiang like doing? 引导学生回答:They like singing and dancing.. Let’s talk 1. 教师出示一张新疆的风景照说:Look at this picture. This is a picture of Xinjiang. I went to Xinjiang two years ago. 教师再拿出一张公园的照片,说:This is a park. I went to the park last weekend. 教师板书:I went to…指导学生拼写单词went。 2.教师出示一张中国地图说:This is a map of China. I went to a city last year. It’s in Guangdong province. It’s a new city. Guess. Where did I go? 引导学生用句型Did you go to ,,,? 猜一猜,然后教师说:Yes, I went to… 3. 教师邀请一名学生到讲台前面来描述自己曾经去过的一个地方,教师问:Where did you go on your holiday? 引导这名学生回答。再请几名学生轮流上台,台下的学生其问:Where did you go on your holiday? 教师指导讲台上的学生回答。 4. 教师在请一名学生上台,随意抽取一张地名卡片举起来,不要让台上的学生看到卡片的内容。台下的学生一起问:Where did you go on your holiday? 台上的学生用I went to… 回答。猜对地名后,这名学生指定另外一名学生上台继续游戏。教师再拿出上一课时的单词卡片,在学生猜出地点名称后,任意抽取一张动词短语过去式的卡片,带领台下学生问:What did you do there? 请台上的学生回答。教师注意强调there的发音。 5. 听录音,跟读Let’s talk部分的内容。 6. 学生操练对话,教师引导学生根据本部分插图的提示进行替换练习。 7. 教师出示能拼成重点句型的单词卡片,要求学生在最快的时间内组合成句。 Let’s chant 1. 教师问:Where did you go on your holiday? Did you have a good time? 引导学生回答:I went to … Yes, I had a lot of fun. 2. 教师放歌谣录音,全班跟唱。 3. 学生男女生各一组,一组唱问句,一组唱答句,看那组唱得好。 Pronunciation 1.  教师出示英汉字典,问:What’s this? It’s a dictionary. Yes. It’s an English dictionary. Words in a dictionary are in alphabetical order. 教师用中文介绍查英汉字典的方法。 2. 教师指导学生完成练习,然后让学生在词典理查一查练习中的单词,看谁查得最快。 nsolidation and Extension 1. Activity Book 2. 学生课后询问同学或老师曾经去过的地方,完成调查表。 七、板书设计: Unit 4  My holiday Where did you go on your holiday? I went to Xingjiang.      第三课时 一、教学内容: A  Let’s read  Let’s talk sing Good to know 二、教学目标与要求: 1.  能够听懂、会读Let’s read中信的内容并独立完成信后的书写练习。 2.  能够完成Let’s find out部分的练习。 3.  能够听懂、会唱歌曲“A trip to China”。 三、教学重点 本课时的教学重点是能读懂Let’s read部分的一封信。 四、教学难点 本课时的教学难点是能正确认读下列句子:Every day I had fun with my cousins. On Monday we went to a restaurant. Tomorrow I’ll be back home.

七年级英语教案 篇4

【学习目标】

1、熟练掌握动词be的过去式的用法,并完成相应练习。

2、熟练运用本模块所学的单词、短语和固定搭配。

【教学重点】

be动词的一般过去时(am/ is ? was; are ? were)。

预习指导与检测

1、翻译下列词组或短语:

(1)在中国_________

(2)南非__________

(3)在七月十八日_________

(4)从……到……__ _________

(5)……地区__________

2、复习be动词一般过去时的形式: No, I ________. Yes, I ________. 课堂学习过程

1、检查预习部分的答案。

2、就课本Activity1的表格进行问答练习。

3、再根据表格内容调查自己小组内的一位组员。

4、完成课本Activity3的练习。

5、完成课本Activity4的练习。

6、根据Activity1的调查结果写一段话,用be动词的

过去时描述同学过去的生活。

He/ She was born……

当堂检测

Task1. 单项选择:

( ) 1. She was born _______ Tianjin.

A. at B. in C. on

( ) 2. ——______ were you born? ——On 2nd November, 1990.

A. What B. Where C. When

( ) 3. It takes us ten minutes by bike _______ my house

______ school.

A. to, to B. to, from C. from, to

( ) 4. I was born _______ a winter morning.

A. in B. at C. on

( ) 5. Who _______ your first friends?

A. was B. were C. are

( ) 6. I remember Mr. Wang was my ______ English teacher.

A. one B. first C. the first

( ) 7. This is a story book _____some colourful pictures in it.

A. have B. has C. with

Task2. 根据首字母或汉语意思提示写单词:

1. We can take a shower (沐浴) in a b_________.

2. There is a p_______ with some fish in it.

3. Nelson Mandela wasn’t he hero of South A_______.

4. John Adams was the p_________ of the USA.

1. Betty was b______ in Quincy, USA.

2. My maths teacher was very s_______ with me.

3. What was your p_______ life like?

4. Tony is f_________ to everyone, we like him very much.

6. We have a big g_________ (花园)with lots of flowers in it.

8. He was born in a small __________ (村子) in Shandong Province.

9. My house is small, but it’s very ______________ (舒适的).

10. There were two _________ __________ (影剧院) in the small town. Task3. 连词成句:

1. were , born , you , where

______________________________________________?

2. first , school , what , primary , your , what’s

______________________________________________?

3. born , small , was , village , a , I , in

______________________________________________.

4. wasn’t , in , born , Tony , China

______________________________________________.

5. President , Africa , of , he , South , was , the

______________________________________________.

七年级英语教案 篇5

知识目标:

词汇:in,library,ask,ask...for...,find,some,classroom,e-mail,at,call,lost,must

句型:Is this your...?Are they yours? Is this yours?

投影播放一段小视频《Mr. Dinosaur is lost》,然后投影一张Mr. Dinosaur的图片,然后师生对话

S2:No,they aren’t.They’re George’s.

...

利用投影仪2a中的要求(Write the things you lose easily.)。

请一组学生依次说出一种自己经常丢失的物品。

再用投影仪依次放出一些相关的实物,然后师生对话:

(1)利用投影仪将书中2b的内容展示出来。

(2)教师领读P17的新单词,并给学生一定的时间轻读公示栏中的启事。

(3)分4小组就公示栏中的启事竞赛式齐读,翻译,并评分。教师在就学生所读的情况进行评价,指导。

(4)让学生A说出所圈出的丢失物品。并在投影仪上核对答案。

(5)就启事中的重点词汇进行应用性指导。例如:Ask...for...的用法。

Some 的用法。Call 的用法。Lost与found的用法。

(6)就以上词汇做几道即时练习,分组评分。

让学生对2b的内容充分了解后,利用投影仪将书中2c的内容呈现出来, 在小组内完成2c,并核对答案。

(1)如果你丢了书包又会怎样做呢?

T:如果我们写寻物启事,我们必须写丢失物品的名字,特征,丢失者的名字,联系方式,甚至可以配上物品的图片。

利用投影仪呈现出要用到的基本句型,

I lost my ...

It’s...

I must find it.

My phone number ...

Call me at...

...

让学生B就以上情境写一份寻物启事。其他学生在自己的练习本上写。

全班一起修改完善,总结。

(2)如果你捡到一个书包,怎样寻找它的主人呢?

T:如果我们写招领启事。我们必须写捡到物品的名字,特征,捡到者的名字,联系方式,甚至可以配上物品的图片。

利用投影仪呈现出相关句型:

Is this your...?

Please call...

...

Unit 3 Is this your pencil?

I lost my... Is this your...?

I must find it. My phone number...

Call me at... Call me.

七年级英语教案 篇6

【学习目标】

1掌握本节课的3个单词和3个新句式。

2、初步学习基数词1—31的序数词及序数词的简写形式。

3、巩固句型: when is your/ his/ her/ bob’s birthday ?来询问他人的生日。

学会句型:how old is/are---? 询问别人年龄。

4、 通过学习,增强与人沟通的意识。了解家人的生日和年龄。

【学习重点、难点】:

1、 基数词1—31的序数词及序数词的简写形式

2、 句型: when is your/ his/ her/ bob’s birthday ?询问他人生日

how old is/are---? 询问别人年龄。happy birthday! see you !

【导学指导】:

一: 熟练掌握词汇:happy, happy birthday, old, how old---, party, see you !

二: 熟练掌握句型: when is your/ his/ her/ bob’s / your father’s birthday ?

how old is/are---? happy birthday! see you !

【知识点拨】

1、 序数词:表示顺序的数词称为序数词

2.序数词的简写形式:在相应的阿拉伯数字后加上原序数词的末尾两个字母

one-first-1st.twelve-twelfth-12th thirteen-thirteenth-13th

二。 how old is/are---? 询问别人年龄,答句:主语(人称代词)+ am/is/are +岁数 +

(years old ), 其同义句是:what’s + your/his/her/your father’s + age ?

如:how old is he ? – he is 13 (years old) 。 同义句what’s his age ?

【自主学习】:

学习任务一: 熟练掌握本课的6个单词。

1、个人自读,记忆本课单词。

2、小组互相检查单词读写情况。

学习任务二: 写出数字1----31的英文单词。

【合作探究】

(1)教师课前安排组长检查学生自主学习完成情况。

(2)教师检测学生对本节课的3个单词和3个短语的记忆情况。

(让学生利用课前3分钟加强记忆,然后选各组同学进行拼读,全班学生进行点评)

(3) 情景导课:教师引导学生复习数字1——30

(4)听录音,跟读2a表格中基数词,

(5)听录音, 完成2b、2c 内容。 师生核对答案。

(6)让学生利用2c中信息,两两分组进行练习2d对话,然后选派几组同学进行表演。

(7)学生阅读2e中对话,教师解读点拨。

探究:仔细阅读本课对话内容,学生分组讨论时间介词in, on, at的用法。

1、表示在什么日期用_______ 如:_________________ 2在哪个月份用_____ 如:________

3、在几点钟用_______ 如:_____________________4.在星期几用________如:________

5、在一天某个时间段用______如:_________________

【展示交流】

1、 让学生分男女角色进行练习2e中的对话。

2.让学生两两分组进行练习2e中的对话,然后各小组选派同学进行表演。

【达标训练】

(一)用介词in ,on ,at填空。

1、 my mother’s birthday is_______ july 21st

2、 my birthday is _____ sunday(周日) 。

3、 when is your birthday ? it’s ______ october 。

4、 we have breakfast _______ 7: 10 。

5、 i always have sports _______ the morning 。

(二)选择

( ) 1.--________ your birthday ? --it’s on may 7th.

a. when is b. when c. when are d. what is

( ) 2.his mother’s birthday is_______ july 1st.

a. in b.on c. at d. to

( ) 3. -today is my birthday -________________ 。

a.thank you b.ok c. happy birthday to you d. great

( ) 4. -happy birthday to you ! - ___________ 。

a. happy birthday b.me, too c. you’re welcome d. 。thank you ( )5. _______ your mother ? ----she’s 36 years old 。

a. what is b. how old c. how old is d. who is

( )6. january is the________ month in a year 。

a. one b. two c.first d. second

【拓展训练】

(三)翻译下列短语

1我父亲的生日___________________2.在六月份___________________ 3八月一日______ 4 在六点十分__________________5一个生日聚会______________ 6 再见____________

(四)、句型转换(10分)

(1)my mother’s birthday is on july 21st.(对划线部分提问)

_________ ________ _________ mother’s birthday ?

(2) how old is the boy ? (改为同义句)

_________ the boy ‘s ________ ?

(3) my grandfather is 60. (对划线部分提问)

________ _________ ________ your grandfather ?

【总结反思】

通过本节课的学习我最大的收获_________________________________________________

感到自己有待加强的是____________________________________________________________

七年级英语教案 篇7

一、教学目标:

1. 语言知识目标:

1) 能掌握以下单词: rain, windy, cloudy, sunny, snow, weather, cook, bad, park,

message, take a message, could, back, problem

能掌握以下句型:

① —How's the weather in Beijing?

—It's sunny.

② —Can I take a message for him?

—Yes. Could you just tell him to call me back?

—Sure, no problem.

2) 能用所学的知识描述天气情况。

3)描述正在发生的动作。

2. 情感态度价值观目标:

教育学生善于观察天气,善于调整自己的情绪;了解世界各地的天气情况,增加世界观念。知道大自然的力量是神奇而伟大的,我们应当好好学习,立志学好科学知识,为长大后探索神奇的大自然,打好基础。

二、教学重难点

1. 教学重点:

1) The vocabulary and useful expressions.

2) —How’s the weather?

—It's raining/ windy.

3) —What are you doing?

—I'm playing basketball.

2. 教学难点:

运用目标语言来对天气进行问答,并且会问答其他人正在进行的活动。

三、教学过程

Ⅰ. Warming-up and Lead in

1. Greet the Ss and check the homework.

2. Watch a video program about the weather.

Ⅱ. Presentation

1. (Show some pictures of the weather)

Let Ss look at the pictures and ask them how the weather is.

Ss learn the new words and expressions with the help of the pictures.

2. Look at the pictures in 1a. Then read the new words on the right. Ask the Ss to match the words with pictures.

3. Check the answers.

Ⅲ. Game (How's the weather?)

1. (Showing some pictures on the big screen.) Ask Ss "How's the weather?"

2. Ss guess and answer the question.

Ⅳ. Listening

1. Now let's look at the city names in the box in 1b. Please read after me.

Ss read the cities after the teacher.

2. Now, We’ll hear four conversations. Listen carefully, point out each city in the picture as it comes upon the tape. Play the recording a second time. Ask Ss to write the name of the city in the picture of its weather.

3. Check the answers.

Ⅴ. Pair work

1. Tell the Ss: If you are in one of the places in the picture above. Talk about the weather

with your friends in another city on the phone.

2. Make a model with a student like this:

T: Hi! How's the weather in Beijing?

S1: It's sunny.

3. Ss work in pairs. Ask and answer about the weather in the cities.

Ⅵ. Listening

1. Work on 2a.

Let's see what Joe's families are doing. Point to the 4 pictures.

2. Ask Ss tell each person is doing in each picture. More attentions should be paid

to the correct use of the Present Progressive Tense.

3. Play the recording for the Ss to listen and number the pictures [1-4].

4. Play the tape for Ss to check the answers.

5. With the whole picture, get some Ss to tell the story of it.

6. Brainstorming

Play the tape for another time. Then do a memory test.

Ask Ss: What's Uncle Joe/Jeff/Mary/Aunt Sarah doing?

What're Scott and Lucy doing?

Is Jeff watching TV? etc.

7. Let Ss match the names with the activities in 2b.

Play the recording for the Ss to check the answers.

Ⅶ. Pair work

1. Look at the pictures and talk about the people in 2a with a partner.

2. Ask a student the questions as a model:

T: What's Uncle Joe doing?

S1: He's playing basketball.

3. Ss work in pairs. Ask and answer about the pictures.

Ⅷ. Role-play

1. Ask Ss to read the conversation and answer the questions:

① What's Steve doing?

② What's Rick's brother doing?

Ss read the conversations and answer the questions. Then check the answers together.

2. Let Ss role-play the conversation in pairs.

IX. Language points.

X. Exercises

Homework:

一、总结有关天气的词汇。

二、编写三个有关天气问答的对话。

七年级英语教案 篇8

我要讲课的内容是人教版七年级上册英语教材第九单元第二课时。现我就本次授课内容从课标、教材、教法、学法、教学程序和板书等方面加以说明。

本单元的功能话题为谈论自己的兴趣爱好。本节课是本单元的第二课时,主要通过听力和阅读对话的活动形式让学生掌握单元话题。并且能够用英语进行问答操练,增加师生和同学之间的互相了解。英语课程标准明确指出,通过英语学习使学生形成初步的综合语言运用能力。而语用能力建立在语言技能、语言知识、情感态度、学习策略和文化意识等方面整体发展的基础上。英语课标对三级技能目标的要求为:能听懂学习活动中的指令和问题,并作出适当的反应。具体体现在课本2a和2b部分的听力活动中;能听懂有关熟悉话题的语段。主要体现在2d部分对话的初步感知中。课标中对说的要求为能在活动中用简短的英语进行交际;并能在教师的指导下进行简单的角色表演。此目标将主要运用到听力活动之后的两人对话操练中和课文学完之后的角色表演里。课标对读的要求是:能读懂简单的故事和短文并抓住大意。这主要体现在让学生进行自主阅读以获得对话的大意。同时让学生能就表格提示等信息进行简单的写句子练习。用以表达信息。在教授语言知识和提高语言技能的同时,引导学生学会抓疑问词和科目名称等关键词信息的学习策略。并培养其加强沟通、增加彼此了解、促进友谊的情感态度。最终了解中西方文化的差异,增强跨文化交际意识。在教学中渗透对文化意识的培养。

英语教材既是实现教学目标的重要材料和手段,也是对学生开展思想品德教育的重要媒介。教师应对教材有个清晰的了解。本课的内容为新目标人教版教材Unit 9 My favorite subject is science.Section A 2a-2d。本单元的主要功能话题是让学生能够就喜欢的事物进行简单的问答以及能够询问并陈述喜欢某事物的原因。学会使用句型What’s your favorite subject? My favorite subject is math.以及Why do you like…? Because it’s fun/interesting.

这是进入初中阶段以来第二次接触到此话题的教学单元。是在第六单元以like句型简单谈论喜好的基础上继续深层次的学会使用my favorite引导的表达爱好的句型,以及学会使用why和because等问答原因。既是对前面教学单元的拓展和延伸。又在整个初中阶段的功能话题中独立成章,起着无比重要的作用。同时在本单元里是对第一课时学习新知后的听说巩固训练,为Section B的阅读和写作打下基础。在本单元起着承上启下的作用。基于此,应对教材足够重视和合理使用。

根据教材内容和课标对听说课型教学的目标要求。特制定本节课的教学目标为:

知识与技能:

(1)听懂、会读、会用以下词汇:

why,because,Monday,Friday和Saturday.

(2)听懂、会读、会说以下句型:

―Why do you like ...? ―Because its ....

―Who is your music teacher?―My music teacher is ....

How’s your day?

play games with sb.

That’s for sure.

过程与方法:

通过课堂上师生对话、生生操练、听说并进、读写结合等活动,让学生掌握一定量的词汇、句型等语言知识。并能听懂有关谈论喜好方面的话题,且能运用所学词汇、句型与他人谈论喜爱的学科,提高英语口语表达能力。

情感态度与价值观:

通过互相谈论喜欢的学科,增进师生和同学之间的了解和友情;

学习策略:

让学生学会在听音和阅读过程中抓关键词以促理解的学习策略。

文化意识:

了解英语国家学生的学习生活,增强跨文化交际的意识。

教学重点:

根据本节课的教学内容和课型特点,特制定本课的教学重点为熟练掌握本课的目标词汇:

why,because,Monday,Friday和Saturday.

掌握目标句型:

―Why do you like ...?―Because its ....―Who is your PE teacher?―My PE teacher is ....以及How’s your day? Play games with sb. 和That’s for sure.

教学难点:

应该根据上课的实际情况,学生在课堂上遇到的问题即为教学的难点。初步预设为学生能就所学进行口头交流和笔头的输出。以及对重点句型How’s your day? Play games with sb. 和That’s for sure.的理解和使用。

根据课型和教学内容定教法。本节课是一节听说和阅读相结合的课型。应该体现听说课教学的特点。以培养孩子的听音能力和口语交际能力为主。同时体现以听促读、以读促写的教学原则。在处理听力和阅读部分的教学内容时,我主要采用任务型教学法。让学生在完成每一个教学任务的过程中掌握知识、培养技能。另外、对于新句型的呈现和掌握,我们主要采用师生问答、生生问答、男女生问答、以及个人和集体问答等不同形式的问答操练方法来巩固和检测学生对所学知识的掌握情况。对于较多知识和信息的呈现,可以采用多媒体辅助教学法,丰富教学资源的同时也能提高教学效率。

新课标提出的教学建议里有一条:加强学习策略指导,培养学生自主学习能力。根据本节课的教学内容和目标,引导学生掌握在听音和阅读的过程中抓取关键词的学习策略。这会帮助学生快速搜寻和捕捉到有效信息,为理解奠定基础。结合七年级孩子的年龄特点和性格特征,在他们理解了对话内容之后,采用角色扮演法上台表演。既能增加他们的学习兴趣,又是对学习情况的检测。此外、在听音、理解课文大意之后,让学生采用读写结合的方法进行有效输出。既为汇报环节做了铺排、又降低了直接说出的难度。还有两人对话法和小组汇报法等。均体现在练习环节之中。

让学生大声朗读教学目标,对本节课所要掌握的内容做到心中有数。

设计意图:紧紧围绕目标进行教学,避免课堂上进行一些不必要和大量无效的操练。

结合本节课的课型特点。出示自己班级的课程表让学生感知上课内容、复习有关词汇。并且引出本课出现的形容词和新句型。

设计意图:让学生感知到英语学习和实际生活息息相关。学习是为了实践和运用。复习旧知、引出新内容。既为听力活动做好准备,又为课堂上对话的操练,语言的输出展示着内容。让学生有话可说。

分为听前、听中和听后活动。听前活动已在上一环节中进行了处理。听后活动放在下一个环节的两人操练中。对2a和2b部分的听力进行多遍反复播放。每播放一遍都带有一个具体的任务。比如一听排顺序、二听跟读、三听连线、四听填空。让学生在不同任务的完成中得到听力技能的提高。充分体现任务型教学法在教学中的运用。

设计意图:语言技能是语言运用能力的重要组成部分,主要包括听说读写等方面的技能以及这些技能的综合运用。各个任务的设计体现了层层深入的渐进性原则。同时为后面的读和写打好基础。让学生在反复训练中提高。

结合听力内容,同桌之间互相谈论自己所喜欢的课程并说出原因。同时要求学生在他人交流时养成认真倾听的习惯。

设计意图:体现英语教学要求里的听说领先,读写跟上的原则。设计简单的两人操练活动,是对目标语言的一个口头检测。也是对听力内容的拓展。同时可以了解和掌握学情。

让学生先听后读,教师讲在必要之处。在一个个任务完成的过程中对课文内容进行层层深入的了解。同时强调重点、突破难点。

设计意图:体现自主学习理念。 指导学生养成抓关键词的学习策略。让学生在一个个任务引领之下真正掌握阅读策略,逐步提高阅读能力。

出示表格,进行知识和内容的拓展,从谈论喜欢的科目扩展到一切喜好。比如颜色,水果,老师,运动等。让学生尽可能写出完整的句子来。之后进行小组汇报交流。

设计意图:学以致用、拓展延伸。从教材知识的学习扩展到生活中的实践练习。将课堂引到生活里。

(1)识记并背诵所学单词:

why,because,fun,Monday,Friday和Saturday.

设计意图:打好基础知识,词汇是一切教学知识和技能培养的基础。

(2)完成《绩优学案》第九单元第二课时第题。

设计意图:主要从句子的变换来检测学生对本节课知识的掌握情况。

(3)用所学句型与同学编写对话,进行个人喜好的谈论。下节课表演。(对于学有余力的同学)

设计意图:让学生将学到的知识用于生活实际中,达到学以致用的目的。

主板上左边出示课题和课文中出现的新句型。右边张贴一张课程表,并利用思维导图的形式引出科目单词和形容词,以及目标句型。

设计意图:课堂板书,既是科学、又是艺术。在条理化呈现教学重难点的同时,应该追求形式上的新颖。使学生一目了然、加深印象。

以上是我就本节课的设计和说明。有何不足之处,还望各位老师给出建议和意见。

七年级英语教案 篇9

从II栏、III栏中找出与I栏中对应的'选项。

1.圣诞节HalloweenA.thefourthThursdayinNovember

2.感恩节ChristmasB.the15thofthefirstlunarmonth

5.中秋节AprilFool’sDayE.lunarAugust15th

6.复活节Mid-autumnDayF.September10th

8.教师节ThanksgivingDayH.SecondSundayinMay

9.愚人节LanternFestivalI.March,22nd-April25th

10.万圣节EasterJ.thenightofOct.31st

1.ManyChinesefamiliesburnpicturesofkitchenGod,ZaoShen,_______goodluck.

A.tobringB.bringC.forbringD.brings

2.Peopleenjoy_______holiday.

A.sevendayB.aseven-dayC.seven-dayD.sevendays

3.__________manyplacespeopleeatricedumplingstorememberQuYuan.

4.―HappyNewYear!

―_________.

A.ThesametoyouB.ThankyouC.You’rewelcomeD.Thankallright

5.Pleasegivemybest__________toyourparents.

uldyoutellme___________aboutyourfavoritefestival?

A.anythingB.somethingC.nothingD.everything

7.―When_________you_______tostudyinthisschool?

―Twoyearsago.

A.do;beginB.did;beginC.will;beginD.did;began

8.Thebabywasborn__________themorningofMarch3rd.

9.Theyenjoyedthemselvesattheparty.“Enjoyedthemselves”means_______.

10.Ithinkhewillsucceed(成功)____________.

A.inendB.attheendC.intheendD.bytheend

11.―What’syourfavoriteChinesetraditional(传统的)festival?

―It’s___________.

C.ThanksgivingDayD.SpringFestival

12.―It’stimeforsports!__________yoursportshoes,please.

―OK,I’mcoming.

A.PutonB.PutupC.TakeawayD.Takeoff

Goodmorning,everyone!It’s8:00p.m.Thepartyforthenewyearofbegins.MostofthepeopleinChinaarewaitingforthecomingyear.Theclockstrikestwelve.Allthepeopleareveryhappyandtheycheer.

Asweallknow,differentcitieshavedifferenttime.Forexample,it’smidnightinBeijing,but4p.m.inLondonandit’s1a.m.inTokyo,andit’s2a.m.inSydney.HongKonghasthesametimeasShanghai.

Thankyouforlistening!

根据短文内容,选择最佳答案。

1._________hasthesametimeasBeijing.

A.HongKongB.LondonC.TokyoD.NewYork

2.It’snooninLondon.It’s_________inBeijing.

A.9a.m.B.8p.m.C.9p.m.D.8a.m.

3.Thatdayisthelastdayofyear___________.

4.It’snooninBeijing.It’s_________inSydney.

A.1a.m.B.1p.m.C.2a.m.D.2p.m.

5.Theauthorisa_________.

A.erC.teacherD.doctor

B

ChildrenintheU.S.A.likeKDayverymuch.Kisforkites.March7istheday.Onthatdayalotofchildrengooutintotheopenair.Theytaketheirkiteswiththem.Somekitesareverybig.Othersaresmall.Theyareindifferentcolors.Everykitehasalongstring.

Togetthekitesup,thechildrenrun.Theyletoutstringsfromtheballsintheirhands.Nowallofthekite’sarehighupinthesky.Somearehigherthanothers.Theonelikeabirdisthehighest.Butwhat’swrong?It’sflyingaway!Thestringisbroken.Anotherkitegetsaway.Andmorekitesflyaway.Butthechildrenarerunningafterthem.Theywanttogetthemback.Peoplearewatchingthemandlaughing.

根据短文内容,判断正(T)误(F)。

1.OnMay1stalotofchildrengooutintotheopenair.

2.Kitesareindifferentcolors.

3.Twokitesarehigherthanothers,buttheygetaway.

4.Theonelikeabirdissmallerthanothers.

5.Thechildrenarerunningafterthekites.

C

ThanksgivingDayisaveryspecialdayforpeopleintheUnitedStates.TheycelebrateitonthelastThursdayinNovember.CanadiansalsocelebrateThanksgivingDay,buttheydoitonthesecondMondayofOctober.InBritain,thisfestivaliscalled“HarvestFestival”.Peoplecelebrateitearlierintheyear,inSeptember.Aharvestisthefruityoutakefromthetreesandthecropsyoutakefromtheground.InNorthAmericaandBritain,harvesttimeformostfruitandcropsisintheautumn.InthesecountriesandotherChristianplacespeoplegivethankstoGodonaspecialdayoftheyear.TheythankGodforthegoodthingsthathavehappenedduringtheyearandforthegoodharvesttheyhavehad.Peopleusuallytakesmallboxesoffruit,flowersandvegetablestotheirchurchestoshowtheirthanks.

Thefirstthanksgivingservice(仪式)inNorthAmericatookplaceonDecember4th,1619,when38EnglishpeoplearrivedinAmericatomaketheirhomeinthenewcountry.TheyheldthisservicenottothankGodfortheharvest,buttothankGodfortheirsafejourney.Thenextyear,muchmoreEnglishpeoplearrived.Theyhadabadwinter,butfortunatelytheharvestwasgood.Theydecidedtocelebrateitwithabigmeal.Theyshotandkilledsmallanimalstoeatandcookedeverythingoutsideonlargefires.About90Indiansalsocametothemeal.Everyoneateattablesoutsidetheirhousesandplayedgamestogether.Thefestivallastedthreedays.

AThanksgivingDaycelebrationwasheldeveryyearforalongtime,butnotalwaysonthesamedayoftheyear.Then,in1789,PresidentGeorgeWashingtonnamedNovember26thastheDayofThanksgiving.In1863,PresidentAbrahamLincolnchangedthedate,andsaidthatthelastThursdayinNovembershouldbetheThanksgivingDay.

Nowadays,NorthAmericansaroundtheworldgettogetherwiththeirfamiliesonthisdaytoeatgoodfoodandhaveahappytime.

根据短文内容,回答下列问题。

1.IstheThanksgivingDaycelebratedonthesamedayinNorthAmericacountries?

_________________________________________________________________________

2.WhendidthefirstthanksgivingservicetakeplaceinNorthAmerica?

_________________________________________________________________________

3.WhomadethelastThursdayinNovemberasThanksgivingDayintheUSA?

_________________________________________________________________________

4.Whatdoestheword“fortunately”meaninChinese?

_________________________________________________________________________

5.Translatethesentence“TheythankGodforthegoodthingsthathavehappenedduringtheyearandforthegoodharvesttheyhavehad”intoChinese.

_________________________________________________________________________

写一篇短文介绍中国的春节情况,比如在春节人们舞龙、舞狮、吃饺子、吃年夜饭、迎灶神、给小孩子压岁钱,互相拜年等等。词数不少于60个。

_________________________________________________________________________

_________________________________________________________________________

_________________________________________________________________________

七年级英语教案 篇10

摘要:分析七年级英语作业的现状及英语作业分层设计的依据。以人教版新目标《英语》七年级 (上) Unit 4 What’s the best movie theater?Section B Reading为例, 探究英语作业分层设计的方法。认为教师应根据学生的情况设计出适合各层次学生的作业, 从而帮助他们有效完成作业, 达到一定的学习效果。

关键词:七年级英语; 分层; 作业设计;

一、七年级英语作业的现状

进入七年级, 英语学科的知识量及课程难度有所增加, 很大一部分学生赶不上教学进度, 学无章法, 成绩两极分化日渐明显。平时的英语作业普遍形式单一, 以练习册习题为主, 学生的个性发展和创新能力难以得到提升;作业设计以教师意志为出发点, 忽视学生之间的差距和学习潜能等问题普遍存在。

二、英语作业分层设计的依据

英语作业分层设计是与本学科分层教学紧密相连的。分层教学是让学生根据自己现有的知识基础、学习能力和兴趣, 自主选择不同层次的学习内容进行学习的教学过程。分层的依据是学生的基础、学习能力和兴趣;本质是尊重学生的差异, 承认学生的差异, 使学生的个性、特长得到充分发挥。作业是教学过程中一个不可或缺的环节, 同样需要分层设计来保证分层教学的实施。

(一) 多元智能理论

美国哈佛大学霍华德·加德纳教授提出的多元智能理论强调:每个人身上都有不同的智能组合。所以, 教师要改进教学的形式和环节, 努力培养学生的多种智能。为了让所有的学生都能对作业感兴趣, 并能在作业中收获成功的喜悦, 教师应针对学生的智能特点、学习特征、学习习惯等设计出形式多样且丰富的英语作业, 使各个层次的学生都能完成, 并得到发展智能的机会。

(二) 因材施教原则

由于学生存在个体差异, 采用“一刀切”的作业布置方式不利于各层次学生的发展。实施作业分层必须遵循因材施教的原则。只有这样, 才能使不同层次的学生有效地完成相应程度的作业, 从而保证课堂教学的有效实施及教学目标的完成。

(三) 《课程标准》的要求

《义务教育英语课程标准 (2011年版) 》中提出:英语课程要面向全体学生, 注重素质教育, 突出学生主体, 尊重个体差异, 最终得以激发和培养学生学习英语的兴趣, 使学生树立自信心, 养成良好的学习习惯和形成有效的学习策略, 为他们的终身学习和发展打下良好的基础 (教育部2012) 。所以, 在作业中讲究分层设计, 优化作业内容, 最大限度地调动各个层次学生的学习积极性。

三、英语作业分层设计实践

(一) 学生分层

对学生分层, 学习成绩、学习能力和学习态度是最普遍的标准。

首先, 出于可行性考虑, 一般以学校组织的月考、期中考试及期末考试成绩的平均值为依据。但是, 这一标准的缺点在于单纯的数字无法真实、准确地反映出个别学生在英语学习中的学习态度、学习习惯和不足等。

其次, 使用学习能力和学习态度作为分层标准。这样, 就需要一段较长时期的课堂观察和课下谈话作为分层的参考, 但由于过程漫长, 且事物是变化发展的, 人的学习能力也在不断变化, 这样很难有一个准确的区分标准。

综上所述, 以学生的学习成绩为主要参考, 辅以学习能力和学习态度, 将现有学生分为两个层次:A层学生和B层学生。A层学生有较高的英语学习兴趣, 有一定的上进心, 语言基础知识一般, 理解能力良好, 能跟上教师的教学节奏, 但自主学习意识及思维能力有待加强与提升;B层学生的学科知识基础较弱, 学习习惯、学习毅力欠缺, 理解、运用、独立思维等方面均存在困难, 对英语学习基本不感兴趣, 信心不足。

(二) 作业分层

作业的分层设计能使作业有梯度, 让学生在完成作业的过程中进行思考和创造, 使他们在课后得到不同程度的提高。

对于A层学生来说, 在课堂上完成英语基础知识的学习后, 一定要进行相应的练习。首先, A层学生在课堂上大部分时间在认真听讲, 但也有注意力不集中的时候, 可能没有完全记住基础知识, 因此在为这部分学生设计作业时, 必须包含对基础知识的回顾类的题目和适量的提高类题目。

对于B层学生来说, 由于英语认知基础薄弱, 他们对英语学习带有明显的抵触情绪, 以及对英语认知存在偏差。为了让他们体会到学习英语的乐趣, 在作业设计中应以复习巩固基本的英语单词短语及核心句型为基础, 后续加上必要的基础题目。

(三) 分层作业案例

英语作为一门语言, 单纯依靠习题是不够也不行的。所以, 分层作业既要有书面作业, 又要有口语作业。

案例1:书面作业

“最高级”是七年级 (上) 英语中一个重要的语法知识点, 且有一定的难度。本分层作业案例以人教版新目标《英语》七年级 (上) 为参考。该英语书面作业设计的课时是Unit 4 What’s the best movie theater?Section B Reading, 是一份前置性作业。

首先, 对于B层学生来说, 可以通过作业强化基础知识的理解和基本技能的掌握, 所以这部分学生的书面作业应设计课内基础知识预习:

1. 单词闯关

贫穷的adj.______→rich adj.______

行动v.______→action n.______→ (男) 演员n.______

女孩n.______→朋友n.______→girlfriend n.______

幸运的adj.______→反义词adj.______

2. 短语翻译

动作片______try one’s best______

恐怖片______a pair of______

出版______dress up______

在20世纪30年代______

take one’s place______

准备好做某事______

do a good job______

3. 句型在线

We all know and love the black mouse______two large round ears.

Some people might ask________this cartoon animal______so popular.

Mickey became the first cartoon character____________a star on the Hollywood.

B层学生的书面预习作业要以复习性的预习作业为主, 可以是联系相关旧知识预习新单词, 如单词归类、功能句型等;还可以要求他们借助工具书、课外参考书的译文来理解课文。

除此类常规的预习作业外, B层富有创造力的学生还可以自由选择用思维导图 (mind map的形式对已经学过的形容词、副词最高级的相关内容进行深入探究, 然后将这类作业以海报形式张贴在教室墙面上供全班学生学习参考, 这样无疑既能增强学生的自信心, 又能尊重学生的`个性化, 促进其发展。

作为A层学生, 在做好上述基础性预习作业外, 必须对课文内容进行一定的延伸和拓展。如在家利用微课复习, 对形容词和副词最高级的含义、结构及用法进行归纳总结;回答课文导读中的一些问题;搜集米老鼠 (Mickey Mouse) 和迪士尼 (Walt Disney) 的课外知识, 就课文内容做一份思维导图。

维果茨基的“最近发展区”理论认为学生的发展有两种水平:一种是学生的现有水平, 指独立活动时所能达到的解决问题的水平;另一种是学生可能的发展水平, 也就是通过教学所获得的潜力。两者之间的差异就是最近发展区。上述三个预习作业在设计难度上有所提升, 但未超出学生的最近发展区。英语阅读课的信息量大, 网络给阅读 (Reading) 的预习提供了便利。这样既能降低学生的学习难度, 又能培养学生自主学习和处理知识信息的能力。

案例2:口语作业

单词、词组方面, 所有层次学生以小组为单位, 遵循组内互补原则, 利用音标自主学习单词、词组。具体操作可以是:A层学生必须对每个单元的单词做到“四会”, 并且能说出词性及用法;B层学生必须对教材中的单词全部朗读过关, 只对“四会”单词作背诵、默写要求。

句子文章方面, 同样以小组为单位, 所有学生必须跟磁带或音频朗读教材对话, 并带上相应的语音语调。B层学生在背诵方面只要求将课文重点句型背诵下来;而A层学生需要口头复述文章内容, 或是购买相关英文材料自行阅读, 拓展知识面。

在实际操作中, 口语作业一般由学生在家完成, 为了增加口语作业的趣味性和多样性, 可以让学生通过现有应用程序, 如QQ等, 将口语作业以语音的形式发送至教师邮箱。教师根据各个层次学生的水平, 针对性地给予评价, 如A层学生以注重语音语调为主, B层学生着重强调发音的准确性。这样的口语分层作业做到了因材施教, 针对性强, 能增强学生的自信心和积极性, 使学生在作业中主动探究与思考, 逐步提高其能力。

结束语

推行核心素养的背景下, 传统的作业布置已不能满足当前英语教育的需要。而作业分层设计能够消除学生的抵触情绪, 保证教学的有效性, 使各类学生在良好的学习氛围下找准定位, 立足现实, 稳步前进, 进而提升课堂教学效率, 达到培养核心素养的要求。

参考文献

教育部.2012.义务教育英语课程标准 (2011年版) [S].北京:人民教育出版社.

七年级英语教案 篇11

用来修饰动词、形容词、其他副词或全句,在句中作状语或表语。

eg. Now he is back in New York again.

现在他又回到了纽约。

Mike is a good student. He often does his homework carefully.

副词一般分为七大类:

①时间副词: now, often, then, early, ago, before

②地点副词: here, there, out, above, up, down

③方式副词: hard, well, badly, fast, slowly

④程度副词: very, much, still, almost, too, so

often 等表示“频率”的时间副词,总被放在句子中间,又称“中置副词”。这类副词有 always(总是)、 usually(通常)、sometimes(有时)、ever(曾经)、never(从不)等。

“中置”规律:

①放在单个的 be 动词之后;

②放在单个实义动词之前;

③谓语动词为多个词时,放在第一个助动词或情态动词之后。

如: You are always late for school. 你总是上学迟到。

I usually go to school by bike.

I never see that book.

He often helps other students.

He goes to work on foot sometimes.

七年级英语教案 篇12

七年级英语unit7课件

一、学情分析

1、初一年级学生好奇心强,求知欲望大,对身边生活的新鲜事物特别感兴趣。

从认识角度来看,他们的具体形象思维占据重要位置,具有较强的模仿能力,比起初二三学生来说,敢于表现自己,这种种特点都有利于本节英语教学的开展。

2、学生已经学习了颜色、数字1-9及名词单、复数的有关知识。

这对本节课的学习打下一定的基础。

表示服装的单词尽管对学生来说是陌生的,但由于它们特别贴近生活,学生也会有兴趣去记。

本单元关于询问价格和购物的话题来自日常生活,因此也不难理解,特别是通过猜物品价格、讨论如何购物、角色扮演等活动可以大大激发学生学习英语的兴趣。

二、教材分析

《How much are there pants?》选自义务教育课程标准实验教科书七年级第七单元。

新课程非常重视任务型的课堂教学特点,重视学生的知识与技能,强调学生在活动中完成任务,以达到利用英语进行听、说、读、写的能力。

本单元的中心话题的购物,主要语言功能项目的谈论服装、询问价格和表示感谢,语法结构是how much引导的问句及其回答,名词单、复数的使用和指示代词this,that, these,those的用法。

语言技能和语言知识几乎都是围绕着中心话题来展开的。

它贴近学生日常生活,是学生乐谈的话题。

学生通过学习有关服装的一系列词汇,并使用这些词汇询问价格,可以了解美圆与人民币的知识,培养跨文化交际的意识。

同时,通过购物这一教学过程,学生可以学会如何理财,养成不乱花钱的习惯。

三、本课教学目标

本单元通过学习使用How much引导的问句以及回答,让学生学会谈论物品的颜色和价格、对服装的喜好和购物时使用的礼貌用语等

1语言技能目标

⑴能准确表达服装的颜色、大小及长短等

⑵能对物品的价格进行问答等

⑶能使用礼貌用语进行购物等语言知识目标

⑴掌握有关服装、颜色和数字的词汇,⑵能正确使用目标语言对物品的价格进行问答等。情感态度目标

通过本单元的学习,能使学生了解中西方不同的购物表达方式,以及通过购物,学会使用礼貌用语,养成勤俭节约、合理支配金钱的好习惯。

四、教学的重点难点

教学重点:

1.掌握一些服装类、颜色形状大小的词汇以及有关数字的表达。

2.熟练运用数字.正确表示价格

3.在购物的情景中,熟练并正确使用句型:How much is…? It’s… How much are …? They are….教学难点:

1.指示代词this, that, these, those的适当使用。

2.How much引导的问句以及回答,以及句中主谓数的一致

五、教学过程

Step 1: Greetings.Step 2: Lead in.T: Do you like shopping ?

S: Yes, I/ we do.T: What do you want to buy ?

Show some pictures of different clothes to Ss.T: What’s this ? Do you know?

It’s a T-shirt/sweater/bag/skirt/hat.(Write the names of the clothes on the Bb.)

T: What are these?

They are socks/shorts/pants/shoes.(Write these new words on the Bb.)

Step 3: Read the words and then do the exercises.1.Match the words with the pictures in 1a.(Ask Ss to read the words and match the words with the pictures.Then check the answer.)

2.Listen and circle the things in the picture Ss hear in 1b.(Ss should circle the green shorts, the white sweater and the brown hat.)

Step 4resentation

Show a jacket

T: How much is the jacket?

Ss:(Help students to answer)It’s …dollar(s)/ a hat

Ask students to practice like a pair of shoes

T: How much are these shoes?

Ss:(Help students to answer)They are…dollar(s)/ a pair of socks

Ask students to practice like above.Step 5:Practice

Show some things and ask students to practice in groups like above.Step 6: Pairwork.Let Ss make their conversations to practice the pattern in pairs.Then ask several pairs of Ss to perform their conversations.Homework

Write a new conversation in your exercise books.

七年级英语教案 篇13

作为一名教学工作者,就有可能用到说课稿,编写说课稿助于积累教学经验,不断提高教学质量。我们该怎么去写说课稿呢?下面是小编为大家收集的七年级英语说课稿,欢迎阅读与收藏。

一、说教材

(一)教材概述

本课是人教版新目标英语七年级下册Unit8 Id like some noodles。第一课时。本单元的中心话题是学会如何在饭店订餐以及进行简单的广告或海报的简单写作,本课时要求掌握基本点餐需要的词汇及基本用语,如面条,饮料等的种类及碗的大小的表达。主要语言点要求掌握would like的用法,列出具体句型。通过本课的学习进一步培养学生的跨文化意识和语言综合运用能力。

(二)教学目标

1、知识与能力目标

(1)语言知识目标:通过学习是学生掌握并能熟练运用四会三会词语、句型,并对可数名词和不可数名词的进一步学习与区分。

Words:noodle beef cabbage potato special size bowl mutton.

Sentences:What kind of noodles would you like?/What size bowlof noodles would you like?

(2)语言技能目标:能运用所学词汇、句型点餐,能在真实情景中熟练运用。

2、过程与方法目标:培养学生自主学习的能力、语言综合运用能力、听力、英语会话能力、与他人合作的能力。

3、情感态度与价值观目标:通过创设真实的点餐情景,让学生身临其境感受和体验,使语言学以致用,做到“在用中学,在学中用”,激发学生的学习积极性。体会在活动中学习英语的乐趣。培养学生乐于与他人合作的精神及养成科学的饮食习惯。

4、文化意识目标:通过对中、西方在饮食及用餐方面异同的对比,对祖国饮食文化能有更深刻的了解。乐于了解异国文化,加强对文化差异的理解与认识。

5、学习策略目标:通过学习,使学生在一定程度上形成自主学习、探究学习、合作学习的习惯,有效培养学生的英语思维能力。

(三)教学重点与难点

重点:

1、学习日常生活中有关食物的名称。

2、进一步学习与区分可数名词与不可数名词。

3、含有would like的特殊疑问句及其回答。

难点:

1、would like的用法及其与like在用法上的区别。

2、模拟生活场景点菜、用餐,并在该情景中运用当堂所学词汇和句子进行操练。

二、说学生

七年级学生的特点:在知识基础方面缺少丰富的语言基础,对某些任务的完成有一定的难度;思维能力方面虽有较强的记忆力和模仿能力,但知识扩展运用的能力有待培养。有较强的求知欲和表现欲,但部分学生存在不自信、羞于表现等思想顾虑;鼓励他们勇于张嘴。此外,学生对有关食物的单词掌握不多,所以,本课预习作业为查找有关食物的单词。

三、说教法

1、《英语课程标准》强调课程从学生的学习兴趣,生活经验和认知水平出发,倡导体验、实践、参与、合作与交流的学习方式和任务型的教学途径,发展学生的综合语言运用能力,是语言学习的过程成为学生形成积极的情感态度,主动思维和大胆实践、提高跨文化意识和形成自主学习能力的过程。加德纳的多元智能理论强调教育的目的是真正理解并学以致用。

基于上述理论和英语课程标准对4级学生的'要求及学生的心理特点和认知发展规律,设置情景让学生帮教师解决问题入手,并激发学生的兴趣采用游戏、竞争上岗多种活动方式;在教学策略方面采用“任务型”教学法、情景教学法及TPR,让学生为完成任务获得必须的知识、能力、信息和文化理解,最后小组合作表演在饭店点餐,实现了任务目标,感受到了成功。

2、教学手段:运用多媒体辅助教学,将本课所需要的录音、图片、文字制成PPT课件,使抽象的语言变得直观,为学生运用英语进行交际创设情境,实现师生互动,生生互动和人机互动的多向交流。

四、说学法

《英语课程标准》把“培养学生学习英语的兴趣,树立自信心,培养良好学习习惯和形成有效策略,发展自主学习和合作精神”放在了首位。通过这次学习得到的精神,我从以下几个方面对学生进行学法指导:

1、学习方法的指导

培养学生观察力,想像力,记忆力以及思维能力。用生动可见的教具调动学生的感官进行听说读写的训练。

2、学习积极性的调动

设置真实情景——订餐,把课堂变成有声有色的舞台,为避免在小组表演过程中其他同学不参与到课堂中来,同时也让学生体验到其他行业也需要的英语技能,让学生从乐学、会学到创学。

3、学习能力的培养

通过连贯的听说读写,游戏,竞争等,培养学生的交际能力,发展他们的思维能力。

4、学习策略的指导

在课堂活动中把学生分成四人小组的学习小组,让他们围绕着课堂任务分工合作,在活动中相互探讨、相互交流、相互合作,从而获得知识、技能和情感体验,发展他们的能力。

五、说流程

1、总体设计及依据在任务型活动中热身。

通过询问学生平时爱吃的食物来引导学生之前学过的一些关于食物的单词,然后创设在餐厅的情景把学生带入到一个模拟真实场景的课堂教学模式中来,让学生切实体验英语真正学以致用的真实成就感。

2、教具准备:教学卡片、PPT幻灯片、录音机、粉笔、黑板磁铁。

3、分步设计及依据。

Step1:在任务活动中热身;

活动一:chant;

活动二:Guessing games;

活动三:利用挂图引导学生观察在英语国家人们的点餐习惯及基本流程;

活动四:学生俩俩合作,试着模仿课本上主人公点餐,找出不认识的单词及主要句型并加以勾画,并小组汇报员说出自己的问题,然后再带领全班同学共同解决;

Step2教师带领学生一起操练新学词汇及句型;

Step3通过三个活动进行任务型教学,让学生在完成任务的过程中再次熟练对新学语言点的练习,之后让小组汇报员汇报任务完成情况,教师以此来检测学生的掌握情况;

Step4Summary,以PPT幻灯片来展示本节课所学内容,把词汇和句型分别归纳、总结以便学生在脑子里形成一个完整的知识体系。

4、板书设计。

六、教学效果预测

七、教学反思

1、教学内容要形式多样,避免课堂的死板、生硬;

2、尽量合理组织教材,整合教材内容以便适合本班学生的实际学习情况;

3、课件制作要充满色彩,并且简洁明了,注意不要把学生的注意力吸引在观看幻灯片上而忽略了其真实的学习作用;

4、拓展学生文化视野,把中西饮食文化习惯放在一起对比,让学生了解英语国家饮食文化习惯并要求学生养成健康的饮食文化习惯;

5、充分发挥学生主动作用,让主动会话,增加学生语言运用能力的灵活性。

七年级英语教案 篇14

2、学会询问他人姓名及介绍他人姓名.

3、能听懂有关谈论他人姓名的对话并进行自由交际.

1.个人自渎,记忆本课单词.

2.小组互相检查单词读写情况.

3.根据汉语写出下列英语单词并展示.

学习任务二: 运用句型:What's his / her name?

His / Her name is .... 进行自由交际.

1.小组合作,理解并熟读下列短语,并写出汉语意思.

2.个人理解下列对话,并且两人合作练习.

A:Hello! What's your name?

B:Nice to meet you,too.

3.小组合作,练习自己的对话.

4. 对抗组开展竞赛,展示自己的对话.

1.个人看图,理解四幅图画,思考图画中人是在谈论他人还是对方.

2.听听力,给四幅图画编号.

3. 小组为单位,熟读2b中的名字。

4.听听力,完成2b.

二、合作共建(教师寄语:Many hands make light work. )

讨论下面两句话如何用英语表达.

1.他叫Bob.

2.她叫Jenny.

三、系统总结(教师寄语:No man can do two things at once.)

根据提示,完成下列问答.

What's _______ name? _______ is ....

1、 写出下列短语.

2、 根据句意及首字母补全单词。

(1)_________ is your name ?

(2)Nice to m________you.

(3)His a _________is good.

(4)L______! His clock is beautiful(漂亮的) .

1. _______, What's his name? His name is John Green.

2. She is a girl(女孩).What's ______ name?

五、【课后反思】(教师寄语:Never do things by halves)

第3课时 Unit 1 My name 's Gina (总第3课时)

2、正确辨别英文名字的姓和名,以及和中文名字的差异.

3、 学会询问他人名和姓的句型.

【学习过程】:

1、 个人自读,记忆本课单词.

2、小组相互检查 单词读和写的情况.

3,、据汉语写出单词,小组竞赛并展示.

学习任务二: 能运用句型:What's your first name ?

My first name is....

What's your last name?

My last name is...进行交际.

1、试读下列姓名,尝试总结归纳.

First name :________ Last name: ________

2、理解下列对话,两人合作练习.

A: Hello! What's your name?

B: My name is Jack Smith.

A: What's your first name ?

B: My first name is....

A: What's your last name?

3、小组合作,练习自己的对话.

二、合作共建(教师寄语:Many hands make light work. )

学会了询问他人的名和姓的句型后,能否用his/her做替换练习。

三、系统总结(教师寄语:No man can do two things at once.)

1、 总结你所知道的名和姓。

2、自己编写一个询问他人姓和名的小对话.

四、诊断评价 (一) 用所给词的适当形式填空.

1. Nice to meet ______(your).

2. _____(she) name is Helen Black.

3. His family name _____(be) Mr Green.

4. ______(be) you Mr Green.

5. Hi, I _____(be) Lily.

1. Brown 是他的姓氏. Brown is ______________name.

2. 她的名是什么? ____________________name?

3. 你好,我是杰克. Hi, ________Jack.

4. 我的钢笔是黑色的. _____pen is ______.

5. 他的名字是吉姆. _______________Jim.

(三)根据上下文完成对话.

A: I'm Gina,________________?

B: My name is Linda Brown.

A: Is Linda your last name?

B: No.Linda is my __________. And Brown is ___________.

B: ____________________.

五、【课后反思】(教师寄语:Never do things by halves)

七年级英语教案 篇15

课题Unit 5 Why do you like pandas? 第一课时 共四课时

教学目标:1.了解几种动物的英语表达方式

2.表达自己对动物的喜好与偏爱

3.学会使用why句型

教学重点:1.words:zoo,panda,lion,giraffe,smart,cute,beautiful,

2.Sentences: Why do you like pandas? Because they are cute.教学难点:形容词的用法以及why句型的运用。 教具准备:just the usual tools.教学过程: Step 1: Lead-in

First I will do some gesture to show some animals.The students try to gue what the animal is.After several ones I will write down some animals in Chinese on the paper and ask one of the students to do the gesture.

通过这个比较有趣的环节来引导即将接触的新词,让学生产生对这节课新内容的探索欲望。

Step 2: Words reading

Ask them to turn to the page of words and read the new words after me.At the same time we will learn some e_preion of the new words and make sure they will get the simple idea of the words we are going to learn.

鉴于学生的实际情况,单词的学习并不能直接交给学生自己。大部分学生的自学能力较差。所以在课前先带领学生消除发音障碍,增强他们在操练对话时的自信。也便于他们在新课内容当中熟悉生词的意思。 Step 3: Presentation

Since we already learn the new words for a while, this time I will give them three minutes to finish the e_ercises in 1a.After that, I will point to the picture and tell them which one is my favorite and why.

单词熟悉之后先以口述的方式让他们对即将接触到的句子有所熟悉。加入favorite的用法,便于他们理解句子意思。并对because句型有进一步的复习。 Step 4: Listening

Finish the listening e_ercise.Play the tape for twice to make sure they understand the meaning of the material.

英语学习当中听力训练时必不可少的,重复放两遍确保他们理解听力材料。 Step 5: Practice and pair work.

Write the new words and key sentences on the board.Panda---Why do you like pandas? Because they are cute. Cute pandas Giraffe---Why do you like giraffes? Because they are beautiful. Beautiful giraffes Then ask some students to practice the dialogues.

通过句子的讲述与操练,让学生懂得这个特殊疑问句所表达的意思以及它的用法。特殊疑问词为首,再加上一般疑问句,组成特殊疑问句。注意特殊疑问句的回答并不包含YES 和NO.要按照实际情况来回答。另外此处讲解,形容词的表语和定语地位。

Step 6: Sum up and Homework

Ask them to find more words which can describe the animals.课题Unit 5 Why do you like pandas?

一.说教材

七年级的对话编排几乎都是从学生的生活实际出发让学生能掌握生活中基本常识交流。发展他们自主学习的能力形成有效的学习策略。 二.说教学内容

本课主要是让学生学会谈论动物以及对动物的描述。难易度适中。

1.教学目标 知识目标-熟练掌握,panda,lion,giraffe,smart,cute,beautiful,和子

Why do you like pandas? Because they are cute.能力目标-运用所学的语言知识在创设情景中进行交际并在此

基础上能将其运用于日常生活中。

情感目标-激发学生的学习兴趣,帮助学生树立学习英语的自信

心,并在成功中体会英语学习的乐趣。

德育目标-通过本课学习培养学生合作学习互相帮助以及勇于

表现自己在大众面前的独立表现能力。

2教学重点 熟练掌握本课的生词及主要句型。

3.教学难点。 能区分并应用名词及相应的形容词。

三.说教法

传统教学方法 因为目前学校多媒体设施的运用还不够广泛,大部分课程仍然采取传统的方式教授。 四.说学法 自主学习 探究学习 合作学习

五.说教学过程

Step 1: Lead-in

First I will do some gesture to show some animals.The students try to gue what the animal is.After several ones I will write down some animals in Chinese on the paper and ask one of the students to do the gesture.

以猜动物的方式让学生参与到课堂当中,虽然最开始部分单词无法用英语表达,但是会加入猫,狗之类的动物来降低难度。通过这个富有有趣味性的环节来引导即将接触的新词,让学生产生对这节课新内容的探索欲望。 Step 2: Words reading

Ask them to turn to the page of words and read the new words after me.At the same time we will learn some e_preion of the new words and make sure they will get the simple idea of the words we are going to learn.

古老的方式不一定是呆板且死气沉沉,可以用分组比赛练发音的方式来使跟读单词这一枯燥的过程变的丰富起来。鉴于学生的实际情况,单词的学习并不能直接交给学生自己。大部分学生的自学能力较差。所以在课前先带领学生消除发音障碍,增强他们在操练对话时的自信。也便于他们在新课内容当中熟悉生词的意思。

Step 3: Presentation

Since we already learn the new words for a while, this time I will give them three minutes to finish the e_ercises in 1a.After that, I will point to the picture and tell them which one is my favorite and why.

老师的角色扮演和语句操练,加上神情的诠释,能让学生更好地理解所听到的句子的意思。比如,描述小动物的可爱和食肉动物的恐怖,以夸张的表情来表达自己不喜欢或者喜欢某种动物的原因。单词熟悉之后先以口述的方式让他们对即将接触到的句子有所熟悉。加入favorite的用法,便于他们理解句子意思。并对because句型有进一步的复习。 Step 4: Listening

Ask them to scan the e_ercise and predict what they will listen to.Then I will play the tape.The students listen to the tape and finish the listening e_ercise.Play the tape for twice to make sure they understand the meaning of the material.

为了改善哑巴英语的状况。口语和听力是我们必须重点抓的环节。在听力材料简单的情况下可简单要求学生在听懂意思的同时把句子用自己的话语复述出来,若是难度比较大则一遍一遍精听,确保他们理解内容并做到有所吸收。英语学习当中听力训练时必不可少的,重复放两遍确保他们理解听力材料。 Step 5: Practice and pair work.

Write the new words and key sentences on the board.Panda---Why do you like pandas? Because they are cute. Cute pandas Giraffe---Why do you like giraffes? Because they are beautiful. Beautiful giraffes Then ask some students to practice the dialogues.

老师带读对话的同时让学生纠正发音和语调。讲述完毕之后,首先让学生用书面的形式自己改写并编制新的对话,提问时注意学生的情绪,要鼓励他们勇敢开口,但不能强制逼迫害羞的学生,让他们每次进步一些。对于成就较优秀的同学也要注意在表扬的同时指正他的不足,避免其盲目骄傲。通过句子的讲述与操练,让学生懂得这个特殊疑问句所表达的意思以及它的用法。特殊疑问词为首,再加上一般疑问句,组成特殊疑问句。注意特殊疑问句的回答并不包含YES 和NO要按照实际情况来回答。另外此处讲解,形容词的表语和定语地位。 Step 6: Sum up and Homework

This cla we learnt some words about animals and how to e_pre the reason why we like them or not.But there are still many other words about animals.Please try your best to find more.Ask them to find more words which can describe the animals.

想要充分发挥学生自主学习的作用,老师就得利用好自己的指导作用,给学生指出可行的方向,提供稍微的辅助,让他们完成一些力所能及的学习任务,不但可以更好地充实所学内容,还能让他们培养独立学习的良好习惯。所以,适当的课外作业是必须要有的。

仁爱版七年级教案范文5篇


老师会对课本中的主要教学内容整理到教案课件中,所以老师写教案可不能随便对待。教案是评估学生学习效果的有效依据。我们听了一场关于“仁爱版七年级教案”的演讲让我们思考了很多,经过阅读本页你的认识会更加全面!

仁爱版七年级教案【篇1】

新版人教版七年级上册英语课件

定语从句:

(一)基础:引导词---who, which, that, whom,

练习1.I like cities___________are quiet and clean. 2.I prefer students _________are hard- working.

3.I hate TV shows _________ are noisy and boring.4.The music __________ is gentle and quiet attracts me a lot.

5.The food __________tastes delicious is not always healthy.

6.Those boys ___________ are playing basketballs over there are from Class Fifteen.

7.The books ____________ are written by Lu Xun are worth reading.

8.The town ___we visited last week is much larger than before.9.The book ___ he bought is very interesting.

(二)特例:只用that的情况

1先行词被___________或___________所修饰,或本身是______________________时,只能用 that,

2.被修饰的先行词为 ________________________________________________等不定代词时, 只能用 that.

3.先行词被 _____________________________________________等词修饰时,只能用 that,而不用 which。

4.先行词里同时含有______________________,如I can remember well the persons and some pictures that I saw in the room.

5. 以______________________引导的特殊疑问句,只能用that.如: Who is the girl that is crying?

练习1. I am interested in everything___ is about the World Cup.

2. Is there anything___I can do for you? 3. This is the very bike ______I lost

4.To my surprise, he gave me nothing __ I need. 5.This is the best dictionary __ I have ever used.

6. He was the first person _______passed the exam.

7.He talked happily about the men and books________interested him greatly.

(三)whose 1. The student ______father works in the factory is sitting there.

2. I like the rooms ______windows face south.3. This is the desk ______legs were broken.

4The woman ___ umbrella you took is angry about it.5.Here comes a girl ___ handwriting is the best .

6The banana __skin is green can’t be eaten.7That tall tree _ leaves are yellow is very old.

(四)从句谓语单复数由先行词确定,时态由从句时间状语决定,不必跟主句保持一致。

1-He is one of the boys who ____ (doesn’t, don’t) finish doing homework.

2-I like films which ____(be) exciting and interesting.

3-Children who often ____(eat) junk food are easy to become fat and unhealthy.

4-That boy who _____(run) fastest is from our class.

5Those boys who ____ playing the guitar are from our school. (be)

6The trees which _____ (be) watered yesterday belong to them. 7The man who ____ over there is our teacher.(stand) 8Those boys who ____ playing the guitar are from our school. (be)

9Mr. Brown is one of the foreign experts _______ _________ (work) in China.

10I’m one of the boys ______ ________(like) English best.

(五)“介词+关系代词”注意: 介词的选用要考虑:

A.与先行词的搭配关系

1)I will never forget the day __________ I joined the army.

2) I will never forget the days ______ I worked here.

3) I will never forget the year ____________ my son went to college.

B. 与谓语动词的搭配习惯

1)Have you found the book ________I paid 29 dollars?

2)Have you found the book ________I spent 29 dollars?

3) Have you found the book _____________we learnt a lot?

4) Have you found the book _______she often talks?

关系副词的用法

练习:1. It must be a good place ________________we can do a lot of exercise.

2.This is the village _________________we visited last week.

3.The house _______ we live in is very big./ The house _______ we live is very big

4. The woman ___________ talked to you just now is a doctor. The woman ______ you talked to is my sister.

The woman to ___________ you talked is my sister. 5. This is the hospital ____________ I was born in.

This is the hospital in _________I was born. This is the hospital____________ I was born.

综合练习一. 用适当的关系代词或关系副词填空

1. The boy ______ is wearing the black jacket is very clever.

2. This is the present ____he gave me for my birthday.3.The man _______ talked to you just now is an engineer.

4. He talked about the teachers and schools _______ he had visited.

5. There is nothing in the world ______can frighten him.6. We visited a factory _______makes toys for children.

7. Is this the place _______ your father once lived 8. I’ll never forget the days _______ I joined the League.

9The car______my father bought last month is beautiful.10The man______hair is white is his grandfather.

二 ( )1.Rosa likes music ___ is quiet and gentle. A. when B. that C. where D. who

( )2.--Is the girl _ is interviewing the manager of that company your friend--Yes, she is a journalist from CCTV.

A. whom B. which C. who D. whose

( )3 Yao Ming is a famous basketball star ___ is playing in the NBA. A. whose B. who C. what D. which

( )4. The doctor ___I am waiting for is Mr. Smith. A. which B. whom C. whose D. why

( )5. --- Do you know Hong Zhanhui? ---Yes. He’s the college student ____ has moved Chinese people a lot.

A. who B. which C. what D. whom

( )6. In my family, my sister is the only person __ loves chocolate. A. which B. who C. whom D. she

( )7. This is the place ____ the old man lived last year. A. when B. where C. that D.which

( ) 8. The song ___ Jay Zhou sings are popular with students. A. why B. whom C. what D. which

( )9. The farmer was very thankful to the doctor ___ treated his son. A. what B. which C. who D. whose

( )10.I like to live in a house__ is big and bright. A. that B. who C. how D. why

( )11. The young lady ___ we met yesterday is our new math teacher. A. what B. whose C. whom D. which

( )12. --Can you introduce the town to me? --OK. This is the town in __ I was born. A. that B. who C. which

( )13. Miss green is the only person __ can help you with your English. A. she B. whom C. which D. who

( )14. I like the second football match ___was held last week. A. which B. who C. that D. /

( )15. Is there anything ____ to you? A. that is belonged B. that belongs C. that belong D. which belongs

( )16. I hate people ___ don’t help others when they are in trouble. A. who B. which C. they

( )17. This is the only book ___I am looking for. A. that B. which C. who D. whom

( )18 Her sister__ you met at my home was a teacher of English. A. whom B. that is C. which D. who is

( )19 The book__is sold out at the moment. A.you need Bwhat you need C.which you need it D that you need it

( )20 I'm one of the boys ______never late for school. A. that is B. who are C. who am D. who is

( )21.__cleans the classroom can go home first. A. Anyone B. Those who C. However D. The one who

( )22. The old man __yesterday is a scientist.A.I spoke B. I spoke to C. whom I spoke D. that I spoke to him

中考定语从句真题演练

1.--- Is the girl __ is interviewing the manager of that company your friend? --Yes, she is a journalist from CCTV. A. whom B. which C. who D. whose

2. Do you still remember the movie _____ we saw last weekend? A. who B. what C. that D. whom

3. ---Who is your new English teacher? ---Elena, the woman ____ is wearing a red T-shirt over there.

A. 不填 B. whom C. whose D. who

4. Is that the man _____ helped us a lot after the earthquake? A. whose B. which C. when D. who

5. ---What are you looking for? --- I’m looking for the pen ___ I bought yesterday. A. who B. which C. whose

6. This is the novel_____ written by Guo Jingming. A. who B. what C. that D. /

7. We should be ready to help the people ____ are in trouble. A. whose B. whom C. which D. who

8. Two years has passed, but Chinese people still remember those exciting days ____ they spent during the Beijing Olympic Games. A. that B. who C. when

9. The magician _____ played magic tricks in 2008 CCTV Spring Festival Gala is Liu Qian. He is popular in China now. A. whose B. who C. which

10. July likes music very much. She likes music ____ she can dance to. A. what B. who C. that

11. At school, you should do the things _____ are allowed by the teachers. A. that B. when C. what

12. Thought is the key _____ opens the doors of the world. A. why B. where C. which D. who

13. The gentlemen ___ are coming to my office tomorrow are my classmates many years ago.

A. whom B. who C. those D. which

14. That’s the man _____ house was destroyed in the storm. A. that B. whose C. who D. which

15. The girl ____ I just talked with is Ben’s sister. A. whom B. which C. she

16. I love people ____ are friendly to others. A. which B. whose C. what D. who

17. It’s time to say goodbye to my school. I’ll always remember the people _____ have helped me.

A. who B. what C. which D. where

18. I like the teacher ____ classes are very interesting and creative. A. which B. who C. what D. whose

19. Do you know the boy ____ is sitting next to Peter? ---Yes. He is Peter’s friend. They are celebrating his ____ birthday. A. who, ninth B. that, nineth C. /, nineth D. which, ninth

20.ShaolinTemple__lies in the west of Zhengzhou welcomes the visitors from abroad.A.where B.which C.who

二宾语从句

1宾语从句的学习要注意三个方面

第一:语序:在宾语从句中,一律用___________。

如Where does she live? ( Do you know?) ----Do you know where she lives?

***几个特殊的特殊疑问句

Which is the way to the nearest shop?/ What’s wrong with you?/ What’s up?/ What’s the matter?

这几个特殊疑问句本身就是陈述语序,在宾语从句中不需调整语序。

第二:时态; 1)如果主句是___________,宾语从句时态根据实际情况而定.

如:1. It’s going to rain. I think. ---I think it’s going to rain.

2. “I will go with you .” he says. ---He says he will go with me.

3. He studied English ten years ago. I know. I know he studied English ten years ago.

2)主句是___________,宾语从句要用___________。

如:It’s going to rain. I thought. ---I thought it was going to rain.

“I will go with you.” he said. ---He said he would go with me.

3). 若从句表达的是___________,规律,不管主句是什么时态,从句都用___________。

如1 The earth turns round the sun. The teacher told us---The teacher told us that the earth turns round the sun.

2 Light travels much faster than sound. She said … ---She said that light travels much faster than sound.

第三:连接词1)如果被连接的句子是___________,那么连接词用___________, (也可省)

如1. He’ll be back in a month. ( I hear…) I hear ( that ) he will be back in a month.

2. I have been to the Great Wall once. ( He tells me…) He tells me ( that ) he has been to the Great Wall once.

2.)如果被连接的句子是___________,则用连接词___________

如:*Does he live in that house? ( She asked me …) She asked me if/ whether he lived in that house.

*Have you finished your homework? ( I want to know…) I want to know if you have finished your homework.

3) ___________句,用原句中的特殊疑问词引导:what, who, where, when, which, why, how (many/ much/ often/ long/ old).如: Who are you waiting for? Can you tell me? --- Can you tell me who you are waiting for?

What did he do yesterday? I don’t know. ---I don’t know what he did yesterday.

***其中 以wh- 疑问词或how 引导的宾语从句与动词不定式可相互转换

如I don’t know what I can do.可以说成 I don’t know what to do.

The policeman showed me where I could get books. 可以说成The policeman showed me where to get books.

Can you tell me how I can make a kite?可以说成 Can you tell me how to make a kite?

4).宾语从句___________。在_________________________________等动词所跟的`宾语中,如果从句谓语是否定的,一般要将否定词not转移至主句谓语上去,而将从句谓语改为肯定形式。如:I don’t think he has time to play with the girl.

二.综合练习

1.I want to know __

A. whom is she looking after B. whom she is looking C.whom is she looking D.whom she is looking after

2.I don't know _________ the day after tomorrow.

A.when does he come B.how will he come C.if he comes D.whether he'll come

3.Could you tell me _________ the nearest hospital is?A.what B.how C.whether D.where

4.Could you tell me _________ the radio without any help?

A.how did he mend B.what did he mend C.how he mended D.what he mended

5.I don't know if he____ tomorrow. If he _____,I'll tell you.

A.comes, comes B.will come, will come C. will come, comes D. comes, will come

6.Do you know where _________ now?A.he lives B.does he live C.he lived D.did he live

7.Do you know what time ___?A.the train leave B.does the train leave C.will the train leave Dthe train leaves

8.I don't know _________ .Can you tell me,please? A.how the two players are old

B.how old are the two players C.the two players are how old D.how old the two players are

9.The small children don't know _________ . A.what is their stockings in

B.what is in their stockings C.where is their stockings in D.what in their stockings

10.I can't understand _________ . A.what does Christmas mean B.what Christmas does mean

C.what mean Christmas does D.what Christmas means

11 . When the job______, let me know. A .do B .done C .is done D .finished

12 .She asked me if I knew__ .A .whose pen is it B .whose pen it was C whose pen it is D .whose pen was it 13 .Miss Li wants to know _____________next week . A .when my uncle leaves

B .when will my uncle leave C .where my uncle will stay D .where does my uncle stay

14 .Could you tell me ________________with the money ? A .how to do B .what should I do C .how I should do D .what I should do

中考宾语从句真题演练

( )1. Everyone can play an important role in the society.As members,we should try our best to do__.

A. what we should do B. what should we do C. how we should do

( )2. --I really hope to keep in touch with Lily. --Sorry. I don't know __.

A. what her name is B. what her job is C. what her number is D. when she left

( )3 —Can you tell me ______? —By doing more speaking. A how I will improve my English

B. which way can I choose C. how do I deal with my English D. what’s wrong with my English

( )4. How lovely the dog is ! Can you tell me _____?

A. where did you get it B. where will you get it C. where you got it

( )5.. --Excuse me, could you tell me ____ the book about aliens? --Sure, take the escalator to the second floor.

A. where I can buy B. where can I buy C. when can I buy D. when I can buy

( )6-“Do you know_ have our summer holiday?”-“Next week.”A.when will we B.when are weC. when we will

( )7 ---Do you know ____ the MP4 yesterday? -- Sorry, I’ve no idea about it.

A. how much did he pay for B. how much he paid for C. he paid for how much D. he paid how much for

( )8--What time will Mr. Brown be back to China? -- Sorry. I don’t know ___.

A. when did he go abroad B.why he is going abroad C.how soon will he be back Dhow long he will stay abroad

( )9. You can’t image ___ when the pupils received these nice presents on Children’s Day.

A. how they were excited B. how excited they were C. how excited were they D. they were how excited

( )10. –Can you tell me ______?–She is in the computer lab.

A. where Linda was B. where is Linda C. where was Linda D. where Linda

( )11. –Do you know _______ the Capital Museum? –Next Friday.

A. when will they visit B. when they will visit C. when did they visit D. when they visited

( )12. He wanted to know____the English party.

A. when will we have B. when we will have C. when would we have D. when we would have

( )13. I want to know_______.

A. when we should arrive at the airport B. when should we arrive at the airport

C. when the airport we should arrive at D. when the airport should we arrive at

( )14. –David, look at the man in white over there. Can you tell me_______? –He is a doctor.

A. who is he B. who he is C. what is he D. what he is

( )15. –Do you know___the girl in red is? –I’m not sure. Maybe a teacher. A. when B. how C. where D. what

( )16. Your T-shirt is so cool. Could you tell me ________?

A. where you buy it B. where do you buy it C. where you bought it D. where did you buy it is

( )17. I really want to know ____ . A. what is wrong with my brother

B. how will he go to Beijing tomorrow C. if had he bought that car D. where did he go yesterday

( )18. Excuse me, sir. Could you tell me ?

A.where is the bank nearestB. where is the nearest bankC.where the nearest bank isD. the nearest bank is where

( )19.Lily’s mother looked for her for half an hour, but couldn’t find ____.

A. What Lily was. B. What was Lily C. Where Lily was D. Where was Lily

( )20--Could you tell me___? He is wanted by the head teacher.--Sorry, I’ve no idea.But he _ here just now.

A. where Tim was, was B. where is Tim,was C. where Tim is,was D.where Tim is,is

三、状语从句:

一).条件状语从句:引导词为:if, unless。

形式:

主句_______________, 从句______________.

练习:1.I am waiting for my friend.____________, I’ll do shopping alone.

A.If she comes B.If she will come C.If she doesn’t come D.If she didn’t come

2.I am sure I can make it better, if our teacher _________me a second chance.A.give B.gave C.gives D.will give

3.The art club is for members only. You can’t go in___you are a member. A.unless B.Because C.if D.though

4.I ________the CDs to you if I have time tomorrow. A.will return B.returned C.have returned D.return

5. 1)You won’t pass the final exam ___________(除非)you work hard.

2) The children __________ climb the mountain if it __________________(不下雨)

3) _______________________if he comes. (给我打电话)

二)时间状语从句:(常见从属连词有when,before, after, until, as soon as, while…)

1)As soon as he _____in Paris, he will call you. A.arrive B.arrived C.arrives

2)Don’t leave until the rain_______.A.stopped B.stops C.stopping D.stop

3)You can go skating after you ____A.finish the job B.finished the job C.finishing the job

4) I’ll tell her the good news when he _____ back. A.came es e

5)Father was watching TV ________ Mum was washing dishes. A.before B. while C.after D.until

6)I was watching TV ____ you called me last night. A.when B.while C.until D.after

7) I ______ here since I came to China. d B.have lived C.am living D. had living

8).My grandma didn’t go to sleep______ I got back home. A.till B.until C.since D.when

三)原因状语从句: (常用连词有because, since, as)

1. Tom is ill at home, _____he can’t come here. A.so B.if C.because D.and

2.—Why did you come to school late this morning?--___I watched the Football World Cup until 12:00 last night. A.If B.Because C.Since D.Though

3.I hope to go to France some day__there are many museums there.A.though B. unless C. because D. where

四)结果状语从句:由so… that…/such…that/so that引导的从句(so后接形、副原级)

1)与too…to…句型的转换:

He ran so fast that I couldn’t catch up with him. =______________________________________________

The box is so heavy that I can’t carry it= ___________________________________________________

2)“so… that +从句”与“enough to”的替换

He’s so strong that he can carry the box.=___________________________________________________

He is not old enough to go to school.=________________________________________________________

3)so that…/ so…that…/such…that ____________________________________________________________

如:He got up early in the morning so that he could catch the early bus.

The boy is so strong that he can lift up the heavy stone. He is such a clever boy that all of us like him.

练习:1.--He was _______tired ______he fell asleep as soon as he lay down. -- Oh, we can go out and let him have a good rest..A.too;to B.so; that C.enough; to D.such; that

2.There were _______many people ____I couldn’t find where she is. A.so;that B.so;as C.such;that D.as;that

3. He ran as fast as possible__he could reach school on time. A.in order to B so as to C such that D so that

4. They are ___interesting books __ I want to read them once more.A.so that B.such…that C.too…to D.so…that

综合练习

1.You may leave the classroom when you__writing.A.will finish Bare finishing C have finished Dhad finished

2. Would you give Johnny this letter if you ________ to see him this week.

A. will happen B. happen C. are happened D. happened

3. She was busy, ____she couldn’t go to your birthday party last night. A. and B. so C. or D. but

4. English is ________ a useful language ________ it is spoken in many countries of the world.

A. so…that B. such…that C. so…because D. such…because

5. Don’t cross the street __ the traffic lights are green. A. after B. until C. while D. since

6. Your dream won’t come true__ you know what your dream is. A. after B. unless C. while D. since

7. --Could you ask him if he __to my birthday party next Sunday? –I will, if I __ him this afternoon.

A. comes, meet B. will come, will meet C. comes, will meet D. will come, meet

8. Sarah is ______ a hard-working girl ______ she often works late into night.

A. so; that B. too; to C. such; that D. not only; but also

状语从句真题练习

1.—Where was your brother at this time last night?—He was writing an e-mail ___I was watching TV at home.

A.as soon as B.after C.until D.while

2.The film “Kung Fu Panda” is___interesting__I would like to see it again. A.such,that B.too,to C.as,as D.so that

3.Tom will call me as soon as he ___home. A.gets B.has got C.got D.will get

4. We will have no water to drink___we don’t protect the earth. A.until B.before C.though D.if

5.We won’t start the meeting ___our teacher arrives. A.though B.until C.while D.or

6.Bob promises to join in the football match____he has to help his parents on the farm..

A. if B.as C. unless D. when

7.___it’s difficult to make her dream come ture, she never gives up. A.Though B.Unless C.Because D.If

8.---Could you tell me when Mr. Li___in Huanggang?---Sure. When he ___, I’ll call you.

A.arrives; will arrive B.will arrive; arrives C.arrives; arrives D.will arrive; will arrive

9.In summer, food goes bad easily__it is put in the refrigerator. A.until B.if C.unless

10.A moment, please. I’m checking if Mr. Smith__free tomorrow. A.is B.being C.to be D.will be

11.I didn’t go to bed __my mother came back late last night.A.so; B.until C.though

12.Hurry up,___you will miss the early train. A. or B.and C.if D.unless

13.---Tommy, do you know if Frank___to the theatre with us this Sunday if it ___?---Sorry, I have no idea.

A.will go, is fine; B.goes, is fine C.will go, is going to be fine D.goes; will be fine

14.What a beautiful painting it is! I’ve never seen ___painting. A.such a B.a C.such D.this better

15.I don’t know __he will come tomorrow.___he comes, I’ll tell you.

A.if, Whether B.whether, Whether C.if, That D.if, If

复合句综合检测

( )1.Is this museum_ they visited last month? A. that B. where C. which D. the one

( )2. Is that book ____ he borrowed on Friday? A. that B. which C. who D. the one

( )3 The second book__I want to read is Business at the Speed of Thought. A. which B. what C. that D. as

( )4 –Do you know the man __is running along the street? A who B which C whom

( )5. Without friendship, one can’t be happy although he is rich enough. As for me, I will never forget the days ___I spent with my dearest friend. A that B when C who

( )6 This is the best TV play __we have seen this year. A when B what C who D that

( )7--Have you found the information about famous people ____you can use for report?

--Not yet. I’ll search some on the Internet. A which B who C what D whom

( )8--Have you been to the Sports Center___ is just opened in town? - -No, no yet.

A where B who C that D when

( )9 --Bob, where do you work?--I work for a company ___sells cars. A which B where C what

( )10____ have finished the work can leave. A. Those who B. Anyone C. The one who

( )11. The building that ___new is our school. A. is B. are C. was D. were

( )12. The pandas that we saved ____better now. A. are B. were C. is D. was

( )13 This is the only thing _________ I have lost.A.which B.that C.where

( )14.--Could you tell me____?--Sorry, I don’t know. I was not at the meeting. A. what does he say at the meeting. B what did he say at the meeting. C. what he says at the meeting D. what he said at the meeting

( )15. No one can be sure____ in a million years.

A. what man looks like B. what will man look like C. man will look like what D. what man will look like

( )16. -- Could you tell me ____?-- She is a student in Eton School.

A. where Kate is studying B. how Kate studies C .why Kate was studying D. when Kate studied

( )17.-- Could you tell me___ yesterday?-- About two hours. A. How long it takes to fly to Guilin B. How long it took to fly to Guilin C.How long does it take to fly to Guiln D. How long did it take to fly to Guilin

( )18. Please tell me____.A. what is wrong with the boy B. what is the boy wrong C. what wrong the boy is

( )19. She will hate him when she _more about him .A.knowsB .know C.will know Dis going to know

( )20. --Excuse me. Do you know_____?--Sorry, I don’t know. A. where is No. 1 Middle School

B. where No. 1 Middle School is C. No. 1 Middle School is where D. No. 1 Middle School where is

( )21. At the science museum,the boys and girls get to know__________. A. what is the spaceship like

B. what the spaceship looks like C. how the spaceship looks 1ike D. how does the spaceship1ook like

( )22. He didn’t tell me ____.

A. which floor did he live on B. which floor he lived on C. which floor he lived D. he lived on which floor

( )23. I’m new here. Could you tell me__, please?A. when does the first bus arrive B. when the first bus arrives

C. when did the first bus arrive D.when will the first bus arrive

( )24. I wonder how long_______school?

A. has he been away from B. he has been away C. he has left D. he has been away from

( )25. ---We can use MSN to talk with each other on the Internet. ---Really? Will you please show ____it? ‘

A. what to use B. how to use C. how can I use D. where can I use

( )26. The teacher asked the students . A. if they were interested in chatting online

B. when was Albert Einstein born C. what they will do with the computers D. how often they go to movies

( )27---Could you tell me how long __the book?--Three days.

A.I can keep B.can I borrow C.I can borrow D. can I keep

( )28.I can’t understand ___the boy alone at home.

A.why she left B.did she leave C.why had she left D.why she leave

( )29. You will not succeeded if you ______ harder. A. will work B. won’t work C. work D. don’t work

( )30.Write clearly __your teacher can understand you correctly. A.since B.for C.because Dso that

( )31.______he failed , he went on doing the experiment .A. Even B. Yet C. Although D. in spite of

( )32.The dog went out while we __ supper. A. had B. had had C. were having D. would have

( )33.His brother has worked there ________ he left schoo A.when B. after C. since D. until

( )34.The boy didn’t stop talking ____the second bell rang. A.when B. until C. after D. because

( )35. __I came into the office, the teacher were having a meeting.A.While B. When C. Once D. Since

( )36.I was about to leave my house __ the telephone rang. A.while B. as C. when D. since

七年级上册英语人教版篇一:人教版英语+七年级上册各单元知识点详解

StarterUnit1Goodmorning.

1.Goodmorning/afternoon/evening早上(上午)/下午/晚上好。答语相同。在熟人或家人之间可省略good.熟人之间的问候可加上称呼语,称呼语放在问候语之后且用逗号隔开。如:Goodmorning,class!同学们,早上好!△Goodnight!晚安(晚间告别用语)2.Hello,Frank!你好,弗兰克。

3.A;Ho上午pm下午cm厘米mm毫米11.英语句子的书写

句子开头的第一个单词的第一个字母要大写,单词与单词之间要有适当的距离,一般为放入一个字母的空隙,句末要有标点符号,英语的句号是个实心圆点,而不是汉语中的小圆圈。12.大写字母的用法

1)英语句子开头的第一个字母必须大写。

2)I(我),OK在句中任何位置都大写。

3)人名、地名、国名、某国人或某种语言等专有名词的第一个字母必须大写。

4)电影名、书名、报刊、文章的标题等中的每个实词(如:名词、动词、形容词、副词、数词)的第一个字母一般大写。EnglishWeekly《英语周报》Titanic《泰坦尼克号》5)表示月份、星期、重要节日的名词的第一个字母必须大写。6)某些缩略词的第一个字母都必须大写。

7)表示称呼的名词的第一个字母通常要大写。UncleWang王叔叔

14.英语句子成分

一、主语(subject):句子说明的人或事物。

1.Thesunrisesintheeast.太阳从东方升起。(名词)2.Helikesdancing.他喜欢跳舞。(代词)

3.Tovie去看电影

2、助动词do/does的用法。

3、Whatkind(of)用来问种类:Whatkind(ofmovie)doyoulike?

4、too,ase你的名字firstname名字lastname姓氏hername她的名字

telephone/phonenumber电话号码inChina在中国

2.必背典句:

1.—nicetomeetyou!见到你很高兴!

—Nicetomeetyou,too.见到你我也很高兴。

2.—What’syourname?你的名字是什么?

—Alan.艾伦

3.I’mJenny我是珍妮。

4.What’shis/hername?他的/她的名字是什么?

5.Hername’sMary.她的名字是玛丽。

6.What’syourfirst/lastname?你的名字/姓氏是什么?

7.—What’shistelephonenumber?他的电话号码是多少?

—It’s876-9548是876-9548.

3.形容词性物主代词

物主代词是表示所有关系的代词,是人称代词的属格形式。它分第一人称、第二人称和第三

人称,每个人称又分单数和复数。物主代词分形容词性物主代词和名词性物主代词。

形容词性物主代词的用法和形容词的用法相似,具有形容词的性质。在句中作定语,(于:eC.myD.mine

(河北)Georgereadsthenewspapereverymorning.That’shabit.

A.heB.himC.hisD.himself

(四川南充中考)SheisastudentandnameisKate.

A.sheB.herC.hers

4.be动词用法

(1)be动词(am,is,are)这三个动词常用做连系动词,在句子中起连接主语和表语的作用。

Thisismymother.这是我的妈妈。

Iamnine.我九岁了。

Youaremygoodfriend.你是我的好朋友。

(2)be动词三种形式的使用主要取决于主语。主语是第一人称I(我)时,用am,主语是第二

人称you(你,你们)或名词及代词的复数时,用are,主语是第三人称单数it/he/she(它/

他/她)或名词及代词单数时,用is.

(3)am,is,are的意思是“是”,但不能处处翻译成“是”。例,Howareyou?你好吗?

5.What引导的特殊疑问句

英语中用于提出疑问的句子叫疑问句,以what等特殊疑问词开头的句子叫特殊疑问句,用

法如下:

(1)询问姓名,—What’syourname?你的名字是什么?—Alan.艾伦。

(2)询问某物用英语怎么说。—What’sthisinEnglish?—It’satelephone.这是一部电话。

(3)询问电话号码。—What’syourtelephone/phonenumber?你的电话号码是多少?

—It’s563-4789.是5634789.

6.基数词的用法。

数词分为两大类:基数词和序数词,表示“多少”的为基数词;表示“第几”的为序数词。

基数词有zero,one,two等。序数词我们刚学了一个“first”(第一)。其中基数词的用法如下:

(1)表示数字、年龄、日期等,在剧中可作主语、定语和表语。—What’stwoandfive?二加上五等于几?

—Seven七(表示数字)

—Howoldisit?它几岁了?

—It’sfour.它四岁了。(表示年龄)

—What’sthedatetoday?今天几月几日?

—It’sOctober3.10月3日。(表示日期)

(2)表示编号:LessonOne第一课UnitOne第一单元

(3)表示号码,如电话号码、门牌号、身份证号等,按单个基数词读出。0可以读成字母o

的读音或zero,相连的相同两位数可以读成double(双写的)+基数词。

(4)表示时刻:8::00=eighto’clock8点钟

7.汉语名字在英语中的写法

中国人名是姓在前,名在后。姓和名的首字母都要大写且中间空一格,若名为两个字,中间

不加空格,只需第一字的首字母大写。ZhangLing张玲LiuYifei刘亦菲

仁爱版七年级教案【篇2】

Unit 5

一 、教学目标

(一)语言知识

语音 /t/ /d/ /ts/ /dz/ /tr/ /dr/ /l/ /m/ /n/

词汇 掌握wake,early,first,day,term,must,still,by,on foot,the same to,usually,always,Ms.,boat,ship,sea,train,by plane/air/airplane, etc.

理解 Subway Worm reporter,Net Bar,roller skating Measure dining hall,dormitory bookstore,etc.

(二)语法

1.一般现在时(Simple present)

2.频度副词(Adverbs of frequency)never, seldom, sometimes, often, usually, always, once, twice

3.现在进行时(Present continuous)

I’m looking for a book.

Are you doing your homework?Yes, I am./No, I?m not. Is he/she...?Yes, he/she is./No, he/she isn’t.

What are you doing now?I’m playing computer games. What is he/she doing?He/She is...

4.谈论交通方式(Talking about means of transport)

How do you usually go to school? I usually go to school by bike.

(三)功能用语与话题

1.采访(Interviews)Our guest today is Michael from Class 2, Grade 1.

2.谈论日常生活(Talking about routines)

3.学校建筑(School buildings)swimming pool, playground, library, dormitory, lab, canteen, gym

4.谈论兴趣喜好(Talking about interests, likes and dislikes)I like the swimming pool best. Why do you like English? Because it’s interesting and easy.

5.借物(Borrowing things)How long can I keep it? Two weeks.

6.新闻(News)、海报(Poster)Attention, please! Here is the news.

7.谈论学校活动、科目和时间表(Talking about school activities, subjects and timetable)

8.谈论学校生活(Talking about school life)

(四)能力培养

听 能听懂谈论校园生活中比较熟悉的话题,识别主题,获取主要信息。

说 1?能根据提示词说出意思连贯的校园生活的句子。

仁爱版七年级教案【篇3】

七年级英语(仁爱版)下册复习教案

Unit 5 Our School Life

任务形学习目标:

掌握并能熟练运用表达交通方式的句型。

掌握频度副词的表达方式。

掌握一般现在是的用法。

Topic 1 How do you usually come to school ?

二.重点短语:

1. on foot go …on foot = walk ( to )…

2. by + 交通工具 “乘坐…” by bus / bike / plane / train / subway / ship / boat / car

3.take the bus = go …by bus ride a bike = go …by bike take the subway = go …by subway

4. on weekdays 在平日5. after school 放学后after class 下课后 after breakfast / lunch / supper早餐 / 午餐 / 晚餐后 6. in their free time 在空闲时间 7. have a rest 休息一下8. read books 读书11. go swimming 去游泳 12. listen to music 听音乐 12. watch TV 看电视 13. do(one’s) homework 做作业 14. go to the zoo / park 去动物园 / 公园 15. once a week 一周一次16. every day 每天 17. have classes 上课18. for a little while 一会儿 19. go to bed 上床睡觉 20. have breakfast / lunch / supper(dinner)吃早餐 / 午餐 / 晚餐 22. at the school gate 在校门口 23. come on 快点 、加油24. get up 起床 25. talk with / to sb.与某人谈话 26. at school 在学校、在上课 27. go to school 去上学 28. and so on ……等等

三.语法:表时间频率的副词:never 从来不 seldom 极少 sometimes 有时 often 经常 usually 常常 always 总是

1. I never go to school by subway. 2. I seldom walk to school.

3. Maria sometimes takes the subway home. 4. Li Xiang often rides a bike to school.

5. We usually go to the park on foot. 6. They always go to the zoo by bus.

7. How often do you come to the library ? Very often / Twice a week / Once a week / Every day.

四. 重要句型1. Happy New Year! The same to you.

2. Your new bike looks very nice. Thank you.

3. How do you usually come to school ? By bus / car / bike. On foot.

4. It’s time for class. = It’s time to have class. 该是上课的时候了。

5. The early bird catches the worm. 笨鸟先飞。/ 捷足先登。

6. We have no more time. 我们没有更多的时间了。

7. I have four classes in the morning and two in the afternoon.我早上上四节课,下午上两节。

8. She goes to bed at about a quarter to ten. 她九点四十五分睡觉。

Topic 2 He is running on the playground.

二.重点短语:1. make cards 制作卡片 2. on the playground 在操场上 3. in the library 在图书馆

4. in the gym在体育馆 5. on the shelf在书架上(shelves 复数) 6. at the Lost and Found 在失物招领处 7.clean the room打扫房间 8.have a soccer game 举行足球比赛 9. have an English class 上英语课 10. write a letter 写信 11. some of his photos= some photos of his 他的一些照片 12. on time 准时/in time及时 14. do better in sth 在某方面做得较好 15.put on 穿、戴上、上演(代词it / them放在中间,名词中间或后面,put it / them on ) 16. show sb. around… 令某人参观……

三.语法:

现在进行时态 主语+ be(is / am / are )+ 动词ing + 其他 。表示正在进行或发生的动作。常与now = at the moment 现在 、look看 、listen听 等连用。

1. I’m looking for my purse. 2. They aren’t sleeping at the moment.

3. Are you doing your homework ? Yes, I am. No, I’m not.

4. Is he / she singing now ? Yes, he / she is. No, he / she isn’t.

5. What is your brother doing ? He is running in the gym.

四. 重要句型

1.Excuse me, may I borrow your story book ? Of course. = Sure. (borrow sth from…从……借回某物……)

2. How Long may I keep the book ? Two weeks. ( keep 借用,后面常跟一段时间连用)

3.You must return them on time. ( return 归还,return sth to …把……归还给……)

4. Thank you. It’s a pleasure. = A pleasure = My pleasure. 别客气。

5. Sorry, I don’t have any. Thank you all the same. 仍然感谢你。

6. See you soon. 回头见. 7. What else ? 还有别的什么?( else 其他的、别的,常放在疑问词what/ where / who…和不定代词something/ somebody等的后面)

Topic 3 My school life is very interesting.

重点短语:1. outdoor activity 课外活动 2. easy and interesting 容易又有趣3. difficult and boring 又难又乏味 4. be friendly to sb. =be kind to sb. 对某人友好 5.between…and… 在……之间… 6. learn…from… 向……学习……/ 从…中学…… 7. from…to… 从……到…… 8. in the morning / afternoon / evening 在早上/ 下午/ 晚上9.on Monday 在星期一 on Monday morning在星期一的早上 11. tell sb. about sth告诉某人关于某事

三.语法:

一般现在时 主语+ 动词原形/ 动词第三人称单数s/es + 其他。表示经常或习惯性的动作。常与频率副词:never 从来不 seldom 极少 sometimes 有时 often 经常 usually 常常 always 总是或every day 每天、in the morning / afternoon / evening 在早上/ 下午/ 晚上 等连用。例如:

I often do my homework in the evening. I don’t often go shopping on Sunday.

Do you usually come to school by car? Yes, I do. No, I don’t.

Sometimes she watches TV in the evening. She doesn’t like Chinese.

Does she often take a bus to school ? Yes, she does. No, she doesn’t.

四. 重要句型

1.What day is it today?It’s Sunday / Monday / Tuesday / Wednesday / Thursday / Friday / Saturday.(在英语国家每周的第一天是星期天而不是星期一)

2. What class are they having ? They are having a music class.

3. What time does the class begin ? At ten o’clock.

4. What do you think of math? = How do you like math ? 你认为数学怎么样? It’s difficult and boring.

5. Why (为什么)do you like English ? Because(因为)it’s easy and interesting.

7.What subject (学科)do you like best ? I like history best.

8. At school, my teachers and classmates are very friendly to me.

9. I study Chinese, English, politics, geography and some other subjects.(other泛指其他的,别的+ 名词复数)

10.English is my favorite (最喜欢的)subject. I also like P.E and music.= I like P.E and music , too. (也)

11.Can you tell me something about it ?

五.词语辨析

a few 几个,一些 + 名词复数 a little 一点儿 +不可数名词 many 许多+名词复数 few几乎没有 little 几乎没有 much许多、大量的+不可数名词

other泛指其他的,别的+ 名词复数 another 泛指又一个、再一个、另一个+ 名词单数 the other 两者中的另一个

Unit 6 Our Local Area

Topic1 Is there a sofa in your study?

一、学习目标

1、掌握单词和重点词组

2、掌握there be的各种形式及用法

3、能熟练用英语描写房间、家庭、学校等建筑

4、熟练掌握方位介词in, on, behind, under, near, next to, in front of

二、重点词组

On the first floor 美式英语一楼floor地板,此处指“楼房的层”。英式英语用the ground floor 表示一楼

Why not =Why don’t you 复习其他提建议的方式

Go upstairs上楼 Go downstairs 下楼

A moment later 一会以后

You have a nice study。 study名词:书房 动词:学习与learn的区别

In the front of the house 在屋子(里面的)前面 In front of the house在屋子(外面的)前面

Talk about谈论 talk with sb.和某人谈论

Put them away 把他们收拾好

Look after = take care of 照顾,看管

In the tree(非树本身的东西)在树上 On the tree(树本身的东西)

On the river浮在水面上 over the river 在河上(悬空)

On the wall在墙上 in the wall 在墙里

Get a letter from sb= hear from sb 注意hear from宾语是人不是信,her of听说某人(物),hear听到,听见,侧重听的结果。常用 hear sb doing sth/do sth

Tell sb about sth Tell sb to do sth Tell sb sth

want sb to do sth/want to do sth

三、语法知识: There be 句型的用法

There be句型是英语中常见的特殊句型,用以表示某物某事存在或不存在。句中的there只起引导作用,并无实际意义,句子的真正主语是谓语动词be后面的名词。

1、在there be 句型中,谓语动词be要与主语(某人或某物)的数保持一致。当主语是两个或两个以上的名词时,谓语动词要与跟它最近的那个名词一致。

eg. ① There is a bird in the tree.

② There is a teacher and many students in our classroom.

③ There are two boys and a girl under the tree.

2、There be句型与have的区别:

There be 句型和have都表示“有”的含义。区别如下:There be表示“某处存在某物或某人”;have表示“某人拥有某物/某人”,它表示所有、拥有关系。 eg.①He has two sons.

②There are two men in the office.

当have表示“包括”、“存在”的含义时,There be 句型与其可互换。

eg. A week has seven days. =There are seven days in a week.

3、否定句

There be句型的否定式的构成和含有be动词的其它句型一样,在be后加上not或no即可。注意not和no的不同:not是副词,no为形容词,not a/an/any + n. 相当于no+ n.。例如:

There are some pictures on the wall. →There aren't any pictures on the wall. =There are no pictures on the wall.

There is a bike behind the tree. → There isn't a bike behind the tree. =There is no bike behind the tree.

4、特殊疑问句

There be句型的特殊疑问句形式有以下三种变化:

① 对主语提问:当主语是人时,用\“Who\'s+介词短语?\”;当主语是物时,用\“What\'s + 介词短语?\”。注意:无论原句的主语是单数还是复数,对之提问时一般都用be的单数形式(回答时却要根据实际情况来决定)。如:

There are many things over there. →What's over there?

There is a little girl in the room.→Who is in the room?

② 对地点状语提问:提问地点当然用“Where is / are+主语?\”啦!例如:

There is a computer on the desk. → Where is the computer?

There are four children on the playground. →Where are the four children?

③ 对数量提问:一般有两种句型结构:

How many+复数名词+are there+介词短语?

How much+不可数名词+is there+介词短语?

used to表示过去常常做某事.

例句: I used to play football after school.过去我常常在放学后踢球.

be used to do的意思是被用来做某事;be used to doing的意思是习惯于做某事.

used to + do:“过去常常”表示过去习惯性的动作或状态,但如今已不存在。

Mother used not to be so forgetful.

Scarf used to take a walk. (过去常常散步)

be used to + doing: 对……已感到习惯,或“习惯于”,to是介词,后需加名词或动名词。

He is used to a vegetarian diet.

Scarf is used to taking a walk.(现在习惯于散步)

Topic 2 What’s your home like?

重点语法:There be 句型

There be句型的否定句

There be句型的疑问句

③ There be句型的就近原则

④ There be句型的反意疑问句

⑤There be句型与have/has的区分

重点短语:

be like / an apartment building/ a town house /in the surburbs/

on the street corner/ rent a house with furniture to others / keep money

重点句型 :

①What’s your home like?

②What’s the matter ……?

③I hear you playing the piano.

④I can’t hear you ,the line is bad.

⑤I’ll get someone to check it right now .

⑥The traffic is heavy and the cost of living is high.

⑦There are many old people and many families with young children living there .

点拨:

㈠What’s your home like?

Like 动词“喜欢”,介词“像”。be like像和look like看起来像。be like 主要用来询问人的性格、外貌和事物特征。Look like 主要用来询问外貌。

㈡for rent 出租。wanted求租.rent sth to sb把某物租给某人rent sth from sb 从某人处租某物。

㈢call sb at + 号码。请打......电话与某人联系。

㈣I hear you playing the piano.

hear sb doing sth听见某人正在做某事(强调动作进行)

hear sb do sth (强调全过程)

㈤Many shops and restaurants are close to my home .

be close to 离……近。close 与near 都有“靠近”的意思,但close 比near 更近。

Topic 3 Which is the way to the post office?

重点语法:

祈使句

①肯定、否定形式。

②特例。

重点短语:

a ticket for speeding 超速罚单 at the end of the road在路的尽头 go across走过 turn left/right向左转/向右转 on the corner of 在。。。转角/拐弯处 across from 在。。。对面 between……and 在。。。之间 take the No. 718 bus乘坐718路公共汽车 change to变成no parking禁止停车 get hurt受伤 obey the traffic rules 遵守交通规则 keep on the right of the road 保持在路的右边 at the foot of 在。。。的脚下 hold sth in one’s hand抓住某人的手

重点句型:

一.问路语

Where is ……?

Is there a……near here?

Which is the way to ……?

How can I get to……?

Could you tell me the way to……?

二.指路

①Go along/down this road until……

②Turn left at the first turning﹦Take the first turning on the left.

③Go straight ahead and you will see……

④It’s about 15 kilometres away from here.

三.Thank you all the same .﹦Thanks anyway.

四.You can’t miss it.

五.You need to take bus No.718……

六.How far is it from here?

七.Everybody must be careful and obey the traffic.

八.We must stop and look both ways before we cross the road.

语法讲解:

祈使句:表示请求、命令、禁止、劝告或建议的句子,特点是省略了主语。

祈使句无主语, 主语you常省去;

动词原形谓语当, 句首加don't否定变;

朗读应当用降调, 句末常标感叹号。

●肯定结构:

1. Do型(即:动词原形(+宾语)+其它成分)。如:Please have a seat here. 请这边坐。

有的祈使句在意思明确的情况下,动词可省略。如:This way, please. = Go this way, please. 请这边走。

2. Be型(即:Be + 表语(名词或形容词)+其它成分)。如:Be a good boy! 要做一个好孩子!

3. Let型(即:Let + 宾语 + 动词原形 + 其它成分)。如:Let me help you. 让我来帮你。

●否定结构:

1. Do型和Be型的否定式都是在句首加don't构成。如:Don't forget me! 不要忘记我!

Don't be late for school! 上学不要迟到!

2. Let型的否定式有两种:“Don't + let + 宾语 + 动词原形 + 其它成分”和“Let + 宾语 + not + 动词原形 + 其它成分”。如:Don't let him go. / Let him not go. 别让他走。

3. 有些可用no开头,用来表示禁止性的祈使句。如:No smoking! 禁止吸烟!No fishing! 禁止钓鱼!

Unit 7 The Birthday Party

Topic1 When were you born ?

任务型学习目标:掌握序数词的表达法

掌握系动词be的一般过去时的用法

掌握日期的读法和写法

重点词组:

Plan to do sth have a birthday party be born be like

use sth to do sth must be buy sb sth=buy sth for sb

重点句型

When were you born? I was born in June,1970

Were you born in He bei? Yes,I was, No,I wasn’t.

3. Where was she born? She was born in /Henan.

4. When was your daughter born? She was born on october 22 .

5. What’s the date today? It’s may 8.

6. What’s the shape of your present? It’s round.

7. What shape is it? It’s rectangle.

8. How long/wide/tall/high/deep+is it?

9. What do we use it for? We use it to study English.

10.It must be an English learning machine.

11.Here is a present for you.

重点语法:系动词be的一般过去时

1. I was born in June,1970. 2. I was not born in He bei.

3. Were you born in Hebei? Yes,I was, No,Iwasn’t.

When was you daughter born? She was born on October 22nd,1996.

Where were you born? I was born in Hebei.

Was it like a flower just now? Yes,it was, No,it wasn’t.

重要知识点:

时间介词in/on/at用法

介词in/on/at可以用于表示时间的名词前,有“在”的意思,用法如下:

1)at用于钟点时刻前,意思为“在--- 时(刻)”,如at three O’clock

at a quarter to six at noon at night

at midnight at this time of day

2)in 用于泛指一天的上午,下午,晚上等,也用于某个较长的时间,如年,月,季节等,如in the morning/afternoon/evening in , in the day/daytime.

In还可以表示“从现在起一段时间以后”in a week

3)on用于表示在具体的某一天以及某天的某段时间,如on Sunday

on Children’s day , on the night of new year,on the morning\afternoon\ evening of , on Sunday morning

中考链结:

( )1.My uncle was born____June,1960.

A in B on C at D for

( )2.(08河南)We will never forget what happened___the afternoon of May 12. A in B by C at D on

( )3. (08苏州)Chinese climbers carried the Olympic Flame(奥运圣火)to the top of the world’s highest mountain___8th May,2008

A on B at C in D from

( )4.Mike will go to the town____December28

Unit7 Top2复习教案

知识网络梳理

1.重点词组:at the birthday party在生日聚会上 perform ballet跳芭蕾舞 dance to disco 跳迪斯科 take these flowers to 把这些花带去。。。 work out math problems 解出数学题 read books 读书fly a klite放风筝 be good at / do well in doing擅长做。。。 have a good time /enjoy oneself玩得开心with one’s help / with the help of 在某人的帮助下

2.重点句型:

Can you dance ?

Yes,I can /Yes ,a little /Yes,very well

No,Ican’t /No,not at all。

She can fly kites very well now. But one year ago , she couldn’t do it at all

Kangkang is good at playing soccer ,while Michael does well in basketball

Six years ago,there was something wrong with her eyes

With her mother’s help ,Jenny could write many words

3.易混点点拨:

1>play the guilar(piano /violin……)

Play football (soccer /basket……)

Play with the basketball (football /soccer…… )

球类运动前不用 the ,乐器名称前用 the

2>Take ,bring ,fetch 和 carry

Bring“带来,拿来”表示 “拿到靠近说话着的地方”;take “拿走,带走”表示“拿到远离说话着的地方”:carry“拉,搬”表示“用力移动,没有方向”;fetch“去取,去拿”,表示“往返拿物”。

Please take the books to the classroom。

Remember to your homework to school tomorrow

The bag is too heavy,please it to my office。

Don’t worry ,I can the key.

3>Read, see ,look and watch

See 看见,表结果;look看,表动作,不及物动词,后面需加介词at才能跟宾语;watch看比赛、电视;read看书、报,表示阅读

I can an apple on the table

I want to the film with you

,there is a kite flying in the sky

Please the blackboard carefully

Tv too much is bad for your health

He’s on tonight

4>work和job work可以作动词work out / at / on / for / as计算出/在……方面工作/致力于/为……而工作/作为……而工作,It doesn’t work .The pills that the doctor gave me aren’t working.可以作不可数名词:工作at work / out o

仁爱版七年级教案【篇4】

课件介绍及使用说明

本课件是为仁爱英语七年级上学期Unit 4 Topic 1 What can I do for you? Section A编写的教学课件。本单元内容主要围绕购物、打电话、表达时间以及谈论自己喜欢的事物和动物展开。本课要求学生学习并掌握购物的基本用语,掌握1000以内数字的读写方法,并能正确回应别人的感谢。本课件紧扣教学目标,直观生动,易于操作。

导入----①课堂活动,齐唱3b歌曲,活跃课堂气氛。

②听课文3a语音部分。

③复习数字1-20。

(幻灯片2-5。注:幻灯片2, 点击影片1播放3b歌曲;幻灯片3, 点击录音1播放3a语音部分。)

呈现----呈现人民币图片,学习数字21-999的读法和写法。

(幻灯片6-12)

巩固----①听2a 录音,跟读,完成表格,并记忆。

②听2b录音,完成连线。

③导入How much,学习价格询问方式。

④导出1a中的重点句型进行训练讲解。

⑤观看1a的动画,回答:How much is the coat?

(幻灯片13-18。注:幻灯片13,点击录音2播放2a录音;幻灯片14,点击录音3播放2b录音;幻灯片18,点击影片2播放1a动画,在听力练习中可以点击动画中的title键消去字幕,增加难度。)

练习----①再听一遍1a,完成1b。

②模仿1a内容进行快乐购物,并完成对话。

(幻灯片19-20。注:幻灯片19,点击影片2播放1a动画,)

小结----①总结数字1-999的读法和写法。

②总结有用的表达方式。

(幻灯片21)

作业----①复习数字21-999的读法和写法。

②背诵1a。

③预习Section B。

(幻灯片22)

仁爱版七年级教案【篇5】

Ⅰ. Teaching aims

1(1) 学习辨认物体及询问如何拼写单词的表达法。

(2) 学习新词 eraser, desk, pen, pencil等。

2. 能够用得体的语言辨认物体。

Ⅱ. The key points and difficult points

1.Key points:(1)Words and expressions : eraser, desk, pen, pencil

(2) Sentences: What’s this/that in English?

How do you spell it?

Can you spell it, please?

2.Difficult points:

不定冠词a/an的用法。

III. Teaching procedures

Step1. Warming-up

Step2. Pre – listening

Present pictures of some objects and teach the new words.

T: What’s this in English?/What’s that in English?

Ss: It’s a map./ an eraser./ a pen./ a map/ a desk..

T: How do you spell it (point to a pen)?/ Can you spell it, please?

Ss: P-E-N, pen./ Ss: Yes, P-E-N-C-I-L, pencil.Practice in groups.

Step3. While – listening

Play the tape recorder and finish 1b. Check the answers and then practice the dialogs.

Step4 Practice

1.Make conversations with these words. The sentences in 1a may help you.

2.Listen and finish 2a..

3.Guessing game.

4.Write the sentences, paying attention to the use of capital letters and punctuation.

Step5 Test

Blackboard design

Unit 1 Making New Friends

Topic 3 How old are you?

Section B

It’s a map./ an eraser./ a pen./ a map/ a desk..

P-E-N, pen.

Yes, P-E-N-C-I-L, pencil.

a map/ pen/ pencil/ desk/ toy/ telephone

an eraser/ apple

英语七年级教案


在众多文章中教师范文大全编辑看到了一篇引人深思的“英语七年级教案”。教案课件是老师上课前的准备工作,因此要注意随便书写。教案是教师日常教育教学工作中不可或缺的一部分。如果还想了解更多信息,请继续关注我们的网站!

英语七年级教案(篇1)

一.学习目标:

(1)知识与技能: 1.学会正确朗读和书写Aa-Hh八个字母。

2.了解一些常用缩略字的含义。

3.巩固所学的八个人名。

4.有英文名字的记住自己和同伴的英文名。

5.学会不同时段打招呼的用语。

(2)过程与方法: 通过听、读、说等活动培养良好的听和口头表达的能力;通过独学、对学、小组合作,学会正确读写字母、英文人名及问候语。

(3)情感态度价值观:培养正确的交际观念。

二、学习重点、难点

1.学会简单的问候用语及不同时段打招呼的用语。

2.八个字母的正确书写和记住尽可能多的名字。

三.学法指导:预习中自主学习的方法,课堂上积极参与小组讨论、合作、探究的方法。

四.学具准备:录音机、磁带、课本,教案

五.学习过程:

一、回顾反馈 预习提纲:

1. 正确朗读和书写Aa-Hh八个字母。

2. 巩固所学的八个人名,记住自己和同伴的英文名字。

3. 听读课本2c完成2c练习。

二、明确目标 学案教

学生自读目标 完成预习部分

三、自主学习 合作探究

1.看图片上的时钟让学生清楚地认识morning, afternoon and evening.这三个单词的区别,学会在不同时段来使用它们。通过图片的场景进一步加深对Good morning. Good afternoon. Good evening..这三个句子的理解和应用。

2.体会打招呼用语的奥妙所在,做到灵活运用。

1)Good morning / afternoon /evening:适用于比较正式客气的场合,双方都应说Good morning / afternoon /evening!例如:

A:Good morning,Miss wang.早晨好,王老师。

B:Good morning,Mr.zhang.早晨好,张老师。

2)Morning:适用于比较熟悉的朋友之间或比较繁忙的情况下。

3)Hello:是最广泛、最简单的打招呼语,显得亲切自然。例如:

A:Hello,Dale.你好,戴尔。

B:Hero,Helen.你好,海伦。

4)Hi:在现代英语中,Hi比Hello用得更多,显得更随和。例如:

A:Hi,Han Meimei.你好,韩梅梅。

B:Hi,Lucy.你好,露西。

四、展示提炼 拓展延伸

1. 小组练习对话,教师巡回指导。

---Good morning, Helen! --- Good morning, Bob!

---Good afternoon, Eric! ---Good afternoon, Grace!

---Good evening, Helen! ---Good evening, Dale!

---Hi, Alice! ---Hi, Cindy!

---Hello, Frank! ---Hello, Dale!

2.各小组展示对话

五.课后反思:

从本堂课收获中,我觉得现在的英语教学要以学生为主体,教师为引导。多鼓励差生开口说英语,并能及时地表扬他们。教师要有课堂效益意识。教学效益首先体现在课堂教学信息量、教学活动的广度和密度以及媒体的使用上。有效的媒体手段有助于课堂容量、密度和速度的提高。

英语七年级教案(篇2)

一、本单元设计意图

《英语(新目标)》是以任务型语言教学为基础的英语教材,它体现“以学生为中心”的教学思想。在教学实际当中,我们应该坚持“以学生为主体,以任务教学为主线,以教学为主导,以学生的能力培养为重点,逐步培养学生自主学习的能力”的教学策略。教材中每个单元都是一个独立的话题,但它在学生的实际生活中连成了一个整体。本单元的教学设计本着新目标的理念,针对学生的实际及教学实际来实施的。

一)教材分析

1.教学内容分析

本单元是教材的十一单元,它以学生最为熟悉的日常作息习惯为谈论话题,通过对句型:

--What time is it?

--It is six.

--What time do you usually get up?

--I usually get up at six a.m.

练习时间的表达和询问方式,同时逐步的培养学生合理安排时间的能力。整个单元以谈论日常作息时间安排为主线,将日常生活中所涉及到的语言、词汇和时间的表达法融入一系列的小任务中,初一的学生通过完成一个个的任务达到交际的目的,从而能够合理的安排自己的作息时间;且初步了解时差。

2.教学对象分析

学生通过前段时间的学习,对一般现在时态的用法已经有了一定的语感和模仿运用的能力,也能够用简单的英语表达个人意见。通过本单元学习能基本掌握时间的表达法并能用英语谈论作息时间安排。

3.教学目标

通过本单元的学习,使学生掌握相关的时间表达方法以及相关的词汇,能够就生活中的时间安排及日常活动来交谈;

通过情景设计来激发学生学习的学习兴趣,并培养学生的自主学习和与他人合作的精神;

通过谈论作息时间及日常活动,培养学生合理安排作息时间的意识。

4.教学难点

时间的表达法 5:15 five-fifteen (a quarter past five) 11:50 eleven-fifty(ten to eleven)

6:30 six thirty (half past six)

第三人称单数谓语动词的运用

本单元的新词汇多及内容跨度大也给学生在理解和掌握上带来了一定的困难。

5.教学策略

交际教学法,通过组织活动进行教学,体现Learning by doing, doing is learning;

任务型活动设计教学策略;

兴趣教学策略

合作学习

启发式教学和讨论法

6.课时安排:本单元分为四个课时,

Period 1(1a-2c)

从简单的时间表达法入手,通过对时间的了解,引入到学生平时熟悉的生活习惯,从而引出本单元的重要句型:What time do you get up?

Teaching aim:

To help them to say the times.

To know the actions of Rick’s day.

To say the drill:

What time do you get up?

I get up at six a.m.

Teaching focus:

Actions: get up, run, brush the teeth, wash the face, eat breakfast, do the homework, go to school take a shower, go to bed,

in the morning /afternoon/evening…

Period 2(3a, 3b, Section B 2a-2c)

学生在上一节了解本单元的主要句型的基础上,机械的把人物一天的主要活动描述出来,这里给了学生一个充分的能力释放的空间,激发他们的自主学习兴趣;在本节中学生们主要是掌握如何更好的表达一天的活动;

Teaching aim:

To help them know more actions that people usually do.

To ensure they can communicate by using the drills:

-What time do you usually get up?

-I usually get up at 6:00 a.m.

To help them to express their days.

Teaching focus:

Useful expressions: do homework, brush teeth, wash face, go to work, in the morning /afternoon/evening, love to do, listen to him, What a funny time to eat breakfast!

Period 3(section A part4, section B 1a,1b, 3a-part4)

通过前2节的学习,学生对描述人物一天的活动有了全面的了解,本节课主要是让学生们对人们平常的活动从上午,下午,晚上三个时间段做出归类,(当然这并不是精确的,只是大概的)目的是为了让他们能够;了解并合理的安排时间

Teaching aim:

To ensure they can read the massage quickly and get the useful information;

To ensure they can communicate about their days

To know something about the morning schedule themselves and arrange their morning reasonablely;

To ensure they can write the composition about correctly.

Teaching focus: say and write your morning and arrange their morning reasonablely

Period 4(self check)

通过听说读写各个方面来检测学生是否已经基本掌握本单元的知识点,同时引导学生对自己的假日及学习时间做出比较合理的安排;同时了解时差;

Teaching aim:

To communicate about their days

To ensure they can know more words;

To ensure they can arrange their days reasonable;

To know the culture of time;

Teaching focus: words and useful expressions

Teaching procedure:

Period 1(1a-2c)

Step 1 Say the time

1. Show the clocks and ask them: -What’s this in English?

-What time is it?

2. Show the way how to express the time.

Step 2 Presentation

1. Show a clock, ask them to say the time

2. Show the picture and let them to say

What does he do?

If they cannot say, let them say in Chinese.

Show the English of the action: get up,

3. Ask him: What time do you usually get up?

To the class: What time does he get up?

To show the sentences and read.

4. Do the others one by one in the same way.

5. Teach ‘take a shower’ and lead them to guess the time that Rick takes a shower

Step 3 Listen and say

1. Listen to the tape and fill in the blanks in page66 2a, and choose one to say.

2. Listen and complete the tablet.

3. Ask them to talk about the shower schedule for Rick’s family.

4. Choose some pairs to say.

Step 4 Look, listen and match

1. Page 65 let them look and match the picture.

2. Listen and match the time.

3. Show the pictures and let them to say again.

Step 5 Interview

1. Let them to say the actions they do everyday.

2. Show some pictures they may do, and let them try to say English.

3. Show the tablet and let them discuss in groups of 4.

4. Report what they get.

Step 6 Homework

Write a short passage about the tablet they interviewed

Period Two(3a, 3b, Section B 2a-2c)

Step 1 Warming up

1. Check their homework and ask some questions from their report:

What time does he usually get up?

2. Show the time and ask them to say in different ways.

3. Show the actions they learnt and ask them to say, then to make a sentence.

4. Show 6:30 8:10 11:20 4:15 and ask them to say.

Step 2 Presentation

1. Show the new pictures of actions and let them try to say: brush teeth, do homework, go to bed, wash face,play computer game.

2. Ask them to ask and answer in pairs by using the drills in this unit;

Choose some pairs to say.

Step 3 Listen and circle

1. Play the tape and let them to listen to 2a.

2. Check and let them spell the words.

3. Listen again and write the times 2b.

4. Check and let them ask and answer in pairs, and help them to use ‘when’.

Step 4 Read and say

1. Ask them to read page 67 3a and match the pictures.

2. Check and let them to say the words again.

3. Ask and answer questions about the time in pairs.

Choose some pairs to say.

4. Read the massage and fill the blanks.

Scott I

Study very long hours

Gets up at 17:00

Go to school by bike

Works all night

Get home at 17:30

Go to bed at 8:30

5. Ask them to exchange the message and say something to the partner.

Step 5 Homework

Read section 3a and write a similar passage.

Period 3 (Section A Part 4, Section B 1a, 1b, 3a, Part 4)

Step 1 Warming-up

1. Ask them to show the homework 5sts and ask them to say the words from it.

2. Ask them some questions from the homework.

3. To show the pictures and revise the phases actions in the daily life.

Step 2 Game

1. Ask them: A: When do you usually go to bed?

B: I usually go to bed…. When do you usually go to bed?

C: I usually go to bed…. When do you usually go to bed….

D: …

2. Ask them do the train drills, and line up from the earliest to the latest time.

3. To do it by using the other words.

Step 3 Practice

1. Give them five minutes to say the daily life about their parents.

2. Choose 5 or more to say.

3. If they cannot, give them more questions to help them;

Step 3 Read and write

1. Let them to read 3a and fill the time in the blanks.

2. Ask them to read.

3. Finish 3b.

4. Read for us.

Step 4 Groupwork

1. Discuss in groups of four and finish the tablet.

What do

people usually …? in the morning in the afternoon in the evening

get up

3. Choose some to report

Step 6 Homework

1. Imagine you are a famous star and collect the information about him or her, arrange this Sunday

Period 4 Self check

Step 1 Check their homework

Choose some students to tell us the Sunday schedule and collect it

Step 2 Self check

1. Page 70 part 1,

Let them to finish it.

2. Have a dictation.

Step 3 Design a survey

1. According to the knowledge, let them to design a survey.

2. Write down on page 70.

3. Ask some students to do it orally.

Step 4 Game

1. Divide them into three groups, and write the name, time and actions on the paper.

2. Collect them into three boxes, and ask students to choose, then make a sentence.

3. If he is right, his group will get one flag.

Step 5 Culture notes

1. Read through ‘just for fun’.

2. Discuss in groups.

3. Tell us what happened.

Step 5 Homework

Arrange your class in a week

Monday. Tuesday Wednesday Thursday Friday

7:20-8:05

Break time

英语七年级教案(篇3)

今天我说课的题目是M9U1, 我要说的是该模块第一课时。整个说课我将分为七个部分进行讲述,即说教材、学情、教学目标、教学重难点、教法、教学过程以及板书设计。

一、说教材

M9U1外研社版教材九年级上册。本模块围绕Great inventins这一话题展开教学,让学生学会谈论伟大发明。本课的教学内容与学生的生活密切相关,学生有认同感,因此我在在任务设计上,尽量贴近学生的'真实生活,以引起学生的共鸣和兴趣,激发学生的求知欲,充分发挥学生的想象力和能动性,主动自觉滴融入到语言学习中去。

二、说学情

八/九年级学生已经具备了一定的阅读理解和抽象思维能力,但是这个学段的学生注意力还是容易分散的,太枯燥的教学会使学生丧失兴趣,分散注意力,所以我打算采取模象直观的方法结合丰富的课堂活动,抓住学生活泼好动的心理,吸引学生们的注意力,

三、说教学目标

1. 知识与技能:

词汇:学习并掌握学科名称以及星期名称favrite, subect, ath, science, bilg, P.E., because, Mnda, Tuesda, Wednesda, Thursda, Frida等

语法:掌握

英语七年级教案(篇4)

Unit 7 What does he look like?

任务型教学设计:

1.话题: What does he look like?

2.目标:

1)认知目标:掌握新单词短语及句型,学会描述人的外貌,并能根据描述画出人像。

目标语言:

What does your friend look like?

She has a medium build, and she has long hair.

(Or: She is thin, and she is tall/medium height.)

2)能力目标:

①学会谈论身高,体重,发型,面部特征及着装特点。

②能积极思维,运用所学单词,短语及句型,结合实际生活进行灵活运用。

③能和合作伙伴互相交流,充分交换信息。

3)情感目标:学会简单地表达自己的观点或好恶,学会为人善良的美德。

任务设计:

笔者在本课时设计了5个不同的任务活动形式,紧紧抓住了初一学生求知欲强,好动,好自我表现的年龄特点,较为成功地完成了本课时的教学任务。

活动一:猜一猜,学一学

在本课时的第一步,新教学内容学习过程中,笔者采用了3幅学生熟悉的可爱的卡通图画,请学生们从身高,发型,体型三个方面依次用抢答的形式说出已学过的表达:He is tall/ short/medium height……

对新知识的学习,笔者采取了让学生从老师的体态语言中,从实际的图片及身边的同学长相,适时再配以音标,让学生自己猜义,拼读,然后再由老师,学生分别教读,领读。在说说,猜猜,学学的过程中,学生自然就进入了本课时的学习内容与氛围中。

活动二:动一动。

初一学生毕竟年龄小,好动是他们的天性。针对这一特征,笔者设计了在学习完身高,发型,体型三个方面的词汇后,让全班学生齐起立,跟着老师一起用形象的body movement复习巩固了刚学会的新内容。

活动三:唱一唱,编一编。

笔者用一个节奏简单明了的chant,把所学的知识用另一种形式得到体现与升华。学生先由老师带领熟悉chant 节奏与内容,再让学生模仿老师的chant,为他们所喜欢的人物(如贝克汉姆,周杰伦,居里夫人等)编写新的chant,最后再为身边的老师,同学进行现场编写chant,气氛达到了前所未有的高潮。学生的能力也从简单的模仿训练上升为带有一定创造性的训练活动,不但有利于他们的思维培养,还能极大地提高学习兴趣.

(附chant: What does she look like?? She is short,short,short,short.

What does she look like ?????? She is thin,thin,thin,thin.

What does she look like?????? She has curly hair,curly curly hair.

活动四:听一听,画一画,猜一猜。

为加强学生的听力能力,结合初一学生喜好动手的特点,笔者设计了让学生们先听两遍录音,再结合所听内容,为所听到的任务画像。再通过实物投影机,请画画的同学对所画的人物描述一翻,可以让学生为自己的同学画像并描述,让其余的同学猜他(她)画的是谁。

活动五:写一写,找一找。

笔者设计了一个结合生活实际的开放性任务:让学生自己假设一个情景,有可能是逛街时和妈妈走散,有可能是小孩走失,有可能是寻找多年不见的亲人等等,结合下列表格写出一份寻人启示。此任务不仅培养了学生的写作水平,同时也培养学生体会出助人为快乐之本.最后再升华了本节课思想: 心灵美比外表美更重要。这也突破了本节课的情感目标.

教学体会:

(1) 任务型语言学习有利于发挥学生的主体作用

在任务型教学中,教师教学活动的设计以学生为主体,教师的作用是组织、引导、帮助和监控,教学活动以学生用英语完成各项“任务”为主,从而培养学生应用英语的能力,这极大地发挥了学生的主体作用,充分体现了以学生为中心的教育理念。如在学生为自己喜欢和敬佩的人设计chant时,那种参与创造的氛围非常热烈,学生的情绪和能力体现都得到了很好的升华。

(2)任务设计的真实性有利于激发学生的学习兴趣:

由于有意义的任务活动贴近学生的生活、学习经历,能引起学生的共鸣,并能激发学生积极参与的欲望,使学生有话可说,使不同程度的学生都学有所得,体验成功的喜悦。

(3)小组活动的任务设计有利于培养学生合作学习:

在任务型教学中,教师围绕特定的交际目的和语言项目,设计出由易到难阶梯式、任务化的教学活动,教学活动中让学生用英语完成各项真实的任务,这些任务可以是独立完成的,可以是小组协作完成的。在完成任务的过程中,学生们针对自己对话题信息或语言知识的掌握程度,分工合作,为共同完成学习任务发挥各自的优势,并及时交流、合成信息,完成学习任务。小组活动的任务设计,使不同程度的学生都参与到活动中,发挥自己的优势,互相协作,共同提高。

英语七年级教案(篇5)

Unit 5 Our School Life

Topic 1 I usually come to school by subwsay

SectionD

Ⅰ. Aims and demands 目标要求

1. Learn the vowels: /(/, /( /

2. Learn some new words and phrases:

begin, have classes, while, go to bed

3. Sum up the useful expressions in this topic.

(1)Happy New year! The same to you!

(2)The early bird catches the worm.

(3)Nice talking to you.

(4)Work must come first!

(5)She goes to bed at about a quarter to ten.

4. Review and sum up the grammars.

(1) Review words and phrases of frequency.

never, seldom, sometimes, often, usually, always, once/twice/three times a week

(2) Sum up the present simple tense.

①Do you often come to school by bike? Yes, I do. / No, I don’t.

②I usually come to school by subway.

③I seldom walk to school.

④I never go to school by subway.

⑤They always take a bus to the zoo.

⑥How does Maria go home? She sometimes takes the subway home.

⑦How often do they have ball games? Four times a year.

⑧He usually plays soccer, but he doesn’t play basketball.

Ⅱ. Teaching aids 教具

录音机/音标卡片

Ⅲ. Five-finger Teaching Plan 五指教学方案

Step 1 Review 第一步复习(时间:7分钟)

复习节日问候语、谚语,复习Section C,完成4b和5。

1. (用生日歌的旋律唱Happy New Year导入本课, 可以活跃课堂气氛, 又为下一步进行4b做准备。)

T: Let’s sing the song Happy New Year together.

T & Ss: Happy New Year to you!

Happy New Year to you!

Happy New Year! The same to you!

Happy New Year to you!

2. (学习4b, 归纳本话题中有用的'表达方式。)

(1)(通过上面的歌曲, 巩固下面的表达方式。)

(

(2)(呈现The early bird catches the worm.和Work must come first!并翻译成汉语, 勉励学生勤奋学习。)

T: In this topic, we have learnt two useful expressions. They tell us we must work hard and can’t waste our time. Do you still remember them?

Ss: Yes. One is “The early bird catches the worm.” and the other is “Work must come first!”

T: So you must study hard every day.

(

3. (让学生听4b录音,并大声跟读。)

T: Well, let’s listen to 4b. Follow it loudly.

4. (检查家庭作业,完成5。)

T: Boys and girls, have you finished your homework?

Ss:

T: Good! In the last lesson, we learnt about the school life of American students. Today let’s survey your classmates about the school life. Fill out the form in 5 with

your survey results. Then compare the school life of American students with yours and write a passage. You may begin like this:

The school life of American students is different from ours OK, let’s begin! Step 2 Presentation 第二步 呈现(时间:5分钟)

呈现2

1. (复习一般现在时,引出2。)

(让学生看图片,完成书中的表格。)

T: Boys and girls. Look at the pictures in the passage. What does Jane usually do at 6:20 a.m.?

Ss: She usually gets up at 6:20 a.m.

T: What does she do at half past seven?

Ss: She goes to school.

(教师边问边引导学生完成部分表格。)

2. (让学生听录音完成剩余表格。)

T: Good! Let’s listen to 2 and fill in the rest blanks. Ready?

Ss: Yes.

T: OK, let’s begin.

(播放2的录音。)

3. (核对答案)

T: Now, let’s check the answers. Who wants to share the answers with us? S1: Let me try

T: Very good. Next one?

S2:

4. (让学生仔细阅读2,找到新单词并猜测其词义。)

板书

begin, have classes, while, go

to bed

T: Wonderful! Now let’s read this passage carefully and guess the meaning of the words.

(点评并纠正学生在理解上的错误。)

5. (让学生依据2中的表格复述短文。)

T: Now, let’s look at the table and retell this passage. Any volunteers?

S3: Let me try

T: Great! Anyone else?

Step 3 Consolidation 第三步 巩固(时间:16分钟)

英语七年级教案(篇6)

【教材分析】

本模块以出行旅游为话题。对话是通过读地图来呈现指路及表明具体位置的语言表达方式。通过本单元的听说活动,给学生提供充足的体验和运用语言的机会。

【学情分析】

学生具有一定的英语基础,学习热情高,表现欲强,能积极参与到课堂中。而且相互之间能够很好地利用小组进行合作交流。

【教学目标】

Knowledge objective:

To master some words and expressions about places, positions and giving directions.Ability objective:

1.To ask the way and give directions.2.To understand a conversation of giving directions.Moral objective:

1.To be polite to others.2.To be ready to help others.3.To know more about Beijing and love Beijing.【教学重点】

1.To learn some words and expressions about places:

Bank, museum, along, across, cross, opposite, tourist, excuse, excuse me, street ,turn, third, guidebook, bookshop, right, why not ?? could, underground

2.To learn and review some words about positions: near,opposite, along, on the left/right, across.3.To learn some expressions about asking ways and giving directions:

【教学难点】

1.To get information from the conversation.2.To ask the way and give directions.【教学方法】

PWP method, task-based method and interactive approach.【教学手段】

A tape recorder, multimedia ,PPT courseware, the teaching CD and some pictures.【教学过程】 Teaching Procedures:

Step 1 Revision【复习】

1、listen to an English song.Aim : to activate the classroom atmosphere.2、Do a duty :

Aim :To give one student a chance to train his spoken Englishin every class.3、Talking and acting:

Aim :to check if the students can practice the topic of the last

module and to develop the students’speaking and language expressing abilities.Step 2 Leading in

【导入】

1、Play a guessing game: The teachers shows the pictures ofnew words and let the students say as quickly as possible.Ai : to check if the students preview the new lesson before the class and to be familiar with them.2、Look, think and say: the teacher shows some pictures aboutgiving directions and some road signs and asks the students to think and say the phrases.Aim :to consolidate the phrases about giving directions.3、Find and say.The teacher shows pictures of direction prepositions, and the students find the right words and make some sentences with the direction prepositons.Aim : to understand and master the usage of the directionprepositions.【总结】

1.Do some exercises about the direction prepositions。2.Do some exercises about the patterns of asking for and giving directions.

英语七年级教案(篇7)

山东省特级教师、青岛二中英语教研组组长刘元静告诉记者,最后两个周各学校一般都已经进入了一个“静悟”的阶段,在这个阶段中,既要多思考、总结,同时也不能放下常规的练习。“最好可以保持隔一天做一套题,跟高考保持同样的时间段,下午三点到五点,控制好时间,这样能大体上了解自己的答题节奏,上考场的时候才不会慌。”刘老师介绍说,“如果个人在特定的题型上有所欠缺,也可以重点做一些练习。”

九中的高三英语集备组组长匡文超老师也介绍说,考试前两周要掌握学校或老师给总结的重点字、词、句、短文,努力在考试中灵活运用,要平稳心态,按部就班的进行复习。因为考试形式都出入不大,复习时最好放慢速度不要一味地追求突击,难度不要太大,要以梳理语言思维为主。

从明年开始,山东高考英语考试中听力将不再出现,今年的考生将会是最后一批考核听力的考生。针对听力的练习,九中的匡文超老师介绍说,因为高考英语是在下午三点到五点之间,所以为了习惯这个时间答题,有条件的情况下最好在这个时间段放听力。

而对于听力的练习,青岛二中的刘元静老师也介绍说,如果有条件的话尽量不要戴着耳机听,以免到时候不适应考场环境。“因为我们高考的时候,听力都是用大喇叭的,在播放的过程中肯定会有一定的失真,音质也没有用耳机好,而且考生座位的不一样听到的声音大小都会有区别。”刘老师介绍说,“考生的心理都会很微妙,如果稍微有些不一样,那么听力的时候就可能会紧张,所以建议大家在家里练习的时候也尽量用喇叭。”

临近高考,不少考生都以为多背几篇范文,到时候高考的时候没准可以蒙上,对于这种想法,二中的刘老师明确表示没必要。“千万不要让孩子整篇整篇地背诵范文,因为高考考核的是综合运用语言的能力,让你‘押宝’押中了的情况几乎不可能出现。所以大家还是重在积累,把平常遇到的、听力中听到的精彩词句都可以记下来,灵活运用到高考作文中去,整篇整篇地背范文反而会限制考生的思维,因此完全没必要。”

“按部就班地放慢步伐复习,不要搞突袭,调整心态,防止考试时状态不好出现问题。”九中的匡老师说道,临考前的心态也很重要。研究近三年高考题,习惯高考题型防止不适应,不要一味要求难度,要梳理培养英语思维,强化二卷答题能力防止非客观因素扣分(粗心等)。强化二卷的答题能力,不要因为粗心或其他情况影响成绩。

英语七年级教案(篇8)

新目标英语人教版七年级下册英语教学计划范例

一、教材分析

本学期的主要内容为PEP小学英语六年级下册,共有4个教学单元、2个复习单元。每单元分“A、B、C”三个部分,共12页,复习单元为6页。全书配有彩色卡通式插图,设计新颖活泼,生动有趣。本教材的设计与编写体现了对传统外语教学思想的继承和发展,在比较、分析和研究多种国内外小学英语教材的基础上,博采众长,取其精华,形成了本套教材特有的编写体系。本套教材的编写思路是以话题为纲,以交际功能和语言结构为主线,逐步引导学生运用英语完成有实际意义的语言任务,即:话题-功能-结构-任务。根据学生的实际情况,教师可以有选择地、灵活地安排教学内容,有针对性地设计课堂教学活动。

二、学生分析

六年级的学生对英语学习兴趣整体有所下降,两极分化比较严重。所以本学期应做好后进生的转化工作。教师应该面向全体学生,以学生的发展为宗旨,始终把激发学生的学习兴趣放在首位,注意分层教学,引导学生端正学习态度,掌握良好的学习方法,培养学生良好的学习习惯。

三、教学目标

1、能按四会、三会的要求掌握所学单词。

2、能按四会要求掌握所学句型。

3、能使用日常交际用语,活用四会句型,进行简单的交流,做到大胆开口,发音正确。

4、能在图片、手势、情境等非语言提示的帮助下,听懂清晰的话语和录音。

5、进一步养成良好的书写习惯。

6、进一步养成听英语、读英语和说英语的良好习惯。

7、能运用相关的语言知识和技能,完成某项任务。

四、主要教学措施

1、以活动为课堂教学的主要形式,设计丰富多彩的教学活动,让学生在乐中学、学中用,从而保证学生英语学习的可持续性发展。

2、通过听、说、读、写、唱、游、演、画、做等形式,进行大量的语言操练和练习。

3、培养学生拼读音标的能力,确保学生自主学习的质量。

4、设计全面、高效的课外作业,培养学生良好的书写习惯,做到整洁、规范、正确地书写。

5.对优秀学生尽量的多提高自身素质,多看英语读物,多落知识点。对差生则多利用课堂,课外的时间抓基础知识,纠正个别同学的发音。努力提高学生学习英语的积极性。争取全班统一进步。

五、教学进度安排

由于本学年教学时间相对较短,所以教学时间显得十分紧张,因此对本学年的教学作如下安排:

教材共四个单元。每单元8课,其中6节新授课,新授课部分两周完成,复习单元一周完成,计三周一个单元。书本知识共32课,不排除因为课文难,学生接受较慢而增加课时。教学中还穿插各种形式的`小测验,丰富多彩的英语活动,还有数次作业、考试的评析,同时由于放假、学生差异、教学容量、教师进修、考试等其他客观因素的影响,我将按实际需要对课时进行适当调整,力求达到最佳效果。

总而言之,这半年是六年级学习小学英语的最后半年,本学期英语教学的目的就在于要使学生爱学、乐学、善学。为中学的英语学习打下基础,同时教师充分利用“情景教学”这一重要方法扩展教学形式,培养、维持和发展学生学习英语的兴趣,提高英语教学的效果。

六、电教计划:

UNIT 1:Part A Let’s learn 运用“金太阳”光盘进行教学,让学生学习单词的标准的发音。

Part B Let’s talk 运用“金太阳”光盘进行句型的教学。

UNIT 2 :Part A Let’s learn 运用“金太阳”光盘进行教学,让学生学习标准的发音。

Part B Let’s talk 运用“金太阳”光盘进行句型的教学,学生能进行分角色对话。

UNIT 3 :Part A Let’s learn 运用“金太阳”光盘进行教学,让学生掌握句型标准的发音。

Part B Let’s talk 运用“金太阳”光盘进行句型的教学。

UNIT 4 :Part A Let’s learn 运用“金太阳”光盘进行教学,让学生学习标准的发音。

Part B Let’s talk 运用“金太阳”光盘进行句型的教学。

UNIT 5 :Part A Let’s learn 运用“金太阳”光盘进行教学,让学生学习标准的发音。

Part B Let’s talk 运用“金太阳”光盘进行句型的教学。

UNIT 6:Part A Let’s learn 运用“金太阳”光盘进行教学,让学生学习标准的发音。

Part B Let’s talk 运用“金太阳”光盘进行句型的教学。

具体进度表安排如下:

周次 日 期 内 容

1 2月19日—2月24日 Unit 1 Part A Let’s learn &Let’s do

2 2月25日—3月2日 Unit 1 Part A Let’s talk

Unit1 Part A Read and write

Unit1 Part B Let’s Learn

3 3月3日—3月9日 Unit 1 Part B Let’s talk

Unit 1 Part B Read and write

Revision and Test

4 3月10日—3月16日 Unit 2 Part A Let’s Learn &Let’s do

Unit 2 Part A Let’s talk

Unit 2 Part A Read and write

5 3月17日—3月23日 Unit 2 Part B Let’s Learn &Let’s chant

Unit 2 Part B Let’s talk

Unit 2 Part B Read and write

6 3月24日—3月30日 Revision and Test

Unit 3 Part A Let’s Learn & Let’s do

Unit 3 Part A Let’s talk

7 3月31日—4月6日 Unit 3 Part A Read and write

Unit 3 Part B Let’s learn &Let’schant

Unit 3 Part B Let’s talk

8 4月7日—4月13日 Unit 3 Part B Read and write

Revision and Test

Recycle 1

9 4月14日—4月20日 Unit 4 Part A Let’s Learn

Unit 4 Part A Let’s talk &Let’s chant

Unit 4 Part A Read and write

10 4月21日—4月27日 Unit 4 Part B Let’s Learn & Let do

Unit 4 Part B Let’s talk

Unit 4 Part B Read and write

11 4月28日—5月4日 Revision and Test国际劳动节

12 5月5日—5月11日 国际劳动节

Unit 5 Part A Let’s Learn & Let’s chant

Unit 5 Part A Let’s talk

13 5月12日—5月18日 Unit 5 Part A Read and write

Unit 5 Part B Let’s Learn & Let’s do

Unit 5 Part B Let’s talk

14 5月19日—5月25日 Unit 5 Part B Read and write

Revision and Test

Unit 6 Part A Let’s Learn & Let’s do

15 5月26日—6月1日 Unit 6 Part A Let’s talk

Unit 6 Part A Read and write

Unit 6 Part B Let Learn & Let’s chant

16 6月2日—6月8日 Unit 6 Part B Let’s talk

Unit 6 Part B Read and write

Revision and Test

17 6月9日—6月16日 Recycle 2

18 6月17日—6月22日 Revision

19 6月23日—6月29日 期末考试,学期结束工作

最新七年级新目标英语教案14篇


想要查看“七年级新目标英语教案”的相关资料可以参考以下内容,大家都来看看吧说不定有意想不到的收获。老师会对课本中的主要教学内容整理到教案课件中,所以老师写教案可不能随便对待。 教案和课件是高效教学的必要条件。

七年级新目标英语教案【篇1】

在悠扬的轻音乐中,我开始了上课。这是一堂人物外貌的描述课,所以我用一个游戏“Pally says…”game开始引课。

StepI.Guidance: Play “Pally says…”game目的在于活跃气氛,调动学生的积极性,减少学生的紧张情绪。加之五官属于人的长相的范畴,所以与此课人物外貌相关连,这样引入就能自然过渡到本节课的内容。人物前活动用于扫除学生的语言障碍,因此在教学上以激发学生的学习兴趣为主,通过活动让学生感知、操练语言,为下一步活动做好铺垫。

Rulers: If Pally says touch your eyes/ears/ nose/mouth/shoulder/legs/arm. You should do it . If it doesn’t say that, you can’t do it. If you are wrong, you have to sit down. The person who does it correctly is the winner.

After that we begin to study our lesson.

T: Do you like Miss Hu?

Ss: Yes.

T: Why?

Ss: Because you are beautiful.

T: Thank you. Do you like her?(图片展示)

Ss: Yes.

T: OK, I know you think she is a beautiful girl, too. And you like any beautiful person. Today we learn Unit 7 What does he look like?( 图片展示同时板书。)

Step II. Teach the new words and new sentences pattern.

The teacher uses the pictures to lead and teach the new words and the new sentence pattern. And then ask the Ss to describe the classmates.

先利用图片展示进行新单词句型的引入,让学生熟悉。接着要求其他同学描述三位外貌典型的同学,再小组练习。这样更形象,更贴近生活,学生更容易接受,加强了学生间的合作与交流。再按发形,身高,体重的类别练习以免混淆,同时加深记忆。在教学的过程中,我要求学生描述教室里听课的老师,学生们十分激动,想着能用英语描述自己的老师了,他们特别高兴。此时的气氛很活跃。

StepIII. Pair work

At first the teacher gives the Ss an example. Then ask Ss practice like this.

A:What does he look like?

B: He has short hair. He is tall. He is medium height.

这样完整地描述人的外表是为后面能安排、完成任务做铺垫,同时能检测学生的掌握情况,以便老师随时调控。

StepIV. Play a guessing game.

At first the teacher gives the Ss an example.Then ask Ss to describe anyone in the classroom. Let the others guess.

这个游戏的安排目的是让学生通过他人的描述,去发现别人的外部特征。培养学生听、说以及辨别能力,同时可活跃课堂气氛。

StepV. Free talk: talk about any person who you like.

这是一个任务教学,让学生描述自己的家人、朋友及喜爱的明星,增添他人对自己的了解。学生拿出事先准备好的自己最喜爱的电影、足球明星,在小组里轮流进行描述。然后在组与组之间进行资源共享,让学生在讲台上用投影仪进行展示。(通过这一活动,使学生在掌握一定的英语基础知识和基本技能,能与小组成员合作共同完成学习任务,发展语言的综合运用能力,并创造性地使用英语表达自己的思想)。

StepVI. Describle and draw

Ask Ss to describle “What do you look like when you are 20 years old and draw a picture of it.

设计这个任务目的在于让学生能学有所用,想象设计一下自己20岁风华正茂时的样子,并画出来,让此堂课别开生面,乐趣横生。同时这培养学生的多种能力,让其能动手动口。

StepVII.1a-1b

在学生掌握好的前面的知识的基础上再处理学习书上的知识,就化难为简,学生才能得心应手,同时让学生整体回顾本节课的重点内容。

StepVII. Motto

此格言的安排是为了培养学生尊重他人的品德,不以貌取人。

StepIX. Homework.

1. Copy the sentences in Grammar focus.

2. Describe your friend,your parent, your teacher or any other person,and then write it down in your exercise book

通过以上几步的语言输入练习,让学生在进一步创造性活用所学语言,提高学生的写作能力。

二、课后分析及感想:

反思中教学,教学中成长

精心准备了好久的“节目”上演完毕,心中紧绷的弦终于放了下来,不管结果怎样,我都坦然。因为它毕竟是我努力的心血。从初赛到复赛到决赛,我努力过、奋斗过,有了这个过程,结果怎样就显得不是那么重要了。毕竟我们年轻人就是应该在一次次的磨练中,吸取经验教训,在反思中教学,在教学中成长,才有利今后的进一步提高。当然这次课后我也受益不浅。课后也私下征求了一些老师的意见,询问了学生的学习反馈意见。我一直在思索这个问题:我们的英语课该怎样去上,才能让学生觉得不枯燥,并能学好知识?是天天拿着教材教呢?还是变着花样把生活以及其他学科融入到英语学科,让学生们去感受,去体会,然后学中用,用中学。

本课是初一新教材第7单元的第一部分,教材内容围绕着描述人的外貌特点展开,让学生学会谈论人的身高、体重、发型、面部特征及着装特点。本课的教学内容与学生的实际生活密切相关,易于引发学生运用简单的英语进行交际和交流。在学习活动中,学生能通过交换对不同人物的描述及看法,促进学生之间和师生之间的情感交流,增进情谊。所以在这堂课的设计上我是从以下几个方面去考虑的,以下是本节课的亮点:

第一:丰富的图片信息使用:我们的学生由于他们的年龄特征所定,对形象的事物特别感兴趣,尤其对新新人类更是喜欢。那么就这个特点,我采用了大量的人物图片。而这些图片却是经过精挑细选的:就本课的教学内容它主要是要求描述人物的发型与身材,所以选图时,就得相当有代表性。比如:高个--姚明;矮个--潘长江;胖的--韩红;瘦的--张柏芝等等。让学生一看就能明白这些单词的含义。那么他们说起来也就琅琅上口了。

第二:对现实教学资源的合理利用:图片给的信息直观,现实的资源就更为形象。本课要求学生能描述他人的外貌。那么我们的身边有这么多的同学、老师,我们来描述他们的长相,岂不更贴近生活实际,给我们的学习岂不带来更多的乐趣。这样更能给学生们长久的记忆。

第三:贴近学生的生活,让学生的口、手齐动。人们常说我们要过“双文明”生活。那我们的学生也应要求思维与动手能力齐备。大量的可行的任务教学设计,有利于学生们对知识的灵活运用。

首先要走进学生的生活,了解他们才能找到让他们动口动手的关键。那么怎样走近学生的生活呢?那就应该知道他们的喜好。我们的学生有强烈的喜恶情绪,有自己所喜欢、所崇拜的明星。那么以此为切口,我设计了一个活动:谈论自己喜欢的明星。这样以来学生就能运用自己所学的知识去描述自己喜欢的明星。并且缩短了与学生的距离,也让他们感受到老师的关心。

我让学生自备明星照片讲述,以及用“猜朋友”的办法来描述他人进行思维与口头的训练,同时我让学生们自己设计绘画自己将来的形象,培养了他们的动手能力,并且描述出来,这就让学生手口齐动。三个环节紧密相扣,层层相关。

第四、发挥多学科知识的联系作用。这一节课要求学生能描述他人的外貌。这就要求学生应具备听、说能力。怎样把这样的能力融入一体,并且学生能很好的接受,同时还能锻炼写的能力呢?怎么办呢?我想学生们的想象能力十分丰富,何不让他们想象一下当他们20岁的时候自己长什么样子呢?可是这个活动又怎么实施呢?我犯难了。我想不如让他们一边描述,一边画出自己的'肖像。这样利用美术知识来巩固本节内容,学习的形式也多样了,岂不更好?

第五、对学生情感上的引导。人的外貌对人的影响是很大的,所以常常有人犯以貌取人的错误。那么我们老师就应该对他们进行正确的引导,培养学生正确的人生观和世界观。于是在此课中通过描述同学、教师或自己的偶像的外貌,表达自己的看法,使学生在人际交往中学会尊重和理解别人,学会交换不同的看法,了解他人的爱好,增进情谊。在选图时,我就侧重强调人物虽然有美丑,但是他们却都有自己的特长,都能在各自的领域成就一翻事业,让学生明白人不可貌相。同时在课末我增添谚语,再次强调人的外貌在人生中不是最重要的因素,能力才是最重要的。

在课堂上我鼓励学生大胆的使用英语,对他们学习过程中的失误和错误采取宽容的态度。以学生为主体,教师旨在导学,不断创设情境让学生参与,积极肯定地评价学生的表现。任务设计较成功,创造条件让学生能够研究他们自己感兴趣的话题。同时注意给学生创设自主学习和交流的机会。学生通过体验、实践、讨论、合作等方式发展了听说读写的综合语言技能。同时我也将在今后的教学中继续探索在任务、与合作型教学中如何调动全体学生的积极性的方法。争取做到让学生独立“自主”学习,参加小组活动进行“合作”学习,做到“探究”学习

本课的设计使学生确实从学习中学会了如何谈论外貌,同时还学会了识别不同人物外貌特征,设计简单形象.丰富了学生生活,同时也是一种真实的体验.增加学生的语言实践,促进他们在整个教学活动中主动参与。

在板书设计上,为了避免学生把is和has混用,我采取了分开总结排版的格式,让学生能一目了然,描述什么该用什么词语。这样能使他们更容易接受,并且能分清它们的区别。 而课后作业是描述朋友、父母的外貌特征。这样设计的目的是为了巩固知识培养和提高学生的写作能力 。通过以上几步的语言输入练习,让学生再进一步创造性活用所学语言,提高学生的写作能力。

从这些方面我设计了本节课,按理说是很不错了,可是上完之后却不如我想象中的那么好。因为此课的设计不管是从内容上还是活动上都是很有激情的,然而学生的激情却没有充分的调动起来,让我很失望。课后我也一直在思考这个问题。我问学生为什么不积极回答我的问题呢?他们给的答案是:“胡老师,我们在那样的大教室里,有那么多老师听课,回答问题很紧张,害怕答错。”原因似乎很简单,但是这个问题却一直萦绕着我。我发现自己还有很多不足:

首先培养学生大胆发言习惯不够。在平常的教学中,学生的胆量是比较大的,可是这学期与上学期他们举手发言的激情却没有那么活跃了。因此我想在今后的教学中我应该注意培养学生大胆开放的性格,让学生在任何场合都能勇于发言,积极思考。

其次,课堂调控能力仍需加强。可能由于自己教学经验不足,导致调控能力不够好,所以没有把学生的激情完全调动起来,导致课堂上没有那么活跃。我应该把握好学生学习的反馈情况,及时调整教学进度。

既然意识到自己的不足,那么今后我应该多学习专业知识,多向其他老师学习,多方位的了解学生,把握好教学进度,分析好学情,弥补自己的不足,争取以后能学到更多的知识,能更好的上好课,教好书。争取尽快成长成为一名优秀的教育工作者。

七年级新目标英语教案【篇2】

人教版新目标七年级下册英语第九单元教案

Unit 9 How was your weekend? No. 110 Middle School of Chongqing  By Cao Yi Teaching Goal: 1. General aims: Talk about recent past events 2. Particular aims:   A. Language Focus.   Talk about recent past events and think of the past events. B. Language goals How was….? It was … What did …do over the weekend? C. Language structures: (1). How was your weekend? I was great. Pay attention to no form. (2). What did you do over the weekend? I played soccer. We went to the beach. D. Useful words and phrases:   Words: was, did, went, beach, over, project, test, wasn’t, false, number, geography, spend, week, most, mixture, their, had, little, cook, read, saw, change, everyone, sit, sat, no, anything   Phrases: did one’s homework, played soccer, cleaned my room, went to the beach, played tennis, went to the movies, on Saturday morning, over the weekend, cook … for, what about, do some reading, have a party, talk show, go shopping E. Grammar language:   Present simple past tense Regular and irregular verbs F. Learning strategies:  Tour and holidays G. Interdiscipinary:   H. Emotion and manner:   Teaching time: 5 periods Teaching procedures:   Period One (pp31-32)   教学步骤、时间 教师活动   学生活动 媒体应用 Step 1 Free talk 3’ Ask some questions like: Who’s on duty today? What’s the weather like? Answer and talk about something.     让同学们回答下列问题 1. Do you like weekend? (Let some students answer) It takes them three minutes to talk about the question. 2. Why do you like weekend? (let the students answer) Most of the students like the weekend 此时教师用汉语问: “在周末期间问你干了什么? 这句话用英语这么回答? Let the students guess. At last the teacher give them right answer 3. What did you do over the weekend?(板书、学习) 4. What did you do over the weekend? (Let sb. answer the question) I-played basketball. 5. 出示三张照片(有各种活动) 6. Match the words with the picture   7. Let the students listen and write carefully. First listen, then listen and write the words like “morning afternoon” or “night”等 Find some students to answer. The students talk about it in pairs.   Students think of the sentences.               Students study and read the sentences First the students read after the teacher, the practice in pairs. 学生看图,互相问答:What did you do? The students look at the picture on page 29 and do it. Listen and write carefully.       媒体展示问题                   多媒体放映图一、图二、图三(关于周末的.活动) Step 3 Practice(5’) Pairwork Role play students A ask and student B answer Then let them do it in pairs A: What did you do over the weekend, Lucy? B: I played tennis. Students do it in pairs.   Step listen to 2a and 2b (5’) Listen and underline the words you hear, then listen again and write. Listen and underline Listen and write A \ B \ S carefully   Step 5 Summary (2’) 1. Words and phrases of the class. 2. What did you do over the weekend? I played ―. Look and listen carefully   Step 6 Test (5’) Selfcheck 1 and 2c Students do it 放映多媒体 Step 7 Consolidation Make a dialogue use “What did ―?”at least five questions. Divide the students into 7 groups.     Step 8 拓展练习(3’) 1. What did you do over the Weekend? 2. What did you do over the weekday? Students answer did things in different times. 多媒体展示、总结 Step 9 Homework (1’). 1. Practise the dialogue. 2. Grasp the grammar Focus.   多媒体放映   Period Two (p33)   教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用 Step 1 Free talk (2’) Ask a student “Do you like weekend”? Do you like weekday? The students answer and talk.           Step2 Presention (10’) (用班里学生为例作下列练习) 1. What did you do over the weekend? 2. First let the students draw a picture of weekend然后让他们利用实物投影向我们说明 3. 用 “What did you do over the weekend?” 询问几个学生后,这着一个学生问“你的周末怎么样?” 4. Let the students change it into English. 板书 “How was your weekend?” Then let the students practice in pairs. 5. Write number (1-3) in the blanks. 1. Draw a picture of weekend 2. Tell the class about your weekend like” I played basketball in the morning. 3. The student answers. (have a try) Guess: How was your weekend? Read and study Then do it in pairs. Ex: How was your weekend? It’s great. I played basketball. Look at the picture in 3a. and write unmbers. 实物投影                   媒体展示         媒体展示答案 Step 3 Game 6’ Let Ss write 3 things they did over the weekend. One is false, the others are true. 然后把学生的描述利用实物投影机投到大屏幕上。 Write 3 sentences ion their paper. Look at the screen. Let the other Ss guess which one is true/false. 实物投影 Step 4 Summary 3’ 1. words 2. Grammar: How was your weekend? I was great. / I did … Read and remember 媒体显示 Step 5 Consolidation 10’ Divide the Ss into several groups. Every group must make up a dialogue. Use “What did you do on the weekend?”/How was your weekend? And so on. Make up a dialogue in groups and act it.   Step 6 拓展练习5’ 1. 让学生回忆一般过去时态。 2. 对照一般现在时和一般过去时,找出差异。 3. 总结 “be”动词的变化。 1. 回忆 2. 讨论 3. 总结 媒体显示 Step 7 Homework Practise the dialogue And answer some questions about the lesson.       Period Three (pp34-35)   教学步骤、时间   教师活动   学生活动  媒体应用 Step 1 Free talk (2’) 1. Ask the Ss some question. 2. check some questions. Put up hands and answer.   Step 2 Presention (10’) (问班里的学生) 1. what did you do over the weekend? 2. 昨天你做了什么?↓引出   What did you do yesterday? ---A played….(板书/学习) 3. Let the Ss look at the screen.   There are four pictures on the screen. These things that Sally and Jim did yesterday, then match. 4. Give the right answers. 1b, 2b, 3a, 4c   5. look at the 1b, let the Ss draw happy faces or unhappy faces. 6. listen to the taps twice, first listen carefully, then let the Ss to listen carefully and write the right answers. Answer one by one     Translate it into English             Look at the screen carefully and match the words with the pictures.   Listen to the tape carefully. Write the right answers.   媒体显示4幅画                         媒体显示 Step 3 Practice(5’) 1. Have a conversation to tell what Sally and Jim do? 2. What did Jim do?   Jim went to the movies. 3. Let the Ss ask freely 4. Ask: What did the Ss do over the weekend? ex: practice The students practice in pairs       Act out in pairs or groups. Answer the teacher’s questions Ask some pairs to the front to act out.   Step 4 Summary 3’ Phrases: played the guitar. Did my homework. Studied geography. Went to the library. What did Jim do yesterday? Read and remember.   Step 5 Test 1 见题后组1 D o some exercises. 多媒体展示 Step 6 consolidation Divide the students into several groups And let them make dialogues using these sentences: What did you do yesterday? How was your weekend? What did you do over the weekend? Write the dialogues and practice in groups.   Step 7 拓展显示 根据下列句子: 1. What did you do over the weekend? 2. How was your weekend? 考虑“昨天或周末你去了哪里?”用英语怎样表达? 1. look at some sentences and think it over. 2. 讨论/交流 3.总结 媒体展示 Step 8 Homework Grasp the new words and expression sentences.  

七年级新目标英语教案【篇3】

【教材分析】

本模块以出行旅游为话题。对话是通过读地图来呈现指路及表明具体位置的语言表达方式。通过本单元的听说活动,给学生提供充足的体验和运用语言的机会。

【学情分析】

学生具有一定的英语基础,学习热情高,表现欲强,能积极参与到课堂中。而且相互之间能够很好地利用小组进行合作交流。

【教学目标】

Knowledge objective:

To master some words and expressions about places, positions and giving directions.Ability objective:

1.To ask the way and give directions.2.To understand a conversation of giving directions.Moral objective:

1.To be polite to others.2.To be ready to help others.3.To know more about Beijing and love Beijing.【教学重点】

1.To learn some words and expressions about places:

Bank, museum, along, across, cross, opposite, tourist, excuse, excuse me, street ,turn, third, guidebook, bookshop, right, why not ?? could, underground

2.To learn and review some words about positions: near,opposite, along, on the left/right, across.3.To learn some expressions about asking ways and giving directions:

【教学难点】

1.To get information from the conversation.2.To ask the way and give directions.【教学方法】

PWP method, task-based method and interactive approach.【教学手段】

A tape recorder, multimedia ,PPT courseware, the teaching CD and some pictures.【教学过程】 Teaching Procedures:

Step 1 Revision【复习】

1、listen to an English song.Aim : to activate the classroom atmosphere.2、Do a duty :

Aim :To give one student a chance to train his spoken Englishin every class.3、Talking and acting:

Aim :to check if the students can practice the topic of the last

module and to develop the students’speaking and language expressing abilities.Step 2 Leading in

【导入】

1、Play a guessing game: The teachers shows the pictures ofnew words and let the students say as quickly as possible.Ai : to check if the students preview the new lesson before the class and to be familiar with them.2、Look, think and say: the teacher shows some pictures aboutgiving directions and some road signs and asks the students to think and say the phrases.Aim :to consolidate the phrases about giving directions.3、Find and say.The teacher shows pictures of direction prepositions, and the students find the right words and make some sentences with the direction prepositons.Aim : to understand and master the usage of the directionprepositions.【总结】

1.Do some exercises about the direction prepositions。2.Do some exercises about the patterns of asking for and giving directions.

七年级新目标英语教案【篇4】

No. 110 Middle School of Chongqing By Cao Yi

Unit 6 Where are the jazz CDs?

单元整体说明

单元教材分析

本单元的核心内容是用英语问路及谈论爱好,因此本单元的主要交际功能项目为“asking for and giving directions”and“talking about favorites,’本单元通过在音乐节Music Festivals)上问路,让学生在问路与指路的同时,又掌握了本单元中出现的音乐名词(Names of musical styles, such as jazz, pop, country)。在Section A中的3 ,4和1a,lb,2a,2b,2c为谈论自己的爱好,学生可当堂表演。

单元知识结构

词汇

名词:jazz, pop, country,dance, video, floor,!!section, group,singer, sound,fan,are, direction, culture, palace, hall, painting, gate

形容词: classical, traditional, amazing, awful, bad, western

副词: upstairs

词组:not bad,and so on

句型:

1 Where’s the pop music?

Go upstairs and turn right.It's next to the jazz.

2 What's your favorite kind of music, Judy?

My favorite kind of music is...

语法:

1. Where are the jazz CDs?

Go upstairs /Go straight and turn right /left.

They are between the pop and the country

2 The use of the sentences structures.

单元整体目标

1.Master the vocabulary.

2.Master and use:Where are the country CDs?

Go upstairs /Go straight and turn right /left.

They are between …and …/next to… behind …

单元教学重难点一览

重点 难点

I The vocabulary.

2 The Grammar. 1 Asking for and giving directions.

2 Talking about favorite.

单元学情分析

本单元与前几个单元的学习自然衔接,继续学习询问和指点方向,而且与学生愿意接触的“音乐“有关,很大程度上能调动学生的学习积极性。

单元教学建议

听、说、读、写全面训练,在说写的基础上,充分借助听力材料和补充阅读材料,训练学生的听力阅读水平。

a口语训练:本单元的口语活动主要是询问和指点方向及谈论爱好,教学时可以将学生分组设置情景〔例如问学校里的某个地方,最喜欢的歌等)展开训练。

b阅读训练:教师要求学生在阅读完SelfCheck中的3后,除了可以在地图上找出正确的地点外,还要培养学生猜测个别生词词义的能力。

c写的训练:写是检查学生英语水平的重要手段,写的训练要在听、说、读训练的基础上进行,任务型的写的训练有助于培养学生综合运用英语解决实际问题的能力。设计如“目标调查”这样的练习,把听、说、读与写的训练结合起来。

第一步,要求学生写几句话,谈谈他们喜欢的歌曲类型,歌手及歌曲。例如:

My favorite kind of music is country, and The Smith Family is my favorite group …

第二步,小组活动。

1提问:一个学生向另一个学生提问,了解对方的爱好。例如:

A:What’s your favorite kind of music?

B:My favorite kind of music is country.

A:Who’s your favorite country group?

B:My favorite group is The Smith Family.

A:……

2朗读:学生朗读自己的爱好。

单元课时分配

本单元4课时:

Section A(一)1课时

Section A(二)1课时

Section B(一)1课时

Section B(二)1课时

Section A(一)

教学内容

Section A中la.lb.lc.2a.2b.2c Grammar focus

教学目标

知识与能力

1、Match the vocabulary: jazz,classical,dance, pop,country, upstairs,video,floor, section,

2、Master and use:Where’s the jazz music?

Go straight /upstairs and turn left/right.It' s next to…/behind... /between…and…

过程与方法

学生在前几个单元已经学会了询问和指点方向,能自然地与本课知识相连接。通过“Where’s the jazz music?”引入创设情景,引起学生的兴趣。并借助媒体来调动学生的积极性。

情感态度价值观

明确相关音乐分类的英文表达法,巩固方位感的表达方式。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

1、The vocabulary

2、language points:

Where’s the jazz music?

Go straight /upstairs and turn left /right. It’s next to … / behind …/between…and …

难点

1 Asking for and giving directions

2 Kind- of music

教学突破

1对于本课的单词短语通过卡片、实物来强化记忆。

2 Language points的学习,借助于Where is……?的练习和课件的图画来使其形象化。

教学准备

教师准备

录音机、磁带、课件、光碟

学生准备

1、预习生词和课文。

2、带自己最喜欢的光碟或歌曲带。

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师时间 学生活动 媒体应用

Step 1

Organization (1’) Organize Ss by greeting each other. Greetings

Step 2

Free talk (2’) Ask the student

1. “who is on duty?”

If there’s a student who doesn’t come, then ask.

2. “Is everyone here?”

3. “Where is he/she?”

4. “Why he/she isn’t here today?” The student who is on duty answer.

Step

Presentation 20’ 1. Ask eight Ss to come to the front of the room and stand in two rows, leaving a few feet between Ss. Let the other Ss ask and answer questions about “Where is …? “He is between…and…”

“Where is…?” “She is behind…?/next to…”

2. Tell the Ss “Do as I told you”.(point to a student) “Wang Ming, go straight/go ahead, and then turn left, then turn right.” Let the Ss follow the directions. 学生模仿练习(impairs)

并表演

“Where is …” “He is between … and …”

“Where is …”

“She is behind …/ next to …

学生模仿表演(in pairs)

A student do as the other student told him/her.

go straight/go ahead, and then turn left, then turn right.”

3. Let the Ss practice in pairs using the CDs they have brought.

Such as one student ask “Which kind of music do you like best?”

Let the other Ss answer.

“Jazz or Country or Dance or pop or classical music.”

4. Let the Ss look at the Section A (la)

Ask the Ss to tell what they see.

Guide Ss to understand that the pictures shows different types of music. (Point: teach the new word “upstairs” with a picture.

At the same time, can teach “downstairs”)

5. Ask Ss to match each picture with one of the words on the left. Say “Write the letter of each picture. next to the words on the left”. Point out the sample answer.

Check the answer. (Answers: 1b, 2c, 3d, 4e, 5a)

6. (For 1b) Draw a set of stairs on the board. At the top of the stairs, write “jazz” in a box at the eight.

Write the three conversations on the Bb, then read it as you use your fingers to “walk” up the stairs and turn left to the “jazz” section. Then ask various Ss to come to the front of the Bb to read the other conversations, at the same time, use their fingers to walk to each section mentioned.

Play the recording the first time.

Play the recording the second time. This time, ask the Ss to listen to the recording and write the number of each conversation in the correct box. Point out the Sample answer.

Correct the answers.

(Answers: From left to right: 3, 2, 1)

7. (1c, Pair work)

Point to the conversations in 1b and ask Ss to read after you.

Use the stairs you drew on the board earlier. Erase the words you wrote before and write in the words “country” and “pop” to the left of the stairs, “dance” straight ahead of the stairs and “jazz” and “classical” to the right of the stairs.

8 (For 2a)

Ask four Ss to come to the front of the classroom. Arrange the Ss so that one is in the middle and the others are to the left of, to the right of, and behind the first student. Then describe the location of the Ss using the words “behind, next to and between”. For example, “Li Peng is behind Zhou Wen. Cao Ying is next Zhou Wen is between Cao Ying and Cong Zheng.”

Letn the Ss look at the pictures. Ask Ss to tell what they see in each picture.

Ask Ss to match each numbered sentence with one of the pictures. Say “Write the letter of each picture next to the correct sentence.

Check the answers. 小组表演

One student ask “Which kind of music do you like best?” Let the other Ss answer “Jazz or Country or Dance or pop or classical music”

到黑板前表演,并用手指按照所说的指引方向。

“Where’s the dance music?”

“Go straight and turn left.”

“Where’s the classical music?”

“Go upstairs and turn right.”

Ss listen to the tape carefully

Ask Ss to match each numbered sentence with one of the pictures 多媒体放映图一

录音机

(The answers are 1a, 2c, 3b)

9 (For 2b)

First, tell the Ss that suppose they are clerks of a music store, if someone asks them the directions, what they should do?

Notices

注意CDs和 videos 中的s 发的[z] 解说在以元音或浊辅音([z], [v], [dv]除外)结尾的名词后读[z]。

例如:play [pleiz], doogs [z].

10 Ask Ss to work in pairs. Suppose one student is a clerk of a music store, the other is asking him/her for different kinds of CDs, show her the Ss listen to the tape carefully and label the map of the CD store Ss write them down

分角色扮演

directions by looking.

At the map at Page 36, 2b.

Step 4

Practice (6’) Pairwork

Practice the conversations by looking at the screen and pictures on the Bb, ask and answer questions about other places in the pictures. Ss practice the dialogue in pairs “Where’s the pop music?” “It’s …” 多媒体放映 2a, 2b

Step 5

Just for fun (5’) 1. Ask all Ss to read the conversation. Have Ss identify the two characters in the cartoon.

2. Ask pairs of Ss to present the dialogue to the rest of the class.

3. Ask Ss to play both roles.

Work in pairs

Step6

Summary (2) 1. Summary the language points of this lesson.

2. Words and phrases of this class.

3. Language points.

Step 7

Test (4’) 同“练习设计 Do it by themselves.

Step 8

Consolidtion (4’) 1. Let’s Ss keep the Grammar Focus in their hearts.

2. Ss practice the Grammar Focus in pairs by looking at the pictures on the Bb.

Practice in pairs.

Homework (1’) Practice the dialogues according to the pictures on Page 35 and 36

本课小结

本节课学习了10个生词,和?句式的练习运用及学习了。通过本节课的学习,学生能熟练的用英语询问和指点方向,也能用英语说出不同类型的音乐。

问题探究与拓展活动

本节课主要学习问路、指路和各种类型的音乐。学生掌握后,可以问学生如果别人问路而他不知道时该如何办?本课的拓展活动为Shelf - Check中的Just for fun,同时增进本课所学。如:

When’s the pop music/dance music?

Where are the country CDs/jazz CDs?

I don’t know! You don't? No, I don’t. I don't work here.

练习设计

随堂练习设计

按要求做题

downstairs(反义词) videos,

将下列词组翻译成英语。

在…的旁边 在…和…之间 上楼 下楼

一直往前走 向右转 爵士音乐 古典音乐

个性练习设计

翻译下列句子:

1、流行乐在哪里?上楼后向右转。在舞曲的旁边

2、舞曲在哪里?上楼后一直往前走。它在流行乐和乡村乐的旁边。

3. 乡村乐碟在哪里?他们在舞曲碟的旁边

4. 爵士乐碟在哪里?它们在乡村乐的旁边。

板书设计

Unit 6 Where um the jam CDs?

1, Where’s the pop music? go straight

Go upstairs and turn right. go upstairs-go downstairs

It’s next to the dance music. pop music

2,Where are the country CDs? Between …and …

They are behind the jazz CDs.turn right/left

Section A(二)

教学内容

Section A中3,4以及Self check中1,2两部分

教学目标

知识与能力

1. Match the vocabulary : group, singer

2. Master and use:What’s yaw favorite kind of music?

My favorite kind of music is country.

过程与方法

通过“What’s Bob’s favorite kind of music?”引入创设情景,引起学生的兴趣。并借助多媒体来提高学生的主动性,让其大量练习。

情感态度价值观

在上节课的基础上,对于音乐分类的表达和指点位置更加熟练,运用自如。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

1. The vocabulary.

2. language points: What's your favorite kind of music?

My favorite kind of music is country.

Who's your favorite group?

My favorite group is The Smith Family.

难点

The language points

教学突破

在摹仿的基础上逐渐能用单词替换的方式熟记表达法。

教学准备

教师准备

录音机、磁带、课件、光碟

学生准备

预习生词和课文。

将自己最喜欢的歌手或乐队列出,并将其歌曲分类。

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用

Step 1

Organization(1’) Organize Ss by greeting each other.

Step 2

Free talk (2’) Ask the students

1. “Who is on duty?”

If there’s a student who doesn’t come, then ask

2. “Is everyone here?”

3. “Where is he /she?”

4. “Why he/she isn’t here today?” Answer.

Step 3

Revision (5’) 1. Draw a set of stairs on the Bb, at the top of the stairs, write “dance” in a box, and “pop” in a box in its right, and “country” on its left, behind the pop box write “jazz”, and behind the country box write “classical”

2. 2. Let the Ss works in pairs, practice the dialogues by looking at the picture. Ss work in pairs

1. “Where’s the pop music?” “Go upstairs and turn right. It’s next to the dance music.”

2. “Where’s the jazz music?” “Go straight and turn left. It’s …

3. …4. …

Step 4

Presentation (15’) 1.处是些听风的一张图片,问学生 “Who is he?”

Let the Ss answer. Then say: “Yes, you’re right, he is xie tingfeng.”

Ask a student “What is he? /What does he do?” (student can answer in Chinese.)

“Yes, he is a singer.” Teach the word ‘singer’.(sing-singer)

2. 让学生无人一组谈论

“Who is your favorite singer?”

“Who is your favorite group?”

“What’s your favorite kind of music?”

Let the Ss write their answers in the chart on the book (SectionA, 4)

3. Ask a student the other four’s favorite singer/goup/kind of music. eg, ask Wang Ping:

“Who is Li Ming’s favorite singer/group?”

“What’s Li Ming’s favorite kind of music?”

4. Let the Ss work in pairs. Ask the other three Ss in their group their favorite singer/group/kind of music.

5. Let a student describe the musical tasts of the other Ss in thir groups. Such as: Liu Fang’s favorite kind of music is dance, and his favorite singer is Sun Yue.

6. Tell the Ss “If I’m student A, if I want to know what Bob’s favorite kind of music is, what should I ask?” “Yes, I should ask ‘What’s favorite kind of music?’”

7. Ask the pairs to continue on their own.

Move around the room monitoring the progress of the pairs.

8. Go over the answers.

The answer are:

Bob: classical The Boston Orchestra

Carla: jazz Boys from Brzil

Mary: dance Patsy Street

Joe: country The Smith Family

Ss answer: ‘He is Xie Tingfeng.”

Answer my question in Chinese or English

Ss work in group of

five.

“Who is your favorite singer?”

“Who is your favorite group?”

“What’s your favorite kind of music?”

Ask the other’s favorite singer/group/kind of music Work in groups.

Ss describe the musical tastes of the other Ss in their group.

Ss listen carefully

Work in pairs

Student A in each pair look at the chart on Page 37. Student B look at e the chart on Page92

Ask and answer

“What’s Bob’s/Carla’s/Mary’s/Joe’s favorite kind of music?” and so on. 多媒体放映

Step5

Consolidation(6’) Give Ss five minutes to consolidate the language points by practicing the dialogues which this class have learned in pairs. Work in pairs.

Step 6

Summary

(2’) Summa the language points of this lesson.

Show the teaching aims. Ss read after the teacher. 多媒体放映

Step 7

Test(8’) Self Check1, 2.

Ask Ss to check all the words they know.

Ask Ss to find out the meaning of any words they don’t know. They can do this by reviewing to unit, asking the teacher, asking their classmates, or using dictionaries.

Ask Ss to write five new words in their Vocabulary on Page 106.

After Ss to have recorded their new words, ask to have recorded their new words, ask them to share their lists with other Ss.

2. 同练习设计 Check all the words they know.

Find out the meaning of any words they don’t know.

Work in groups.

Homework

(1’) 1 Practice the dialogue in pairs after class.

“What ‘s your favorite kind of music?”

“Who’s your favorite singer/group?”

2 预习Section B 中的1a, 1b, 2a, 2b, 2c.

本课小结

本节学习了2个生词和What's your favorite kind of music?及Who's Bob's favorit group/singer句式的练习和运用。通过本节课的学习,学生能熟练地用英语谈论自〔喜欢的歌词和乐队。

教学探讨与反思

教师通过展示明星卡片,来引起学生的兴趣,通过对自己喜欢的歌手和乐队的谈论,(例如小组谈论”Who is your favorite singer?’’“Who is your favorite group?’

“What's your favorite kind of music?’),引导学生联系实际,谈论一下当前国内-些较为流行的音乐,歌手及乐队等.

练习设计

(A类学生全做,B类学生只做1)

1按要求变换下列句子。

(1) My favorite kind of music is country.(划线提问)

(2) Bob’s favorite group is the Smith Family.(划线提问)

(3 ) My mother's favorite singer is Cheng Long.(划线提问)

2在横线上填上适当的介词

(1) Please look ______this page.

(2) Work ______small groups. Ask your classmates ______ their favorite groups or singers.

(3) Where's the pop music?It's next ________ the dance music.

(4) What's your favorite kind ______ music?

板书设计

Unit 6 Where are the jazz CDs

1 What’s Bob’s favorite kind of music? sing-singer

His favorite kind of music is … in small groups

2. Who’s Carla’s favorite group? Look at

Her favorite group is …

教学内容

Section B中1a, 1b, 2a, 2b, 2c

教学目标

知识能力

1. Master the vocabulary: amazing awful bad Latin sound

2. Can talk about singers or musical groups

过程与方法

学生在本单元Section A中已学过不同风格的音乐如;jazz music, dance music, classical music等,已具备了学习本课的初步知识,课前通过放不同风格的乐曲录音来导人新课,让学生通过听录音后的感受,来谈论他们喜欢的歌手或乐队。

情感态度价值观

教育学生学会欣赏不同风格的音乐,陶冶他们的情操。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

1 The vocabulary

2 Language:Talk about singer or musical groups

难点

Talk about singers or musical groups

教学突破

1. 本课学习的单词主要是一些表示感情色彩的形容词,可通过丰富的表情演示来学习

2. Language放音乐录音,让学生边听边谈

教学准备

教师准备

录音机、磁带(不同风格的音乐磁带)课件

学生准备

预习生词,收集自己喜欢的歌手或乐队的资料

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用

Step l

Organization

(1’) Organize Ss by greeting each other

Step 2

Free talk(2}) Ask the student:

1 “Who is on duty?”

2 “What’s your favorite kind of music?”

3“Who’s your favorite singer/ group?” The student talk about something

Step3

Presentation

(15') la:

1.Focus attention on the three faces:

Guide students to understand the meanings of the three faces: the snide face means“I like it”.The middle face with no smile means “I don’t like it or dislike it“. The frown face means ”I don’t like it“ 读单词并根据单词意思做出不同的表情

2.Then call attention to the list of words. Say each one and ask student's to repeat then talk about what it means.

(借助面部表情及声音来解释单词并让学生根据不同的单词做出不同的表情)

3.Ask students to draw the correct face on the line to each word. Draw the correct face

on the line.

1b:

1.Play a piece of dance music let students listen then ask them:Do you like the dance music?

Guide the students to answer:

”Yes,I do. It’s awful.” Then play another type of music, such as classical, jazz, country and so on

2.Ask each student to make a list of three singers or musical groups then ask them to work on pairs:

A: Do you like the Latin Sound?

B:No,I don’t.They’re awful.

C:Do you like?

D: Yes,I do.No, I don’t.

2a:

1.Let the Ss look at the chart and the pictures of the four students,tell them they will listen to recording of these four persons.Write the name

of each person’s favorite kind of music/favorite groups/singer and Description word in the blank under their photo,Then play the recording the first time, Ss only listen

2. Play the recording again.This time students listen and write their answers in the chart. Listen the music and

answer the question.

Make a list

Work in pairs

Do you like?

Yes …

No, ….

Listen to the cording

Listen and write.

Look at the chart.

Listen and complete

the chart.

2b Play the

tape

录音机

录音机

1. let Ss look at the chart on the right, tell them that we will listen the recording again. listen and complete the chart.

2. Play the tape,students write the favorite group or singer and the description words in the chart.

Step 4

Practice

(5’) 2c:

Tell the students: This activity we will work in pain,you are Mike and your deskmate is Judy. Have a conversation about music like 2b. Talk about the music in pairs

Step 5

Summary

(2') 1.Words and phrases of this class

2. Language points talk about singers and musical groups. Talk about the music in pairs

Step 6

Consolidation

(8') Show the pictures of Tian Zhen, Na Ying.,Sun Nan,Beyound group,Yuquan and play their music,

let the students talk about them. Look, listen and talk 课件

(二)

Step 7

Homework(1’) 1.预习Section B中句3a,3b,3c

2画张学校的平面图

本课小结

本节课学习了5个生词和Do you like? What's your favorite句式的练习和运用。通过本节课的学习,学生能更加熟练地用英语谈论自己喜欢的歌词和乐队。

教学探讨与反思

通过对国外某些歌手和乐队(Who’s your favorite singer/group?What’s your favorite kind of music?)的谈论,引导学生联系实际,谈论一下当前国内一些较为流行的音乐,歌手及乐队等.

练习设计

(见课件Test)

板书设计

Unit 6. Where are the jazz CDs?

1 amazing, awful,bad, 3 Do you like The Latin

great sound,terrible, No,I don’t.They’re awful /fantastic

2 What' your favorite... 4 Do you like Livinia Casey?

My favorite…is… Yes,I do.She's cool.

Section B(二)

教学内容

Section B中3a,3b,3c,4和Self Check中3.

教学目标

知识与能力

1. The words(three skills): direction,culture, palace, area,western,eastern,hall,traditional,and,painting, by, and so on,gate

2. Master: How to give directions to the places that people ask you.

过程与方法

学生在第一课时就已经学会指引方向,已具备了学习本课的知识,这是第一课时的进一步学习。通过询问学生其学校所在地来引人创设情景,让学生有身临其境之感。需大量练习口头表达,同时提高学生的英语阅读能力。

情感态度价值观

正确表达各种情绪:

喜欢,不喜欢等等。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

1 The vocabulary

2 How to give directions

难点

How to give directions.

教学突破

1、对于生词学生只要会读、说、听就可以了,学生通过查阅字典或问老师或问同伴来自己解决,提高学生的自学能力。

2、对于方向的指引,通过大量的练习和课件的图画来突破解决。

教学准备

教师准备

课件

学生准备

预习生词和课文。

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用

Step 1

Organization

(1’) Organize Ss by greeting each other.

Step 2

Free talk

(2') Ask the students:

1.“Who is on duty?”

2.“What's your favorite kind of music?”

3. “Who’s your favorite singer / group?” Students answer my questions

Step3

Presentation

(15’) 1.“Now,pop music fans,listen carefully,if you,here”.(Start with a circle and label it.“You are here“)

Read the first set of instructions,draw a map of the pop store.

For example,when you read the words “Go straight’,draw an arrow straight up.

When you read the words “Turn left at the classical music’,

draw a box and label it‘classical music’,Then continue your first arrow around this box to the left.

Let Ss draw a map on the exercises books.

At the same time,let the other Ss look at the country music section, draw a map.in groups of four.

Let Ss work in groups of four,check the accuracy of the map by reading the instructions as their fingers through the map.

2.(3b),First,let the Ss look at the Big Sound music store map Point to each section of the store and ask Ss to read all the labels on the drawing.

Then ask Ss to fill in the missing words by themselves.

(As Ss work,the teacher can move around the room monitoring progress and answering any questions they may have.)The third,ask the Ss to check each other' s

won,and the teacher check the answers Pop music fans draw a map on their Exs books.

Draw maps

Ss work in groups of four.

Ss use their fingers to trace the path.

to the classical music section. 多媒体

投影地

3,Let the Ss write directions to the jazz/dance/country/pop sections. They can use the same kind of sentences.(As Ss work,the teacher can move around the mom monitoring progress and answering any questions they may have.)Ask Ss to check each other's work.Then

check the answers. Write directions 多媒体

投影地

图多媒

体投影

Step 4

Practice

(7’) From each group to be the first to give directions to be a location somewhere in the school.Tell the students that the first student to correctly guess the answer takes the next turn.

Self check(3a)

1.Let the students read the article by themselves.Find out the words that don't know list it. They can learn them by looking them up the directions or asking the teacher or the classmates or looking at the books.

2.Let the students read the words they don’t know after the teacher. Summa, the language points of this unit.

(见小结)

见练习设计。 Work in groups

Ss do the activity 多媒体

投影学

校平面

本课小结

本节课还是主要练习了问路与指路,同时在selfcheck中接触到了一些生词,学生只要做到会听、说就可以了。

问题探究与拓展活动

本节课中,可以让学生在知道west一western,east ---eastern的同时,自己找出表示方向的名词转换为形容词时在其后面直接加ern就可以了。(例如south一southern, north一northern, southeast一southeastern northeast一northeastern,…等等。)并出训练题,如个性练习。

练习设计

随堂练习设计

用适当的介词填空:

1.Direction _____ the Country Music section.

2.Turn left _____ the classical music

3.Pop music is _____ jazz and dance.

4.Look _____ the Big Sound music store map.Then fill ______ the blanks.

5.The classical music is next ______ the country music.

6. Welcome ________ the Culture Palace.

7.You can listen _______ classical music ______ Area E.

8.There you can see the traditional paintings ______ Qi Baishi.

个性练习设计

用所给词的适当形式填空。

1.We have a _______ (west) section,the left,and on ______ (east)section on the right.

2.a _______ (northeast)wind(东北风)

A _________(southeast)wind(东南风)

3.the _______ States of the U.S.A.(south)(美国南部各州)

4.The _______ (north)States of the U.S.A

注:解说表示方向的n.+ern就成了形容词

板书设计

Unit 6.Where are the jazz CDs?

Go straight west一western

Turn left at the east一eastern

pop section. south一southern

The classical music is north一northern

next to the country southeast一southeastern

music northwest一northwestern

教学探讨与反思

在本单元的教学中,多数学生能按照老师的要求掌握好大纲的内容,而且本单元的内容与学生的生活息息相关,在现实生活中经常遇到,也经常谈论。通过小组练习、讨论,练习“Where’s the jazz music?” “It's …”. ”What’s your favorite kind of music?”“It’s …” “Who's your favorite singer?……多数学生掌握得相当好。但是学生的自主学习能力尚待提高。

七年级新目标英语教案【篇5】

新目标英语七年级上册Unit5第一课时教学反思

康川学校

卢光萍

本节课重点学习的语法是do 和 does 引导的一般疑问句以及它们的回答方式,与此同时学习与运动有关的一些词汇。在本节课我运用不同形式鼓励学生使用目标语言,在任务中体现学生的主体地位。在过程中学生可能出现一些错误,本人就以积极的态度对待他们,愉快的氛围对学生的学习有很大的积极影响力。首先要调动学生的学习兴趣和积极性,我努力在这方面去做,不足的请各位多提宝贵意见。学生的信息交流要在特定的环境中进行,给他们参与的机会。任务的完成不是语言学习的结束,而是另一个高度的开端。加强学生语言的实践是改革的关键,要给学生机会去说、去做、去思考。一篇好的教学设计应争取在课堂中得到更好的效果。自己教学的一节课,回顾反思一下自己在执教时的切身体会或疏漏,想一想学生上课时的闪光点或困惑,从而积累教学经验和吸取教训,不断地改进课堂教学和提高自己的教学水平。非常感谢学校给我这次好的网络学习机会,真是受益匪浅,在今后的教学过程当中,我会借着这次机会所学到的知识不断地提高自己的业务水平。

七年级新目标英语教案【篇6】

一.教学目标:本单元主要学习日期的表达方式。通过围绕生日进行互相问答式的讨论,掌握英语表达年、月、日的单词和句型,能够熟练地谈论各种有关日期的话题,询问表达年龄的句型。可以询问节日的表达法。

二.语言目标:掌握以下句型

1.When is your birthday ? My birthday is November 11th .

2.How old are you ? I’m thirteen years old .

3.What events do you have at your school ?

We have an Art Festival each year .

4.Do you have a pop concert ?Sorry ,I don’t know .

5.When is the school trip ? It’s in April .

6.When were you born ? I was born in ….

三.学习策略:

角色扮演

自我评价

四.课时安排:

课时1: p47-p48 2c

课时2: p482d-p49

课时3: p50 Section B-p51 3b

课时4: p51 (4) groupwork-p52 selfcheck

五.教学步骤:

Period One

1. Showing the students a large calendar.

Teaching the words : when , January , February , March , April , May , June , July , August , September ,October , November , December.. birthday.

2. T: When is your birthday ?

S1: My birthday is -----

T: When is his /her birthday ?

S2: His /Her birthday is ----

Teaching : first , second , third , fourth , fifth , sixth , seventh , eighth , ninth , tenth , … , twentieth , thirtieth,twenty-first -----

3. Training the ordinal numbers together .

4. Listening to the tape recorder of 1a . The students try to remember the words of the months .

5. Listening to 2b conversations and number them 1-3.

6. Pairwork : Practise the conversations “When is your/his /her birthday ?” “…”

7. 2a. Listen to the recorder several times and repeat them.

8. Ss try to find the rule of the ordinal numbers and the teacher writes them on the Bb.

9. 2b,2c : Listen and match the names , months , days.

10. Homework: Workbook , Copy new words and setences.

Period Two

1. Duty report,

Review words of the months and the ordinal numbers .

2. T: When is your birthday ?---When were you born ?

S: My birthday is …. ---I was born in /on …

3. Help the students to learn the festivals of the year .

The students discuss them while the teacher write some of them on the Bb .

4. Pairs work : Practise “ When is your birthday ? / When were you born ? ’ How old are you ?…

5. 3a : Point out the conversations and read with students , practise“How old are you ?”

Point to the three ID cards ask questions about them .

6. 3b: Pairwork

First students make their own ID cards . Then pairs ask and answer.

7. Dictate the sentences .

8. Homework : Workbook , 评价手册 ,让学生制作家人生日卡。

9. If there is time , the whole class play games about birthday , age , name one by one.

Period Three

1. Let the students say out their family members’ names, birthdays , ages ,

2. Section B

Match the pictures and the events :

1. speech contest d

2. party c

3. school trip b

4. basketball game a

Teaching new words : speech , contest , party , school trip , basketball games , event, art , festival , pop , concert , chorus , lecture , music .

3. Listen and check the events above 1.

4. 2b : Listen again , fill in Joe’s calendar

Write 2b conversation on the Bb . Point to the calendar and show the September and October dates . Students listen to the recorder several times

And fill in Joe’s calendar

5. 2c : Ask two students to read the conversation to the class .

Students pairs do .

6. 3a Pair work

Ask students to do in pairs . Look at p51 3a and p97 , complete the schedule .

7. 3b : Practise the dialogue like the model : School Days , Art Festivals , Chorus Competition , Lecture , English Party .

Yes No I don’t

Know Month Do you like it?

School Day

Art Festival

Chorus

Competition

Lecture

Music Festival

English Party

8. Ask the students in small groups .

9. Ask the students to read the lists to the class .

10. Let the students copy these in their notebook .

11. Homework .

Period Four

1. P51 4 Group work : Write five things about yourself on a piece of paper . Another student will read to the class .

2. Have the students guess who the student is .

3. Self check

1.) Students remember the words

2.) Dictate the words

4. Write the words in the vocabulary builder by the students themselves .

5. Show the pictures of the famous people . Help the students to find their names and their birthdays

6. Home work : Students writing something about themselves including their names , ages , birthdays , the school events etc. .

七年级新目标英语教案【篇7】

新目标英语七年级上册Unit5SectionA(1a-2c)教学设计

一、教材分析

1、教学内容

1)、词汇:do, have,tennis, ball,ping-pong ball, bat, soccer ball, volleyball, basketball, volleyball.2)、语言结构:A、Do you have a ping-pong ball?Yes,I do.Do you have a ping-pong bat?Not,I do not。Does she/he have a pen?Yes,she/he does

2、教材的地位及其作用

本单元的教学主要内容是:学习have的一般现在时的疑问式的肯定和否定回答,该话题与学生的日常生活紧密联系在一起,容易唤起学生的学习兴趣,这对于提高学生的综合能力很有帮助,特别是说的能力。

本单元仍在继续学习一般现在时,这是一个生活中离不开的时态,也是最基本的一个时态。新课程标准要求学生重点掌握一般现在时,这在英语中使用频率很高,学好这一时态的用法对以后其他时态的学习和交际有很大的帮助。

二、学生分析

学生现有的能力与已掌握的知识:

学生在已经学过词汇:What is this in English? What is that in English?It’s…

句型: Where is…? It’s in / on / under/…

经过前面的学习学生已经积累了一定的词汇,掌握了一定的目标语言,已经具备了一定的听说读写能力。

三、教学目标

1、语言知识

词汇:A、重点掌握表示有关各种运动球类的名词, 如basketball, soccer ball,so on

重点句型:? Do you/they have a TV? Yes,I/they do./No,I/they don’t.Does he/she have a soccer ball? Yes,he/she does./No,he/she doesn’t.2、语言技能

1)、能看着图片说;Do you/they have a TV? Yes,I/they do./No,I/they don’t.Does he/she have a soccer ball? Yes,he/she does./No,he/she doesn’t.3、学习策略、1)利用教材SectionA1a,2b所提供的图片卡片做出简单的判断。

2)通过与同学交流,学会使用一般现在时的疑问形式及肯定和否定回答。

4、情感态度、价值观

1)通过各小组的对话练习培养学生的合作精神;

2)通过学习本单元Section A,教会学生之间互相有无的主要句式.重点难点

1、Have 的一般现在时的疑问式用法;

2、Have的一般现在时的疑问句,及其肯定,否定回答;

3、简单拓展主语第三人称单数的句型。

教学手段:采用最简单的卡片图片、课本以及肢体语言。理念与思路、教法

1)采用图片进行直观教学。

2)学生在课堂教学过程中口头训练应成为本单元教学的重点内容。

教学突破:Section A重在通过使用动词have对物品的所属进行提问和回答的交流式口语活动,学习由助动词do或does引导的一般疑问句的构成以及回答。教师要善于引导学生比较行为动词的疑问句和be动词的疑问句在构成和回答上的区别,通过大量和反复地操练以达到运用自如。

四、教学过程

第一教学环节:情景创设,导入新课

教师活动 学生活动

Section A主要内容是通过使用have对物品的所属进行提问和应答,来学会使用do和does引导的一般疑问句。所以在教学中可采取问答式导人法:

掌握新单词.采用各种方法学习单词。

1、升降语调、拼读的方式记忆单词。2.检查学生记忆单词的成效。

3、学生看1a的图片,使字母和单词相对应。第二教学环节;老师和学生互动:学习掌握重要内容。

教师活动 学生活动(看图片练句型)

1.分片进行演示:I have a footba11.Do I have a football? 自己回答:Yes,I d0.再问:Do I have a basketball? 自己回答:No,I don’t.再使用其它物体和图片询问学生:Do I have…? 询问学生:Do you have…? 询问学生:…? 询问学生:Do they have…? 在学生充分掌握的第一,第二人称和第三人称 的复数。

2.学生回答:Yes,you do.No,you don’t.学生回答:Yes,I do.No,I don’t.学生回答:Yes,he/she does.No,he/she doesn’t.学生回答:Yes, they do.No,they don’t.掌握它的肯定和否定回答。

3、要求学生完成1b的听力,完成任务。

4.引导学生展开Pair work活动,完成l c部分口语交际的教学任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答,可采用师生互动带动学生互动的交流方式:

5.Pair work活动,完成l c部分口语交际的学习任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答并上台展示口语交际。

第三教学环节:合作交流,巩固提高

教师活动 学生活动

1、学生巩固练习活动,完成课堂练习和总结及笔头练习的教学任务。

2、让总结本课的 主要内容,如果不周到,教师可以补充完成。

3、习题练习,巩固课堂。问题探究与拓展活动

动词的第三人称单数形式:当句子的主语是“第三人称单数”时,即:不是I,不是you的其它单数形式时,谓语动词必须改变形式,也就是在词尾加-s或-es(同名词的复数形式),我们可以简称为“三单形式”。有些动词的变化是特殊的,如:have的三单形式是has。在构成否定句时。要在动词前加助动词don’t或doesn’t;在构成疑问句时,则要在主语前加上助动词do或does,does/doesn’t是do/don’t的第三人称单数形式。助动词后应该用动词的原型。

五、教学反思:

本单元重点学习的语法是do 和 does 引导的一般疑问句以及它们的回答方式,与此同时学习与运动有关的一些词汇。为此,在本单元我运用不同形式鼓励学生使用目标语言,在任务中体现学生的主体地位。在过程中学生可能出现一些不足,本人仍以积极的态度对待他们,逐渐地完善他们。愉快的氛围对学生的学习有很大的积极影响力。调动学生的学习兴趣和积极性至关重要,这方面,我正不断努力去做。

教无定法,教师不要为了任务活动而忽略了语言的传授。学生的信息交流要在特定的环境中进行,给他们参与的机会。任务的完成不是语言学习的结束,而是另一个高度的开端。加强学生语言的实践训练是改革的关键,要给学生机会去说、去做、去思考。

七年级新目标英语教案【篇8】

新目标英语七年级下册11-12单元教案

新目标英语七年级下册Unit 11: What do you think of game shows?   Language goals to this unit students learn to state their opinions and talk about likes and dislikes. New language What do you think of soap operas? I dont like soap operas. What does he think of sports shows? He loves sports shows. What does she think of Maria? She likes Maria. What do they think of Tommy? They cant stand Tommy. Section A Additional materials to bring to class: a local television listing list the names of several foods on the board.For example: pizza, broccoli, ice cream, mushrooms. Next to that list, write the sentence, What do you think of ___ ? and leave a blank at the end. Ask a student the question, substituting the word pizza: What do you think of pizza? Help him or her answer / like pizza ot I dont like pizza,  Point to the other foods one by one. Ask a student the question and help him or her answer J like...or I dont like.... Then point to the sentence. What do you think of ___ ? Point to a food name on the board and choose a student to ask the question: What do you think of (mushrooms)? Then point to a student to answer. Repeat the activity several times, giving several students chances to ask and answer the question. 1 a  This activity introduces the key vocabulary. Focus attention on the five TVs. Say, Each TV shows  different kind of TV show. In TV picture a, there is a an playing baseball. This is called a sports show. Talk about the other kinds of shows and ask students what they see. Tell the name of each kind of show as you discuss the picture. Ask students to repeat the names of the shows. Write the word sitcom on the board. Under it write the words situation comedy. Say, The word sitcom comes from the two words situation comedy. A sitcom is a funny show. The people in sitcoms do or say things that make TV watchers laugh. Point out the numbered list of shows. Say each one again and ask students to repeat it. Then ask students to match each TV picture with one of the words. Say, Write the letter of each kind of show next to the correct word. Point out the sample answer. 1 b  This activity gives students practice in understanding the target language in spoken conversation. Point to the smiley faces and the frowny faces and the words next to them. Read the words to the class or have a student do this. Say, These faces show you what the words mean. If you dont mind something, you dont either like it or dislike it. If you cant stand something, you dislike it very strongly. Your least favorite food is something you cant stand. If you love something, you like it very, very much. Your favorite food is something you love. Say, Now I will play a recording. Listen to what Mark says about the TV shows in la. Write the letter of the TV shows next to the words he uses. Play the recording the first time. Students only listen. Play the recording a second time. Point to the lettered pictures. Say, Each picture has a letter. Point out the blank spaces before the words. Say, Each word or phrase has a space in front of it. Listen to the tape and write the letter of a TV show picture in each blank. Point out the sample answer. Correct the answers. 1 c  This activity provides guided oral practice using the target language. Point to the pictures of TV shows in activity la and ask students to say the name of each kind of show. Point out the example conversation. Ask two students to read it to the class. Then ask the class to point to the picture of the sitcom. Say a dialogue with a student. Have the student ask ou a question. Then answer it truthfully. Point to the ppropriate picture as you answer. Say, Now work with a partner. Ask and answer the qstions. Have students work in pairs. As they talk, move round the room monitoring their work. Offer anguage or pronunciation support as needed. 2a  This activity provides listening practice using the target language. Call attention to the list of five words and expressions.Point out the blank in front of each one. Ask a student to read the list to the class. Say, The people on the recording are talking about TV shows. They use these words and phrases as they talk about the shows. You will number these words and phrases 1-5 in the order you hear them on the recording. Play the recording the first time. Students only listen. Point out the sample answer 1 in front of the word love. Say, The first word on the recording is love in the sentence I love it. So the answer in front o/love is number 1. Play the recording again. Ask students to write a number from 1 to 5 in front of each of the words and phrases. Check the answers. 2b  This activity provides more listening practice using the target language. Point out the dialogue with blanks. Read it to the class saying blank each time you come to a blank. Say, Listen to the recording again. This time/ill in each blank with a word or phrase from the list in 2a. Play the recording. Students write words in the blanks. Check the answers. 2c  This activity provides guided oral practice using the target language. Call attention to the dialogue students completed in activity 2b. Say, Read the dialogue with a partner. \ Help students find partners. Have the students practice the dialogue several times. Then say, Now talk about a TV show you both know.Tell what you like and dont like about the show and the people in it. As students work together, move around the room answering questions and offering language sup- sport as needed. Ask some pairs of students to present their dialogue!to the class. 3a This activity provides pral and writing practice using the target language. Call attention to the list of TV shows and ask a student to read the names to the class. Say, In this activity you ask each other questions about TV shows. Ask students to work in pairs. Ask student A in each pair to look at the chart on page 67. Ask student B to look at the chart on page 86. Remind students not to look at their partners pages. Say the first question and answer with a student. Pretend you are student A and work with a student partner.Say What does Stuart think of Sports News? Have student B look at the answer on his or her chart on page 86.Student B answers, Stuart loves Sports News. Show students that you are writing in the word loves after Stuarts name on the chart on page 67. Then say to your partner, Ask me about Stuart Student B asks, What does Stuart think of Sports News? You answer, Stuart likes Sports News. Have the student write the word likes after Stuarts name on the chart on page 86. Ask the pairs to continue on their own. Move around the room monitoring the progress of the pairs. Go over the answers. 3b This activity provides guided reading practice using the target language. Read the dialogue with a student. Every time one of you conies to a blank, say blank. Call attention to the chart students completed in activity 3a. Say, Use the words in this chart to fill in the blanks in the dialogue in activity 3b. 4  This activity provides listening, speaking, and writing practice using the target language. Read the instructions to the class. Then ask students to name some TV shows they know about. Write the list on the board. Try to include some that students like and some they dont like. Point out the dialogue in the speech bubbles. Have two students read it to the class. Then point out the sample answer in the chart. Say,This TV show is called Tell it like it is! I love it, and Lin Peng does, too. I write I love it under What I think and I write Lin Peng under Student who agrees with me. Say, Now go around the class. Ask students about TV shows you know. Find students who agree with you. After five minutes ask students to sit down. Then ask some students to read the information from their charts to the class. Ask students to make statements such as I dont like The Crime Files. Carlos doesnt like The Crime Files, too. Alternative: If you do not want st

七年级新目标英语教案【篇9】

Unit 1 Can you play the guitar ?】

1、can+动词原形,它不随主语和数而变化。

(1)含有can的肯定句:主语+can+谓语动词的原形+其他。

(2)变一般疑问句时,把can提前:Can+主语+动词原形+其他?

肯定回答:Yes,主语+can。否定回答:No,主语+can't.

(3)含有can的否定句:主语+can't+动词的原形+其他。

(4)含有can的特殊疑问句:特殊疑问词+can+主语+动词原形+其他?

2、may+动词的原形。(may为情态动词)一般疑问句是把may提前,

肯定回答是:Yes,主语 +may。否定回答是:No,主语+mustn't。或please don't。

join+某个组织,俱乐部,party,参军,党派等 “加入”

Join sb. “参加到某人中” join in (doing)sth “加入做......,参加某个活动” Join in=take part in +活动,比赛

3、说某种语言:speak+语言 4、play+球、棋、牌;play+the+乐器。

5、擅长于(做)什么:be good at +名词/动ing

6、帮助某人做某事:help sb. (to ) do sth. help sb. with sth.

7、我能知道你名字吗?May I know your name?

8、想要做什么:want to do sth 例如:I want to learn about art.

9、What club do you want to join?

I want to join the chess club and the basketball club.

10、What club does Tom want to join? He wants to join the swimming club .

11、He can’t play the violin or the piano. Can you help kids with swimming?

12、Why do you want to join the English club? Because I want to learn English well.

七年级新目标英语教案【篇10】

重庆市110中学 曹毅

单元整体说明

单元教材分析

本单元是九年制义务课程标准实验教科书《新目标英语》七年级下册第10单元

本单元的核心话题是用一般过去时谈论度假等发生在过去的事情。因此“Where did you go on vacation?“ ” Did you go to the beach? Yes,I did.No,I didn’t.”等是教学的重点。通过对本单元的学习,学生能掌握本单元出现的地点名词,用于询问和回答过去发生的事情的短语和句型。

单元知识结构

词汇:

New York City; Central Park,exam,were,rainy, delicious,expensive,inexpensive.crowded.flew,kite,later,felt,little, corner, discuss,etc

句型: Where did you go on vacation? I went to summer camp.Did she go to Central Park?Yes,she did.No, she didn’t

语法:一般过去时特殊疑问句、一般疑问句及肯、否定回答。

单元总体目标

1.Master the vocabulary

2.Master and use:

Where did you go on vacation? I went to summer camp

Did she go to Central Park?Yes,she did.No, she didn’t

单元教学重难点一览

重点 难点

1.Vocabulary and Expressions

2. Grammar Focus:Where did you go on

vacation?I went to summer camp. Did she go on Central Park?Yes, she did.

No, she didn’t Use the past tense to talk about activities that happened in the past in English with the following sentences:

Where did you go on vacation?

Did you go to…?Yes. … /No,…

单元学情分析

学生在第五单元已接触过一般过去时,具有了学习本单元知识的认知前提,能自然地与本单元话题进行衔接。假期活动Such as; go abroad, go hiking, go hiking, summer camps, and so on接近学生的生活,They are all interested in talking about it.

单元教学建议

首先进行集中识字,为本单元的学习作好铺垫。其次,充分利用听力材料和阅读材料,训练和提高学生的听力和阅读水平。在听读的基础上创设语言情景,加强读写训练。培养学生的听、说、读、写综合能力。

单元课时分配

本单元共4课时:

Section A(一)1课时

Section A〔二)1课时

Section B(一)1课时

Section B(二)1课时

Section A (一)

教学内容

Section A中1a. 1b. 1c. 2a. 2b. 2c. Grammar focus

教学目标

知识与能力

1. Match the vocabulary:New York City,Central Park,exam.

2. Master and use:Where did you/ they /he / she go,vacation? I / They /He /She went to the mountains\New York City\beach\summer camp.

Did you go to the beach? Yes,I did.No, I didn’t.

过程与方法

通过例子Who went to the movies last Saturday?引出动词go的过去式went,从而引出一般过去时态。大面积操练,采用学生提出间题,学生解决问题,借助媒体来提高学生的主动性。

情感态度价值观

学会用一般过去时进行信息交流,培养学生的环保意识,热爱大自然。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

l. The vocabulary:New York City, Central Pads,exam.

2. Language:Where did you/they/he/she go on vacation? I/They/He/She went to the mountains/ New York City/ beach /summer camp

Did you go to the beach? Yes,I did. No, I didn’t.

难点

Use the language to talk about past events.

教学突破

对于本课的单词短语通过卡片或图画来引出学习。

Language: Where did you go on vacation?及答语的学习,借助于课本及课件的图画来引出。

教学准备

教师准备

录音机、磁带、课件

学生准备

预习生词和课文。

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用

step 1

Organization

(1’、Organize Ss by saying hello to each other. Greeting to teacher.

Step 2

Free talk

(2’) Ask the question:

Who is on duty?

Is everyone here today? The Students talk

about

Step 3

Section A

Presentation

la 1.(Ask questions about what students

did last Saturday)

(1)Who went to the movies last Saturday?

(Point to one student who raises his or her hand.)

Sara went to the movies last Saturday.

(Repeat.Write this sentence on the board. Underline the word went.)

(2) Ask:Who visited a friend last Saturday?

(Point to one student who raises his or her hand.)

Carlos visited a friend last Saturday.

(Repeat.Write this sentence on the board. Underline the word visited.)

2.(Point to the words went and visited in the sentences on the board.)

Say,We use these words to talk about things that happened in the past.

(Write these pairs of words on the board:go--went, visit --visited)

Ask: Can you point out the words that talk about the past?

This activity introduces the key vocabulary. Students raise their hands.

And give the right answer: I did.

Students raise their hands to answer.

Read.

强化记忆

Point to went and visited.

Step 4

Practise

la

3’ 1.Focus attention on the picture.Ask:

What at can you see?Say, Each picture shows something a person did in the past.Name each activity and ask students to repeat;Went to the mountains,went to New York City, went to summer camp,visited my uncle,stayed at home,went to the beach,visited museums.

2.Point to the numbered list of activities.Say each one again and ask the students to repeat.

3.Now, please match each phrase with one of the pictures.Say,Write the letter of each picture next to the name of the activity.Point to the sample answer.

4.Check the answers.

Answers:

1.e 2.B 3.D 4. c 5.a 6.F 7. g Read after the teacher aloud to learn the new phrases.

Read after the teacher。

Do it and then discuss

the keys in pairs.

step 5

Listening

(lb)

(6’)

Presentation This activity gives students practice in understanding the target language in spoken conversation.

1.Point to the picture.

on the screen

say, look at Picture A,Where did Tia go on vacation? Yes,she went to the mountains.

Ask,What did the person do in each scene?

2.Play the recording the first time.

3.Play the recording a second time.

say,There are three conversations.

The people talk about what they did on vacation.listen to the recording and write numbers of the names in the right boxes in the picture.

Please write only 5 numbers. Point out the

sample answer next to the picture showing went to the mountain.

4.Correct the answers.

ANSWERS:

(1) went to the mountains

(2)visited my uncle

(3)stayed at home

(4) went to New York City

(5)went to summer camp Practice the dialogue in pairs.Eg.

---Where did the boy go on vacation?

---He went to New York City.

only listen.

Listen and number the pictures(1-5).And then discuss in pairs.

At last raise their hands to tell the result

Read it loudly. 多媒体放映

录音机

录音机

多媒体

放映

Tape script:

Conversation 1

Xiang Hun: Hey, Tina. Where did you go on vacation?

Tina: I went to the mountains.

Xiang Hua: Cool.

Tina: Where did you go, Xiang Hua?

Xiang Hua:I went to New York City.

Conversation 2

Girl: Where did you go on vacation, Sally?

Sally:No where. I stayed at home.

Girl: And where did you go, Brad?

Brad: I visited my uncle.

Conversation 3

Boy 1:Where did you go on vacation, Tom?

Tom: I went to summer camp. It was great.

Pronunciation note

Write to play---played, visit ---visited on the board.Say,We studied the pronunciation of these --- ed endings in Unit 5.

They are both spelled --- ed,but we pronounce one /d/ and the other /Id/.Ask students to repeat these pairs:play-played,visit一visited. Listen carefully and learn the pronunciation of-ed.

多媒体

放映

Step 6

Pair work 1 c

(task 1)

3’ This activity provides guided oral practice using the target language.

1. Point out the example conversation.

Ask two students to read the dialogue to the class.

2. Say,Now work with a partner. You’re your own conversation about the pictures.

3. Say the dialogue in the picture with a student,Do a second example to the class.

4. Have students work in pairs.

As they talk,move around the room monitoring their work.

Offer language or pronunciation support as needed. Read it to the class.

Make a conversation in pairs.

Practice with the teacher,

Work in pairs.

Step 7

Consolidation

(4’) This activity provides guided oral practice using the target language. Talk in groups of three.

2c, group work

(Task2) 1.Say, Get into getups of three. One of you will he Nancy,One will be Marco, and one will be Julie. Ask each other about the vacations. You can talk about the activities from the chart in 2b or about any other activities you like.

2.As Ss talk, move around the room, monitoring the conversations and offering support as needed.

3. Have a group of Ss present their conversation to the class. Work in group of three.

some groups

Would like to act it out,

Step 8Test 4' Loot at test

Step 9

Summary

Grammar Focus

4’ 1. Review the grammar box. Ask Ss to say the questions and answers.

2. Review the difference between regular –ed past tense verbs (stay –stayed, visited). Then say the past form sentences with the form below.

I go to the summer camp

They go to New York City

He stay at home

She visit her uncle

Go to Central Park

I √

He √

She ×

They ×

Read the questions and answers.

Work in pairs

Saying out the sentences: Eg. –where did you go on vacation?

---I went to summer camp.

Eg. Did you go to Central Park?

---Yes, I did.

Step 10

Homework Practice the dialogue according to the picture on Page 1

本课小结

本课学习了1个生词、两个地点短语和英语句式的练习运用。通过本节课的学习,学生能熟练地用一般过去时询问和回答有关过去的事情。

练习设计

随堂练习设计按要求完成句子。

a)I went to the mountains.(改成一般疑问句)

b) Tina went to New York City.(就划线部分提问)

c)Did you go to the beach?(作出肯定回答)

d)Did they go to summer camp?(作出否定回答)

个性练习设计

翻译短语:

(l)呆在家里 ______ (2)去纽约城_____

(3)参加夏令营______(4)去爬山 _____

(5)去海滩______ (6)参观博物馆_____

板书设计

Unit 10

go - went Sara went to the movies last Saturday

visit – visited Carlos visited a friend last Saturday.

play- played

Section A(二)

教学内容

Section A中3a.3b.4

教学目标

知识与能力

1. Match the vocabulary:were rainy

Master and use:How was your vacation?how were the beaches?where did you go?

过程与方法

学生通过上一节课的学习,对where引导的过去时态的特殊疑问句,已经掌握。

能自然地与本课知识相衔接。让学生回忆他们的假期情况,引出一般过去时态的句型,并且进行大量练习。采用学生提出问题,学生解决问题,借助媒体来提高学生的主动性。

情感态度价值观

教育学生渗透合作精神和社会公德意识。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

1. The vocabulary:were rainy fish

2. Language: Where did you go on vacation? I went to the mountains/ New York City /beach /summer camp…

How was your vacation?how were the beaches?

难点

Use the language to talk about past events.

教学突破

对于本课的单词短语通过卡片或图画来引出学习。

Language: Where did you go on vacation?及答语的学习,借助于课本及课件的图画来引出。

教学准备

教师准备

录音机、磁带、课件、单词卡片、彩笔

学生准备

预习生词和对话。

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用

Step 1

Free talk

(2’) Ask the question:Where did you go last Sunday? Students talk about events in the past.

Step 2

Presentation

(16’)

(3a) (用班里的学生为例做练习)

Point out the pictures in the photo album. Ask students to describe what they see.(In Picture 1 there is a man with a bowl of soup.There is also a waiter. He looks angry.) Describe what they

see in picture 1 and

picture 2

Fill in the blanks in

the conversation

Step 3

Practice(36)

(6') (In picture 2 there is a beautiful beach.There is a man.He looks unhappy.)

Read the first two lines of the dialogue to the class.Point out the answer was in the first line. Then point out the blanks in the rest of the lines of the dialogue.Read the conversation to the class saying the word blank for each blank line: How blank the beaches?

Then say,Write the word was or were in each blank. Ask students to complete the activity on their own.

Point to picture 3 and ask students to say what they see.

Then read the words under the picture.Pronounce any new words and explain what they mean,if necessary Say:In this picture a girl is on a bus.The girl is taking a bus trip.Ask,What does relaxing mean?

Does it mean you are excited or quiet?

How do you look when you relax?

H students don’t know the meaning of relaxing, demonstrate by leaning back in your seat and half一closing your eyes.

Say a dialogue with a student.point to (学生看3a部分)

practice and act.

Listen.

(学生看图互问)

Work with the teacher.

Work with a partner

and act out.

Read and learn.

Make their own conversation 多媒体

放映

图一

图二

the food picture. Ask,How was the food? Do a send example,if you wish.

Move around the room monitoring their work.Offer language or pronunciation support as needed.

Have two students perform the example conversation,or perform it yourself with one student(you ask the questions).

Point out that the conversations starts off with the sentences in the speech bubbles.

For example,

A:where did you go?

B: I went to…

A: What was the weather like?

B: It was hot and humid. Practice in pairs.

The student replies,it was awful.

work in pairs

Look at picture6,

Practice the conversation below.

Ask and answer questions. 多媒体

放映

Step 4

Practice

(10') Say:First fill in the chart with the information about your last vacation,Say where you went,what the weather was like, what you ate,and what else you did.As students fill in the chart move around the classroom, monitoring progress and offering help as necessary。 Something in the pictures.

Act it out

Fill in the chart with

Their own information

Then ask and answer 多媒体

放映

本课小结

本节课学习了3个生词,和句式的练习运用。通过本节课的学习,学生能熟练地运用句型where did you go? I went … .

练习设计

1、动词的适当形式填空:

A: Where _____ you ______ on your vacation?(go)

B:I _______ to the stores.(go) what about you?

A: I ______ at home (stay)

B: What ______you _______?(do)

A:Nothing much.

B: Why ______ you _______at home?(stay)

A:I just _______ to go out.(not want)

2. Make a conversation and act.

板书设计

Unit 10

1. were rainy

2. Where did you go on vacation? I went to...

Section B(一)

教学内容

Section B中la. 1b.lc.2a.2b.2c

教学目标

知识与能力

1.Match the vocabulary:

delicious, awful expensive, inexpensive, crowded

2. Master and use:Where did Vera go on vacation?

Did Vera like the vacation?

How were the stores? They were very expensive.

过程与方法

通过例子The ring is one hundred million dollars.It’s expensive.引人本课,设置会话情景来激发学生兴趣,调动其学习主动性。利用多媒体图片大量练习句型,提出问题,解决问题,体现师生互动。

情感态度价值观

教育学生热爱生活,积极参与班级集体活动。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

1. The vocabulary:delicious, awful, expensive,inexpensive,crowded

2. language:Where did you \ they\ he\ she go on vacation?

I\They \ He\She went to Japan.

How were the museums/ people /stores? They were crowded expensive /friendly.

难点Use the language to talk about past events.

教学突破

对于本课的单词短语通过多媒体图画和设置的情境来引出学习。

Language: Where did you go on vacation?及答语的学习,借助于课本及课件的图画来引出。

教学准备

教师准备

录音机、磁带、课件

学生准备

预习生词和课文。

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用

Step 1

Organization

(1’) Organize Ss by greeting each other.

Step 2

Presentation (1 a)

(11’) Ask:What do you think of this book?

Is it interesting?(通过对话弓l出本

课要学习的新形容词expensive 等)Point to the picture, This is a ring. The price is one hundred million

dollars. Answer the questions

together

Say:It’s expensive. 多媒体

体图片

Step 3

1b writing

(5’) This activity introduces more key vocabularies.

Point out the six words delicious,awful,expensive,inexpensive, crowded

1.Say each word and ask students to repeat them,

2.Call attention to the fourth picture saying: This is a cake.

It’s delicious!Then do the same thing for all six pictures.

crowded delicious

3.Then point out the blank line in front of each numbered word.

4.Point out the sample answer. As students work,move around the room answering questions as needed.

Answers

1.f2.a3.d 4.e 5 6.c

This activity provides writing practice using the target language.

Simple draw:the smiley face and the frowny face.Say,the smiley face is for good things. The frowny face is for bad things.

Point out the sample answer. Say, The word delicious is under the smiley face because delicious is a happy word.

Ask students to finish the activity individually, Repeat loudly

Practice in pairs then

act it out

Match each word

with a picture by writing the letter of each picture in the blank in front of the correct word.

Discuss in groups

(act the faces out) 多媒体

放映

图片

1. delicious, inexpensive, crowded

2. awful, expensive, crowded City some examples to learn these adjectives.

This activity gives students practice in understanding the target language in spoken conversation.

Step 4

Listening

(2a)

(8') 1.Point out the two questions. After you hear the conversation, please answer these questions. Read the questions to the class.

2. Play the recording the first time.

Students only listen.

This time say, listen to the recording and write the answer to each question.

3. listen to the recording the second time.

correct the answers. Cite some examples to learn these adjectives

Listening.

2b(4') 1.She went to Tokyo.

2. Yes, she did.

Tapescript

Girl: Hi, Vera , How was your vacation?

Vera: It was great!

Girl: Where did you go?

Vera: I went to Tokyo with my family.

Girl]: Really? Wow!What did you do there?

Vera:Well, we went to a lot of museums.

Girl: Oh, how were they?

Vera: They were really interesting. But they were also very crowded. Did you meet any Japanese people? Listen.

Then answer.

Listen and write.

Then discuss the keys in pairs

Read and practice in pairs. Recorder

Vera: Yeah,the people were really friendly.My parents have some Japanese friends,and we had dinner at their house.

Girl:How was the food?

Vera:It was delicious.I love Japanese food.

This activity provides further

listening practice using the target language

Call attention to the chart. Read the words in the chart:

Her vacation, the museum the stores,the people,the food.

Point out the sample answer. Say,What does Vera think of her vacation? It was great.

Play the recording. Play the recording a second time.Ask students to finish filling in their answers and to check their answers.

Correct the answers.

Answers.

vacation-great

people -- friendly

museums一interesting, crowded

food-- delicious

store一expensive

delicious relaxing Read aloud.

then discuss the keys.

Listen and fill in the

chart.Then discuss

the keys. 多媒体

多媒体

Step 5

Pair work

(2c Task)

(5’) This activity provides guided oral practice using the target language.

Call attention to the question words.

Have a student read them to the class .Ask Where did you go on vacation? Say,please work in pairs.As students talk,move around the room

offering pronunciation and language support as needed. Read out.

(Role play) 多媒体

放映

本课小结

本节课总共学习了6个形容词以及where和how句式的练习运用。通过本节课的学习,学生能熟练地用英语表达自己的感受,培养了他们热爱集体活动的情感。

练习设计

随堂练习

词类转换

1) expensive(反义词)______ 2)crowd(反义词)________ 3 ) awful(反义词)________

4)friend(形容词)________ 5)go(过去式) _______ 6) do(过去式)_________

个性练习设计

翻译下列句子

1)你是去哪儿度的假?

2)我们去了许多博物馆。

3) -----那儿的商店怎么样?一 都很贵。

4) 日本朋友们对我们很友好。

板书设计

Unit 10

1.delicious,awful, expensive, inexpensive

2.Where did Vela go on vacation?

How were the stores?

Section B (二)

教学内容

Section B3a.3b.3c.4以及Self Check 3

教学目标

知识与能力

1. New words and expressions:flew kite later felt little corner discuss difficulty

过程与方法

通过复习一般过去时引出本课的重点------日记。

情感态度价值观

学会日记的写法。

教学重、难点及教学突破

重点

The vocabulary: flew kite later felt little comer till fry question discuss difficulty

难点

日记的格式。

教学突破

对于本课的单词短语通过卡片或图画来引出学习。

Language: 通过询问过去的事情引出日记。

教学准备

教师准备

录音机、磁带、课件

学生准备

预习生词和课文。

教学步骤

教学步骤、时间 教师活动 学生活动 媒体应用

Step 1

Organization

(1’) Organize Ss by greeting each other.

Step 2

Free talk

(2’) Ask the questions:

What day is it today?

What day was it yesterday? Answer: It is Friday.It was Thursday.

Step 3

Presentation

Section B 3a

(17’) 1.Let the students read Kim’s travel diary and find the new words.

2.Teach the new words:

later, felt,little, corner

Explain the meaning and the usage of the new words.

Let the students write the new words.

3.Say,Now read the diary and circle

all the good things about Kim’s holiday.Underline all the bad things. Ask them to notice the description words that tell them whether something is“good”or “bad,” You may want to ask a student to tell you what the first“bad thing” was.

4.Check the answers.

Answers

Good things:

The weather(great) Read Kim's travel diary and find out the new words.

Read the new words after then write them in the notebooks.

Read again and finish the activity individually.

Then discuss in pain:

Read aloud,Then read the diary,try to learn the key words by hearts. 多媒体

The beach(beautiful)

Playing in the waves(fun)

Finding the little boy/returning him to his father(happy)

Playing tennis (really fun)

Eating fried fish and garlic vegetables (delicious)

Bad things:

Kim’s kite breaking(not much fun) Museum (boring and crowded)

No money for taxi/walking back to

hotel(tired)

5.The teacher tell the students the methods of writing the diary.

Step 4

Practice writing

(Section B 36)

(10’) Thus activity provides guided writing

practice using the target language.

1.Say,Now write a travel diary like the one in 3a.

2.Have the students do the activity individually. You may want to have them write on pieces of paper, since space in the textbook is limited. As they work,move around he classroom offering assistance as necessary. Look at the pictures and write a diary.

3.Have several students read out their diaries to the class(You might want to make this activity more substantial, and set it as written homework to be collected and marked.)

4. Do a Survey

Ask students to interview friends and family members and write down where they went on vacation. Ask the students to list at least one activity or place they visited in that city and whether it was good or bad Ask students to share this information with the rest of the class. The students read their own diary

The students write their vacation and tell each other. 多媒体

放映

Step 5

Groupwork

(task)

Section B 4

(7’) This activity gives students listening and speaking practice using the target language.

1 Say, Now you can talk about a real vacation or an imaginary one. The other students can ask you questions. You can use the diary you wrote for activity 3b if you want.

2. Ask students to get into groups of four. One student in each group begins by telling where he or she went. The other students ask questions. Then they switch roles, so each student has a chance to tell the others about his or her vacation.

3. Move around the room, offering vocabulary and pronunciation support as needed. Talk about it in

groups

The students talk

about their real vacation.

Be divided into groups of four and ask questions each other.

Talk aloud.

Step 6

Homework 1.Master the new words.

2.Write a diary

本课小结

本节课学习了19个生词,和日记的写法。通过本节课的学习,学生能掌握日记的格式。

练习设计

1. Write a diary.

2. Make a survey about the circumstance.

教学探讨与反思

能设置一种情景,让学生在假期中“真正”去过某些地方,然后再进行问答,相信会更好。

尽可能多地创设英语氛围,以提高学生的语言综合运用能力。任务型教学能调动学生的积极性,激起学生的好奇心,使学生产生成就感,进一步激起他们对英语的兴趣。学生学习语言是在理解的基础上运用语言,在用中学。为学生提供了使用英语的语境。着重培养学生的创新精神和独立思维能力,并在学习的基础上了解文化差异,培养合作精神和社会公德意识。

如果把课堂教学内容扩展到课外活动中去。形成课内外互相补充、互相促进的学习方式会更好

板书设计

Unit 10

How to write a diary?

七年级新目标英语教案【篇11】

新目标七年级英语下册期末试卷

时间:80分钟 内容:unit1---12 总分:110分

学校 —————— 班级——————姓名 —————— 座号————

一、补全单词。﹙5分﹚

1、r--le﹙规则﹚ 2、m--nd﹙介意﹚ 3、ch----p﹙便宜﹚

4、st----﹙停留﹚ 5t----﹙茶﹚ 6、b----f﹙牛肉﹚

7、b----ld﹙体格﹚8、r--n﹙雨﹚9、w--sh﹙洗﹚ 10、f--sh﹙鱼﹚

二、英汉词组匹配。﹙10分﹚

A、漂亮的 B、赞同 C、万里长城 D、少年宫 E、不再

F、中国文化 G、访谈节目 H、 一大碗 I、故宫 J、 肥皂剧

1、 talk show 2、 China Culture 3、 soap opera 4、 good—looking

5 、agree with 6、 the Great Wall 7、 not…any more

8、 the Palace Museam9、 the Children’s Palace 10、 a large bowl of

三、从Ⅱ栏中找出Ⅰ栏中问句的适当答语。(共10小题,每小题0.5分,计5分)

Ⅰ Ⅱ

﹙﹚ 1. What does your brother look like? A. Yes, they did.

﹙﹚2. How was your weekend? B. It’s ten yuan

﹙﹚ 3. What time did Tom get to school? C. He’s tall with brown hair

﹙﹚4. Did your parents go to the movies yesterday? D.At about six o’clock

﹙﹚5. Where does Mr Smith come from? E. Yes, there is.

﹙﹚6. What is your best friend like? F. They are playing soccer.

﹙﹚7. Are the children playing soccer or basketball?G. I like Chinese.

﹙﹚8. Do you like English or Chinese? H. America.

﹙﹚9. How much is the book? I. She is really friendly.

﹙﹚10. Is there a post office near here? J. It was great.

四、根据句意及首字母提示,补全单词。﹙5分﹚

1 、I often v___ my grandmother.

2 、Where did you go on v______ last year?

3、She went shopping last night, but the shops were too c______.

4 、My brother usually a_____ late for class.

5 She likes the scarf, but I don’t s_____ it.

五、用所给词的'适当形式填空。﹙10分﹚

1、Don’t ______﹙eat﹚in the classroom.

2、They________﹙go﹚to the beach last weekend.

3、Miss Wang is ________﹙friend﹚to us.

4、Look! The boys__________﹙play﹚soccerover there.

5、They enjoy ________﹙listen﹚to music.

6、There aren’t_______﹙some﹚mutton in the fridge.

7、She _______﹙wash﹚clothes every morning.

8、It’s_____﹙sun﹚. Let’s go out for a walk.

9、We have to______﹙clean﹚the classroom on school day.

10、Thank you for______﹙join﹚us.

六、选择最佳的一个答案。﹙20分﹚

﹙﹚1、You are from Australia, can you _____Japanese?

A、 speak B、 say C、 tell

﹙﹚2 、You are a good girl._ _________

A、 Thank you very much B 、Sure C 、OK

﹙﹚3.________ late for school again.

A. Not B.Not be C.Don’t be D. Aren’t

﹙﹚4、 This is my friend, he is a _________boy.

A、 14-years-old B、 14 years old C 、14-year-old

﹙﹚5、 _______did you go last Sunday?-- I went to the zoo

A 、 How B.Where C.When D.Why

﹙﹚6、 Go straight and ___________left. The hospital is next to the post office.

A. turn B.take C.go D. carry

--What_______ _your English teacher _____like?—She is tall with long hair.

A.is, look B.is, looks C.does, look D.do, looks

﹙﹚7、My friend ________a medium build and she ________medium height.

A.has, has B.is , is C.has, is D. is , has

﹙﹚8、 --How was your vacation, Sarah?--________.

A. It’s pretty good B.It was pretty good C.It’s hot D.It was hot

﹙﹚9、 _____ Sunday night , we went to movies.

A 、On B、 At C、 In

﹙﹚10 How about ______ fishing this afternoon?

A、 go B、 goes C 、going

﹙﹚11、 ____________ I’d like some chicken.

A、 Do you like it? B、 Can I help you? C、 What do you like?

﹙﹚12、 Mary like playing __ guitar, but she doesn’t like playing __soccer.

A、 the B、 the, the C、, the

﹙﹚13、 John doesn’t like math, Lily doesn’t, ____.

A、 also B 、too C、 either

﹙﹚14、 She is a waiter. She is ___ at night, but she is free in the morning.

A、 funny B、 busy C 、tired

﹙﹚15、 Is there a park near here? _ __________

A 、Yes, there is. B 、No, it isn’t. C、 No, there is.

﹙﹚16、 Please be _____!It is a reading room.

A 、shy B、 smart C、 quiet

﹙﹚17 、This TV show is _____ , so I want to sleep.

A、 boring B、 interesting C、 exciting

﹙﹚18、 What would you like_____ lunch?-- A bowl of noodles, please.

A、 for B 、with C、 in

﹙﹚19、 There ____ many people in the park yesterday.

A was B were C are

﹙﹚20、 Why __go out for a walk?

A 、don’t B、 not C 、can’t

七、句型转换。﹙15分﹚

1、 I’d like some chicken noodles.﹙划线部分提问﹚ _____ _____ you _____ ?

2、Do your homework after school.﹙否定句﹚ _____ _____ your homework after school.

_3、She gets up at six every morning.﹙一般疑问句﹚ ____ she ___ ____ at six every morning?

4、His brother has some tomatoes. ﹙同2﹚His brother ____ _____ _____ tomatoes.

5、What do you think of the TV show ?﹙同2﹚ _____ _____ you _____ the TV show?

6、What can I do for you ? ﹙同2﹚_____ _____ _____ ______ ?

7、He watched TV last night. ﹙同3﹚____ he ___ TV last night?

8、Mr. Wang is teaching English in the classroom.﹙同1﹚

_____ ____ Mr. Wang _____ in the classroom?

9、Mr. Black is a little bit heavy.﹙同1﹚ _____ _____ Mr. Black _____ _____ ?

10、He is from Japan. ﹙划线部分提问﹚___________he _____?

八、完形填空(10分)

It 51 Sunday yesterday. We has 52 classes. I got up at 6:30 53 morning. Then my mother and I went to the shop. We wanted to do some 54. My mother wanted to buy some food 55 super and I wanted to buy some school things: some books and a pen. The shop56 early in the morning.57a lot of people in the shop. They were 58, old and young. Some things in the shop were cheap, some were not. We bought some food and school things. The people in the shop 59 friendly 60.

51.A.is B.was C.it’s D.it was

52.A.no B.not C.not any D.much

53.A.in B.in the C.at D.at the

54.A.shops B.shopping C.shopping D.shop

55.A.for B.to C.with D.at

56.A.open B.opening C.is opening D.opened

57.A. There is B.There has C.There were D.There have

58.A.man and womanB.mans and womans C. men and women D.a man and a woman

59.A.was B.were C.did D.have

60.A.for we B. to us C. for our D. to ours

60.A.for we B. to us C. for our D. to ours

九、阅读理解:(共10小题,每小题2分,计20分)

A

Billy and Sam were twins. They were in the same class. They were both very happy. One day their teacher asked the class to write a composition(作文)“My Mother”. Sam wrote one, but Billy was lazy. He just copied his brother’s.The next day, the teacher asked Billy why his composition was the same as Sam’s. “We have the same mother, don’t we?”answered Billy.

根据短文内容判断句子正误,正确的填A,错误的填B。

61.Sam was older than Billy.

62.Sam and Billy were in different classes

63. The name of the composition was” My Mother”

64.Billy’s composition was the same as Sam’s

65.Billy was not lazy. He was very clever

B

TV PROGRAMMERS(节目)

Channel 1 Channel 2

18:00 Around China 17:45 Computers today

18:30 Cartoon network 18:10 Chinese arts

19:00 News 18:30 English classroom

19:30 Weather report 18:50 Animal world

19:40 Around the world 19:25 China’s

20:10 TV play: Sisters 20:20 Sports

21:00 English for today 21:00 TV play: Big family

21:15 Popular music 21:45 English news

21:55Talk show 22:00 Music

66.You want to know something about Japan, you can watch________

A.Weather report B.China’s 2004 C.Around the world D.Animal world

67.You are a football fan. You may watch TV at___________.

A.19:00 on Channel 2 B.19:40Channel 1 C.20:20Channel 2 D.21:15Channel

68.How long does the TV play“sisters”last(持续)?

A.30 minutes B.50 minutes C.90 minutes D.120 minutes

69.You can watch _______if you want to learn English.

A.English news B.English classroom C.English for today D.A、B and C

70.Children often like to watch_________.

A.Cartoon network B.News C.Weather report D.Sports

B:Great! Thanks.

十、作文。﹙10分﹚谈一谈你学校的规章制度。

七年级新目标英语教案【篇12】

青铜峡第五中学 王俊霞

教材分析

1、教学内容

1)、词汇:have,soccer,ball,tennis racket,ping-pong ball,volleyball,basketball sport,bat,2)、语言结构:A、Do you have a ping-pong ball?Yes,I do。Do you have a ping-pong bat?Not,I do not。Does she/he have a pen?Yes,she/he does

2、教材的地位及其作用

本单元的教学主要内容是:学习have的一般现在时的疑问式的肯定和否定回答,该话题与学生的日常生活紧密联系在一起,容易唤起学生的学习兴趣,这对于提高学生的综合能力很有帮助,特别是说的能力。

本单元仍在继续学习一般现在时,这是一个生活中离不开的时态,也是最基本的一个时态。新课程标准要求学生重点掌握一般现在时,这在英语中使用频率很高,学好这一时态的用法对以后其他时态的学习和交际有很大的帮助。

二、学生分析

学生现有的能力与已掌握的知识:

学生在已经学过词汇:What is this ? What is that? 句型: Where is„? It’s in / on / under/„

经过前面的学习学生已经积累了一定的词汇,掌握了一定的目标语,已经具备了一定的听说读写能力。

三、教学目标

1、语言知识

词汇:A、重点掌握表示有关各种运动球类的名词, 如basketball, soccerball,so on 重点句型:? Do you/they have a TV? Yes,I/they do./No,I/they don’t.Does he/she have a soccer ball? Yes,he/she does./No,he/she doesn’t.2、语言技能

1)、能看着图片说;Do you/they have a TV? Yes,I/they do./No,I/they don’t.Does he/she have a soccer ball? Yes,he/she does./No,he/she doesn’t.3、学习策略

1)、利用老师所提供的图片卡片做出简单的判断。

2)、通过与同学交流,学会使用一般现在时的疑问形式及肯定和否定回答。

4、情感态度

1)通过各小组的对话练习培养学生的合作精神; 2)通过学习本单元,教会学生之间互相有无的主要句式

重点难点

1、Have 的一般现在时的疑问式用法;

2、Have的一般现在时的疑问句,及其肯定,否定回答;

3、简单拓展主语第三人称单数的句型。

教学手段:采用最简单的卡片图片、课本以及肢体语言。理念与思路、教法

1)采用图片进行直观教学。

2)学生在课堂教学过程中口头训练应成为本单元教学的重点内容。教学突破:Section A重在通过使用动词have对物品的所属进行提问和回答的交流式口语活动,学习由助动词do或does引导的一般疑问句的构成以及回答。教师要善于引导学生比较行为动词的疑问句和be动词的疑问句在构成和回答上的区别,通过大量和反复地操练以达到运用自如。

四、教学流程

一、第一教学环节:情景创设,导入新课 教师活动 学生活动

Section A主要内容是通过使用have对物品的所属进行提问和应答,来学会使用do和does引导的一般疑问句。所以在教学中可采取问答式导人法:

掌握新单词.采用各种方法学习单词。

1、升降语调、拼读、接龙和肢体的方式记忆单词。2.检查学生记忆单词的成效。

3、学生看1a的图片,使字母和单词相对应。

第二教学环节;老师和学生互动:学习掌握重要内容。

教师活动 学生活动(看图片练句型)

分片进行演示:I have a footba11.Do I have a football? 自己回答:Yes,I d0. 再问:Do I have a basketball? 自己回答:No,I don’t.再使用其它物体和图片询问学生:Do I have„? 询问学生:Do you have„? 询问学生:„? 询问学生:Do they have„? 在学生充分掌握的第一,第二人称和第三人称 的复数。

2.学生回答:Yes,you do.,you don’t.学生回答:Yes,I do.No,I don’t.学生回答:Yes,he/she does.No,he/she doesn’t.学生回答:Yes, they do.No,they don’t.掌握它的肯定和否定回答。

3、要求学生完成1b的听力,达到教学应完成的任务。

4.引导学生展开Pairwork活动,完成lc部分口语交际的教学任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答,可采用师生互动带动学生互动的交流方式:

5.Pairwork活动,完成lc部分口语交际的学习任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答并上台展示口语交际。

三、第三教学环节:合作交流,巩固提高

教师活动 学生活动

1、学生巩固练习活动,完成课堂练习和总结及笔头练习的教学任务。

2、让总结本课的 主要内容,如果不周到,教师可以补充完成。

3、游戏:让一个学生在课前 作各种动作,其他学生跟根据他的动作写单词和句型,然后核对结果。这种活动既可练习have一般疑问句的构成和回答的写法,又能调动学生的学习兴趣,十分有效。

4、习题练习,巩固课堂。问题探究与拓展活动

动词的第三人称单数形式:当句子的主语是“第三人称单数”时,即:不是I,不是you的其它单数形式时,谓语动词必须改变形式,也就是在词尾加一s或 一es(同名词的复数形式),我们可以简称为“三单形式”。有些动词的变化是特殊的,如:have的三单形式是has。在构成否定句时。要在动词前加助动词don’t或doesn’t;在构成疑问句时,则要在主语前加上助动词do或does,does/doesn’t是do/don’t的第三人称单数形式。助动词后应该用动词的原型。

五、教学反思:(成功和不足)

本单元重点学习的语法是do 和 does 引导的一般疑问句以及它们的回答方式,与此同时学习与运动有关的一些词汇。为此,在本单元我运用不同形式鼓励学生使用目标语言,在任务中体现学生的主体地位。在过程中学生可能出现一些错误,本人就以积极的态度对待他们,愉快的氛围对学生的学习有很大的积极影响力。首先要调动学生的学习兴趣和积极性,我努力在这方面去做,不足的请各位多提宝贵意见。

教无定法,教师不要为了任务活动而忽略了语言的传授。学生的信息交流要在特定的环境中进行,给他们参与的机会。任务的完成不是语言学习的结束,而是另一个高度的开端。加强学生语言的实践是改革的关键,要给学生机会去说、去做、去思考。

新目标英语上册/Unit 1 My name's Gina 教学目标

1、学会询问周围新同学的姓名,并且将自己刚认识的好朋友介绍给全体同学。

2、通过学生制作名卡或桌卡来提高学生学习英语的兴趣,体现英语的实用性。

3、通过以上任务活动,掌握形容词性物主代词的用法及其与人称代词的主格的区别,并且在第一节课让学生对英语的学习产生兴趣。

4、德育目标:热爱班集体,团结同学。

教学重点和难点

1、形容词性物主代词的用法

2、在任务活动中掌握you和your,he和his, she和her 的用法

3、重点句型(斜体字为扩展句子):

Hi / Hello!Good morning / afternoon / evening.How are you? Fine, thank you!/ Very well / So-so /All right.What’s your name? My name is … / I’m … What’s his/ her name? His/Her name is … 课前准备

1、学生课前准备:

利用网络查阅中英文姓名及初次见面时各国或各地风俗,礼仪体会它们的不同之处;

准备硬纸片和水彩笔;

用英文介绍自己的姓、名。

2、教学器材:录音机、电脑、图片。

3、教学课件:中英文名字展示片。

教学设计

Tasks Students’ activities Teacher’s activities

1.Game: ask and answer the question: What’s your name? Students make a self-introduction and pass the sentences one by one.At first, teacher makes a self-introduction.2.Two students act out how to greet people.Act out the greeting forms they are familiar with or they find on the students the pictures of other countries’ customs with computer.3.See who can make the most friends and get the most information.Then report their results with his or hers.Move around to make friends with the ones they are interested in.Make the students move around to make friends with others. and make their name and make their name cards in groups.Ask them to design their name cards and see which group is the best.教学过程设计

任务一:结识新朋友。

1、老师首先向学生做一个自我介绍,将名字写在黑板上: My name is …, My first name is…, My last name is …同时介绍一下名字的意义,然后学生就近组成若干小组,进行自我介绍。例如:一个学生叫徐烨,他说:My name is Xu Ye.Ye means light;一个叫王超的学生介绍说: My name is Wang Chao.Chao means Superman。这个任务能够激起学生学习英语的兴趣,同时扩大词汇量。

2、“What’s your name?”传句子比赛。学生按行分组,一个同学问,“What’s your name?”第二个学生回答,“My name is …”然后再接着问第三个人, “What’s your name?” 第三个人答,“My name is … His/ her name is …”再接着问第四个人What’s your name?”。。看哪个组最先获胜。

任务二:学生利用电脑向大家展示他们所搜集的中英文姓,问候语名及各国或各地初次见面时的礼仪,体会它们的不同之处;然后由抽签决定各组同学分别用哪个国家或哪个地区的礼仪(例如:日式、美式、法式和学校版的礼仪)来表演两个人初次见面时的问候语及谈话内容(用英文),看哪一组同学表演的形象,语言准确,最后评出最佳组合。

任务三:找朋友。并将他或她加入你的朋友记录中。该任务是通过学生自己去询问他们感兴趣的同学的爱好,找出他们之间的共同点,然后和他们交朋友(利用时间争取和所有的同学交朋友,了解他们各自的优点),并将自己所掌握的新朋友的信息介绍给全体同学,让大家了解他(们)。在该任务的执行过程当中,学生可以尽量施展他们的才能,倾尽其所学的英文知识来展示自己并且看谁能获得最多的信息。因此,这项任务在调动学生学习英语兴趣的同时,也反复操练了本单元的关键句型和形容词性物主代词,尤其是he and his, she and her;同时运用到一些超出本课教学内容的语言知识,学生参与性强,最大限度的调动了他们的积极性,同时也为学生树立了英语学习的信心。

Name Hobbies Other information

任务四:制作姓名卡。制作姓名卡,由小组协作共同完成姓名卡的设计与制作,姓名卡中要求包括学生的汉语名字(拼音书写)和英文名字,其他的内容由各组自行设计,但要求每个人的姓名卡的设计要有创意、体现小组的共性、美观大方、经久耐用、语言准确。因此,该任务既体现个性,又体现共性;既有分工,又有合作。

任务五:作业。为自己、父母、亲朋好友找一个有意义的英文名字,同时将他们介绍给你的同学们。

教学点评(或反思)

本节课的设计体现了任务型教学的特点,同时整个任务链的设计均以学生的兴趣

为主,由易至难,逐层递进,逐步完成各个任务,使学生在愉快的完成每一个任务的同时,体会到学习英语的乐趣,并使每一位学生都参与到活动中,都有所提高。本节课由于是新学期的第一节课,在教学中,本着 “新学期、新起点、新观念、新

认识”的观点设计了四个快乐的任务,同时这几个任务相互连接,环环相扣,形成了一个完整的任务链。整节课课堂气氛活跃,学生学习英语的兴趣始终很浓。尤其是“找朋友”这个任务,极大地调动了学生的积极性,学生们说出了很多精彩的句子。而在制作姓名卡时,各小组通力合作,氛围和谐,作品各具特色,体现了任务型教学中共同合作与个性张扬的优势。在解释自己名字的任务中,充分调动了学生的表现欲,学生们的名言经整理后被保留下来,提高了学生学习英语的积极性。

在各国礼仪表演中学生既学到了英文知识,又了解了其他各国各地的风俗,将知识“延伸到课堂之外的学习和生活之中”。因此,这节课中的活动具有可操作性,并以学生的生活经验和兴趣出发,使学生的思维和想象力、审美情趣得到发展,从而提高学生实际语言运用能力。

另外,本节课的德育目标,使英语教学与其他学科结合起来。

当然本节课中也存在几个需要继续探索的问题:

一、师生均是初次接触任务型教学,对其仅是好奇及尝试,尚未能领会其主旨。

二、活动中课堂秩序稍有些乱,在以后课堂中应加以指导。

教师本身也需要提高对新课标和任务型教学的认识,以完善今后的教学。

英文版英语说课稿

Good morning, everyone!Today, I’ll say something about Unit 5 Section A in Book1 of GO FOR IT English.Background on the reformation of curriculum, this book can connect the life and act, emphasize the interest and experience of the Ss, the pictures are active and vivid.Grade four is the initial stage of English learning, so it stresses on the emotion of the Ss, creates a well beginning for the Ss.This Unit has 7 parts, we’ll learn sectionA mainly, it embodies the repeating characterize.Review the learned language points “Where’s„”and the new language points will be represented in the following units.So this unit forms connecting links with a special meaning in this book.The content of this period is to use “Where’sare„” to determine the place.And according to the contents and the fact of the Ss, I establish the following three teaching aims of this period: Aims on the knowledge: students can listen, read, say and spell the following words: a glass, a fridge, an egg, bread and a table.Aims on the abilities: students can listen, read, say and write the following daily expressions: What’s for breakfast?

Have some juice then.Aims on the emotion(1)To foster Ss’ consciousness of good co-operation and proper competition.(2)To lead Ss to show their loveliness to the poor.III.Key-points of this lesson(1)To help Ss ask and answer the question: What’s in it?

(2)To enable Ss to study in groups and co-operate skillfully.(3)To develop Ss’ interest in English.IV.Difficult points(1)To help the Ss ask and answer the question “What’s in it?” and make sure they can use the plural nouns correctly.(2)To finish the survey by themselves.V.Teaching methods As we all know: the main instructional aims of learning English in primary school is to cultivate pupils’ basic abilities of listening and speaking and their good sense of the English language.So in this lesson I’ll mainly use “Task-based” teaching method.That is to say, I will let the Ss learn in real situations, finish a task by making a survey to help the Ss to get a better understanding of the key structure of the dialogue.I will arrange four kinds of activities: singing, guessing game, finishing a survey and having a competition.And in this lesson a recorder, PPT, school things and a printed form will be needed.Students should prepare some school things.VI.Teaching procedures and purposes of my designing.I’ll finish this lesson in five steps.Step 1.Warm-up and preview 1.Free talk between T and Ss about things in the classroom.2.Sing the song together: Books and pencils.3.Do some TPR, for example: Show me your English me your crayon.4.Review the numbers by asking: “How many crayons do you have?”

Purpose: It is important to form a better English learning surrounding for the Ss by singing and doing some total physical response and at the same time.it provides situations to review learned knowledge for the next step.Step 2.Presentation Now I’ll mainly talk about this step.1.Present the pattern: “My schoolbag is heavy.” “What’s in it?.”(1)Show a bag and say: “Look!I have a bag.” Carry it and say: “Oh, it is heavy.My schoolbag is heavy.” Help the Ss understand the meaning with the help of my body language.Then lead the Ss to read the sentence.Make sure they can say it correctly.(2)T: My schoolbag is heavy.Open the bag and say: “What’s in it? What’s in my schoolbag?” Take out a Chinese book.Then do the action again.Let the Ss read the sentence.2.Play a guessing game.Divide the whole class into four groups to have a competition.Let them guess: What’s in the bag? How many?

Purpose: To present the key structures one by one is much easier for the Ss to learn and grasp the per competition can arouse the Ss’ interest in English learning.3.With the help of the PPT to present the dialogue.Set a situation to help Ss understand: Two Ss are coming.One girl is carrying a heavy bag on her back.They are talking.Girl: My schoolbag is heavy.Boy: What’s in it?

Girl: 20 story-books, 32 pencil, 9 rulers, 12 crayons and 30 picture-books.Etc.Boy: What will you do? Girl: They are for the poor.Boy: Great!I’ll bring some school things too.The boy comes back home and puts a lot of things into the bag.Then he goes to school again and gives them to a teacher.While he is taking them out, he is counting the numbers of all things.The teacher says: Thank you soooooooo much.4.Mention that we should take care of the poor.5.Play the tape.Let the Ss listen and imitate the dialogue.Pay attention to their pronunciation and intonation.Purpose: PPT can provide a real situation for the Ss to understand the dialogue and the relationships between people better.Tell the Ss we should show our loveliness to the Ss.Step 3.Practice Divide Ss into groups of six children.Each one would finish the printed form by asking and answering: How many storybooks do you have? Find out which group finishes faster.Purpose: Task-based teaching method is used here to develop Ss’ ability of communication and also their ability of co-operation will be well trained.Step 4.Assessment Help Ss finish “Let’s check” of this unit and workbook.Purpose: To check the knowledge Ss have learned in this period.Step 5.Add-activity 1.Let Ss tell each other how many school things they have after class.Tell their parents how many school things they have at home.2.Take care of everything they have.Purpose: Revision is so important that Ss should speak English as much as they as in class or after class.It is necessary for the Ss to do some extensive exercise after class to consolidate the knowledge they learned.In a word, the whole period is based on tasks, which are designed from easy steps to steps that are challenging.When the Ss are carting out the tasks, they can acquire information, knowledge, and have their ability and skills trained.That’s all.Thanks a lot for your attention.

七年级新目标英语教案【篇13】

Unit 7 What does he look like?

任务型教学设计:

1.话题: What does he look like?

2.目标:

1)认知目标:掌握新单词短语及句型,学会描述人的外貌,并能根据描述画出人像。

目标语言:

What does your friend look like?

She has a medium build, and she has long hair.

(Or: She is thin, and she is tall/medium height.)

2)能力目标:

①学会谈论身高,体重,发型,面部特征及着装特点。

②能积极思维,运用所学单词,短语及句型,结合实际生活进行灵活运用。

③能和合作伙伴互相交流,充分交换信息。

3)情感目标:学会简单地表达自己的观点或好恶,学会为人善良的美德。

任务设计:

笔者在本课时设计了5个不同的任务活动形式,紧紧抓住了初一学生求知欲强,好动,好自我表现的年龄特点,较为成功地完成了本课时的教学任务。

活动一:猜一猜,学一学

在本课时的第一步,新教学内容学习过程中,笔者采用了3幅学生熟悉的可爱的卡通图画,请学生们从身高,发型,体型三个方面依次用抢答的形式说出已学过的表达:He is tall/ short/medium height……

对新知识的学习,笔者采取了让学生从老师的体态语言中,从实际的图片及身边的同学长相,适时再配以音标,让学生自己猜义,拼读,然后再由老师,学生分别教读,领读。在说说,猜猜,学学的过程中,学生自然就进入了本课时的学习内容与氛围中。

活动二:动一动。

初一学生毕竟年龄小,好动是他们的天性。针对这一特征,笔者设计了在学习完身高,发型,体型三个方面的词汇后,让全班学生齐起立,跟着老师一起用形象的body movement复习巩固了刚学会的新内容。

活动三:唱一唱,编一编。

笔者用一个节奏简单明了的chant,把所学的知识用另一种形式得到体现与升华。学生先由老师带领熟悉chant 节奏与内容,再让学生模仿老师的chant,为他们所喜欢的人物(如贝克汉姆,周杰伦,居里夫人等)编写新的chant,最后再为身边的老师,同学进行现场编写chant,气氛达到了前所未有的高潮。学生的能力也从简单的模仿训练上升为带有一定创造性的训练活动,不但有利于他们的思维培养,还能极大地提高学习兴趣.

(附chant: What does she look like?? She is short,short,short,short.

What does she look like ?????? She is thin,thin,thin,thin.

What does she look like?????? She has curly hair,curly curly hair.

活动四:听一听,画一画,猜一猜。

为加强学生的听力能力,结合初一学生喜好动手的特点,笔者设计了让学生们先听两遍录音,再结合所听内容,为所听到的任务画像。再通过实物投影机,请画画的同学对所画的人物描述一翻,可以让学生为自己的同学画像并描述,让其余的同学猜他(她)画的是谁。

活动五:写一写,找一找。

笔者设计了一个结合生活实际的开放性任务:让学生自己假设一个情景,有可能是逛街时和妈妈走散,有可能是小孩走失,有可能是寻找多年不见的亲人等等,结合下列表格写出一份寻人启示。此任务不仅培养了学生的写作水平,同时也培养学生体会出助人为快乐之本.最后再升华了本节课思想: 心灵美比外表美更重要。这也突破了本节课的情感目标.

教学体会:

(1) 任务型语言学习有利于发挥学生的主体作用

在任务型教学中,教师教学活动的设计以学生为主体,教师的作用是组织、引导、帮助和监控,教学活动以学生用英语完成各项“任务”为主,从而培养学生应用英语的能力,这极大地发挥了学生的主体作用,充分体现了以学生为中心的教育理念。如在学生为自己喜欢和敬佩的人设计chant时,那种参与创造的氛围非常热烈,学生的情绪和能力体现都得到了很好的升华。

(2)任务设计的真实性有利于激发学生的学习兴趣:

由于有意义的任务活动贴近学生的生活、学习经历,能引起学生的共鸣,并能激发学生积极参与的欲望,使学生有话可说,使不同程度的学生都学有所得,体验成功的喜悦。

(3)小组活动的任务设计有利于培养学生合作学习:

在任务型教学中,教师围绕特定的交际目的和语言项目,设计出由易到难阶梯式、任务化的教学活动,教学活动中让学生用英语完成各项真实的任务,这些任务可以是独立完成的,可以是小组协作完成的。在完成任务的过程中,学生们针对自己对话题信息或语言知识的掌握程度,分工合作,为共同完成学习任务发挥各自的优势,并及时交流、合成信息,完成学习任务。小组活动的任务设计,使不同程度的学生都参与到活动中,发挥自己的优势,互相协作,共同提高。

七年级新目标英语教案【篇14】

新目标英语七年级下册第十二单元教案

新目标英语七年级下册第十二单元教案作者:思全英语辅导新目标英语七年级下册第十二单元教案

教学目标:

1.谈论规则

2.祈使语气

3.表示允许

4.能够用口头或书面描述规则

教学重点和难点:

重点掌握祈使语气的用法,包括表示允许的Can及其当情态动词用的have to do;以及各种可以用在表述规章制度的动词和句型。难点在于情态动词的用法,以及祈使句与它的应答。

教学设计:

学习内容

学生活动

教师活动

1.表示规则的句型:

*---Don't run in the hallways.

---Sorry,Ms Mendoza.

*Don't watch TV after school.

*Don't go out on school nights.

1.思考、谈论规则。

*Don't talk loudly.

*Do your homework after school!

*Practice your guitar every day.

引导、启发、教授需学内容。

2.Can for permission,such as:We can do….

We can't do….

Can we do…?

*---What are the rules?

---Well,we can't arrive late for class.

*---Can we listen to music,Alex?

---We can't listen to music in the hallways,

but we can listen to it outside.

2.听录音,回答问题。

*---Can we eat in the classroom?

---No,we can't.

*---Can students wear hats in school?

---Yes,they can.

放录音;启发、提示问题及答语。

3.阅读→迁移(读、写、文化差异)。

阅读/认图标;阅读信件→根据其信息找出规则→写出规则。

3.引导、提示图标含义;提示文化差异。

4.用口头或书面形式描述规则。

4.利用本单元所学祈使语气的用法,包括表示允许的'Can及其当情态动词用的have to do,根据常识或观察,为图书馆、生化实验室、语音室、机房、健身房、游泳馆等公共场所制定规章制度或使用规则。

4.检查学生讨论制定规章制度或使用规则情况--句型、短语、动词形式是否正确;指导并落实学生写作情况。

教学过程设计:

Task One:

Talk about school rules to”feel"Imperatives Goal:Get to know about the structure to express rules Step 1:Talk about the school rules they know/remember Step 2:Look at the picture and read the rules in Section AC 1a,telling the difference between yours Step 3:Add more rules to your school,which you think necessary Task Two:

Listen and find out what Ss can do and what they cannot Goal:Try to understand the rules by listening Step 1:Listen to conversations about the activities and find out what students can do and what they cannot do Step 2:Listen to conversations about the activities and find out what Alex and Christina can do and what they cannot do→Section A(2a/b)

Step 3:Listen to conversations about the activities and find out what rules students break

→Section A(1b)

Step 4:Listen to the different rules that different people have to follow→Section B(2a/b)

Task Three:

Learn to read the signs for rules Goal:Learn about the rules by reading the signs Step 1:Learn about the rules by reading the pictures→Section B1 Step 2:Learn about the rules by reading the signs→Section B(3 b)

Step 3:Talk about the similarities or the differences about the signs between China and abroad Task Four:

Write rules for libraries,labs,computer-rooms,and swimming pools etc.

Goal:Learn to take care of public things Step 1:

Read the letter→Section B(3 a)

Find the rules in the letter Write them down Step 2:

Talk in pairs about the rules for public places,such as libraries,labs,computer-rooms,swimming pools,etc.

Discuss in groups about the rules for these public places Write down what have been talked about/discussed

教学点评与反思:

设计思路:

任务型课程的设计要自始至终体现任务的要求与特点,尤其要确保任务的设计与完成是从简单重复逐步过渡到真实或接近真实。基于这一要求与特点,本课的四个任务先以谈论有关学校各项规章制度为话题,初步感受祈使句,以及如何表达规则;然后听(通过听那些能做、哪些不能做的事儿,体会情态动词can和can't的用法)、认(通过认图标,说出规则,并把说出的规则写下来),最后根据常识或观察,为图书馆、生化实验室、语音室、机房、健身房、游泳馆等公共场所制定规章制度或使用规则。这样,通过完成这一系列任务,既使学生学会了如何描述规章制度,又渗透了对学生的情感教育:通过对公共场所制定规章制度,培养学生遵守公德、爱护公物的美德。同时,学生还可以学会发散思维,以扩展知识;口头及书面表达能力也可随之提高。

二、课后反思:

不足之处:图标展示得不够;还可通过图标渗透中外文化差异。

可取之处:全方位的训练了学生的听、说、读、写的能力。

教案点评:

本设计采用任务型教学模式,设置四个任务先以谈论有关学校各项规章制度为话题,初步感受祈使句,及如何表达规则;然后通过听,体会情态动词can和can't的用法,通过认图标,说出规则,最后为图书馆、实验室等公共场所制定规章制度或使用规则。通过完成这一系列任务,既使学生学会了如何描述规章制度,又渗透了对学生的情感教育。

MSN(中国大学网)

本文网址://m.jk251.com/jiaoan/113929.html

相关文章
最新更新

热门标签